WO2005048933A2 - Oxime substituted imidazo ring compounds - Google Patents

Oxime substituted imidazo ring compounds Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2005048933A2
WO2005048933A2 PCT/US2004/037854 US2004037854W WO2005048933A2 WO 2005048933 A2 WO2005048933 A2 WO 2005048933A2 US 2004037854 W US2004037854 W US 2004037854W WO 2005048933 A2 WO2005048933 A2 WO 2005048933A2
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
group
alkyl
aryl
alkylene
alkenyl
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/US2004/037854
Other languages
French (fr)
Other versions
WO2005048933A3 (en
Inventor
Tushar A. Kshirsagar
Gregory D. Lundquist, Jr.
David T. Amos
Joseph F. Dellaria, Jr.
Bernhard M. Zimmermann
Philip D. Heppner
Original Assignee
3M Innovative Properties Company
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by 3M Innovative Properties Company filed Critical 3M Innovative Properties Company
Priority to CA002545774A priority Critical patent/CA2545774A1/en
Priority to JP2006539911A priority patent/JP2007511527A/en
Priority to EP04810872A priority patent/EP1685129A4/en
Priority to US10/595,792 priority patent/US7897767B2/en
Priority to AU2004291101A priority patent/AU2004291101A1/en
Publication of WO2005048933A2 publication Critical patent/WO2005048933A2/en
Publication of WO2005048933A3 publication Critical patent/WO2005048933A3/en

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D471/00Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00
    • C07D471/02Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00 in which the condensed system contains two hetero rings
    • C07D471/04Ortho-condensed systems
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P17/00Drugs for dermatological disorders
    • A61P17/02Drugs for dermatological disorders for treating wounds, ulcers, burns, scars, keloids, or the like
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/04Antibacterial agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/10Antimycotics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P33/00Antiparasitic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/08Antiallergic agents
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D471/00Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00
    • C07D471/12Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00 in which the condensed system contains three hetero rings
    • C07D471/14Ortho-condensed systems
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D519/00Heterocyclic compounds containing more than one system of two or more relevant hetero rings condensed among themselves or condensed with a common carbocyclic ring system not provided for in groups C07D453/00 or C07D455/00

Definitions

  • Certain lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amines and 1- and 2-substituted derivatives thereof were later found to be useful as antiviral agents, bronchodilators and immunomodulators. Subsequently, certain substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-4-amine, quinolin-4-amine, tetrahydroquinolin-4-amine, naphthyridin-4-amine, and tetrahydronaphthyridin-4-amine compounds as well as certain analogous thiazolo and oxazolo compounds were synthesized and found to be useful as immune response modifiers (LRMs), rendering them useful in the treatment of a variety of disorders.
  • LRMs immune response modifiers
  • the present invention provides a new class of compounds that are useful in inducing cytokine biosynthesis in animals.
  • Such compounds are of the following Formula
  • R', R", RA, RB, RAI, RBI, Rb R-2, and X are as defined below.
  • the compounds of Formulas I and LT are useful as immune response modifiers
  • IRMs due to their ability to induce cytokine biosynthesis (e.g., induce the biosynthesis or production of one or more cytokines) and otherwise modulate the immune response when administered to animals.
  • cytokine biosynthesis e.g., induce the biosynthesis or production of one or more cytokines
  • the present invention provides pharmaceutical compositions containing the immune response modifier compounds, and methods of inducing cytokine biosynthesis in an animal, treating a viral disease in an animal, and treating a neoplastic disease in an animal, by admimstering an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula I and/or Formula II and/or phannaceutically acceptable salts thereof to the animal.
  • the invention provides methods of synthesizing compounds of Formulas I and LI and intermediates useful in the synthesis of these compounds.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formulas I through
  • R, R', R", R'", R A , RB, RAI, RBI, RA2, RB2, RA3, RB3, RI, R2, R3, n, m, p, and X are as defined below.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula
  • X is C ⁇ - 10 alkylene or C 2-10 alkenylene
  • RA and R ⁇ are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or when taken together, R A and R B form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R'" groups; or when taken together, R A and R B form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups; R 2 and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkyleny
  • -S(O)o -2 -aryl -NH-S(O) 2 -alkyl, -NH-S(O) 2 -aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano (i.e., nitrile), nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R 8 ) 2 , -N(R 8 )-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and
  • R 2 and R" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
  • R c and Rj are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R d can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and -CH 2 -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(O) -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ;
  • R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent;
  • R' is a non-interfering substituent
  • R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • dialkylamino alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1-10 alkyl, C -10 alkenyl, C ⁇ - 10 alkoxy- .10 alkylenyl, and aryl-C 1-10 alkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
  • R ⁇ is C 1-6 alkylene or C 2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C 1-5 alkylene, and C 2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; and W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula LT:
  • X is C O alkylene or C 2-10 alkenylene
  • ⁇ and R BI are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or when taken together, R AI and R ⁇ i form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups, or substituted by one R 3 group, or substituted by one R 3 group and one R group; or when taken together, R A I and RBI form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
  • Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R la , Ri b , Ri', and R ⁇ " are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O) 0-2 -alkyl,
  • R and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: X R ⁇
  • Ri a and Ri together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
  • R is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-P ,
  • X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R 13 )-alkylene- and -CH(R ⁇ )-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o-2-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-,
  • Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O) 2 -, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-,
  • R c and R d are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R d can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheter
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R is C 2- alkylene; R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1-10 alkyl, C 2-10 alkenyl,
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene
  • Rn is C 1-6 alkylene or C -6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 1 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C 1-5 alkylene, and C 2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of-CH 2 -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and -N(R0-;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N(-Q-R )-, and -CH -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(0) 2 -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and -S(O) 2 -;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula HI:
  • X is C 1-10 alkylene or C 2-10 alkenylene;
  • R 2 and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino,
  • R 2 and R" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: A'
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N ⁇ Q-R ⁇ -, and -CH 2 -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(O) 2 -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 ;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -;
  • R c and R d are mdependently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R d can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
  • R_i is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1-10 alkyl, C 2- 0 alkenyl, C ⁇ - 10 alkoxy-C ⁇ .1 0 alkylenyl, and aryl-C 1-10 alkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
  • R ⁇ is C 1-6 alkylene or C 2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C 1-5 alkylene, and C 2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • n is an integer from 0 to 4;
  • R m is a non-interfering substituent;
  • R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula ma:
  • X is Ci-io alkylene or C 2 , 10 alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
  • R ⁇ is selected from the group consisting of: -R 4 ,
  • R la , Rib, Ri', and Ri are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O) 0-2 -alkyl,
  • -S(O) 0-2 -aryl -NH-S(O) 2 -alkyl, -NH-S(O) 2 -aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R 8 ) 2 , -N(R 8 )-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and
  • R 2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: X R n ⁇
  • R la and Ri together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-R ,
  • n is an integer from 0 to 4; m is 0 or 1 ; with the proviso that when m is 1 , then n is 0 or 1 ;
  • X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R ⁇ 3 )-alkylene- and
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O) 0-2 -, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-,
  • Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond
  • R c and R are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-io alkyl, C 2-10 alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-C 1-10 alkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene
  • Rii is C ⁇ - 6 alkylene or C 2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C 1-5 alkylene, and
  • R 13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of-CH 2 -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O) 0-2 -, -N(-Q-R 4 )-, and -CH 2 -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(0) 2 -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula ma:
  • X is Ci-io alkylene or C -1 o alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
  • Ri is selected from the group consisting of: -X-R 4 , -X'-Y-R
  • R 2 , R", R ⁇ , and Ri are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino,
  • R 2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: X
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-R4, -Z-X'-R , -Z-X-Y-R 4 ,
  • n is an integer from 0 to 4; m is 0 or 1 ; with the proviso that when m is 1 , then n is 0 or 1 ;
  • X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • X" is -CH(R 13 )-alkylene- or -CH(R 13 )-alkenylene-;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Z is a bond or -O-;
  • R c and R d are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R d can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
  • R- t is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalky
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene;
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-io alkyl, C 2 - ⁇ o alkenyl,
  • R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene;
  • R ⁇ is C ⁇ - 6 alkylene or C 2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C 2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of-CH 2 -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o -2 -, and
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O) 0-2 -, -N(-Q-R- -, and -CH 2 -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(O) 2 -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and -S(O) 2 -;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • X is C ⁇ _ ⁇ o alkylene or C 2-10 alkenylene;
  • R 2 and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino,
  • R 2 and R" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: R ⁇ 1 ⁇ wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9,
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o- 2 -, -N(-Q-R -, and -CH 2 -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(O) 2 -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -;
  • R c and d are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R d can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkyleny
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1-10 alkyl, C 2- iQ alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R ⁇ is C ⁇ - 6 alkylene or C 2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom
  • R 12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and
  • R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
  • n is an integer from 0 to 4; and R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula IVa:
  • X is Ci-io alkylene or C 2-10 alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
  • R la , Ri b , Ri', and Ri are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino,
  • R and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
  • R la and Ri together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
  • X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R 13 )-alkylene- and
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o- 2 -, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-,
  • R c and R are mdependently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R d can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and hetero
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-io alkyl, C 2- ⁇ o alkenyl,
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R 10 is C -8 alkylene
  • R ⁇ is C 1-6 alkylene or C -6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, Ci -5 alkylene, and C 2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of -CH 2 -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and -N(R0-;
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and -CH 2 -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(O) 2 -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R ⁇ )-, -O-C(R 6 ) ⁇ , -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and -S(O) 2 -;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -; and a and b are mdependently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula IVa:
  • X is C 1-10 alkylene or C 2-10 alkenylene
  • R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; n is an integer from 0 to 4; Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 2 , R", Ri', and Ri are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino, -S(O) 0-2 -alkyl,
  • R 2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
  • X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • X" is -CH(R 13 )-alkylene- or -CH(R 13 )-alkenylene-;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R c and R d are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene;
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci -10 alkyl, C 2- ⁇ o alkenyl, C 1-10 alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-C ⁇ ,i 0 alkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • RiQ is C 3-8 alkylene; Rii is C 1-6 alkylene or C 2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C ⁇ -5 alkylene, and C 2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 1 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of-CH 2 -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and -N(R4)-;
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O) 0-2 -, -Nt-Q-R -, and -CH 2 -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(O) 2 -,
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and -S(O) 2 -;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and-S(O) 2 -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula V:
  • X is Ci-io alkylene or C 2-1 o alkenylene
  • R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2
  • Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R -X"-O-NR la -Y'-Rib, and R , R", R la , Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino,
  • R 2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
  • R la and Rib together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-R4, -Z-X-R4, -Z-X'-Y-R ⁇ -Z-X'-Y-X'-Y-R 4 , and
  • X is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R 13 )-alkylene- and -CH(R 13 )-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O) 0-2 -, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-,
  • Z is a bond or -O-
  • R c and R d are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R ) 2 ; or R c and R d can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; t is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl,
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 7 is C 2 . 7 alkylene;
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, .io alkyl, C 2- ⁇ 0 alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-iQ alkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C 3-8 alkylene;
  • R ⁇ is C ⁇ - 6 alkylene or C 2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C 1-5 alkylene, and C 2- 5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of -CH 2 -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and -N(R4)-;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o -2 -, -N(-Q-R 4 )-, and -CH 2 -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(O) 2 -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and -S(O) 2 -;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula
  • X is C 1-10 alkylene or C 2-10 alkenylene
  • R A2 and R ⁇ 2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
  • Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 2 , R", Ri a , Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O) 0-2 -alkyl,
  • R 2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
  • the total number of atoms in the nng is 4 to 9
  • Ri a and Ri b together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
  • X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R ⁇ 3 )-alkylene- and -CH(R ⁇ 3 )-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o -2 -, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-,
  • Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O) 2 -, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-,
  • R c and R are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R d can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
  • Rj is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylen
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C O alkyl, C 2 - ⁇ o alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • Rio is C 3-8 alkylene
  • R ⁇ is C ⁇ - 6 alkylene or C 2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C 1 - 5 alkylene, and C 2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R ⁇ 3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of -CH 2 -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and -N(R4)-;
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O) 0- -, and -CH 2 - t
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(O) 2 -, -C,(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-0-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and -S(O) 2 -;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula VH:
  • X is C MO alkylene or C 2-10 alkenylene; RA and R ⁇ 3 , when taken together, form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups, or substituted by one R 3 group, or substituted by one R 3 group and one R group; or when taken together, RA 3 and R ⁇ 3 form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; Ri is selected from the group consisting of: -R4, -X -R ,
  • Ria, Rib, Ri', and Ri are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino,
  • Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
  • Ri a and Ri together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of: -N- C(R ⁇ ) ⁇ N- S(0) 2 X and ; R 3 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R ⁇ )-alkylene- and -CH(R ⁇ 3 )-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o -2 -, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-,
  • Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O) 2 -, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-,
  • Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R d can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C ⁇ _ ⁇ o alkyl, C 2-10 alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl; R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene
  • R ⁇ is d- 6 alkylene or C 2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R ⁇ 2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C 1 - 5 alkylene, and C 2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R ⁇ 3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of-CH 2 -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and -N(R )-;
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o -2 -, -N(-Q-R -, and -CH 2 -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(O) 2 -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and -S(O) 2 -;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula VLTa:
  • VLTa wherein:
  • X is CMO alkylene or C -10 alkenylene;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ;
  • Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Ri' and R ⁇ " are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino, -S(O) 0-2 -alkyl,
  • Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
  • n is an integer from 0 to 4.
  • X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • X" is -CH(R ⁇ 3 )-alkylene- or -CH(R 13 )-alkenylene-;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O) 0-2 -, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-,
  • R c and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R d can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
  • R 4 is selected from the group consistingof hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • dialkylamino alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci -10 alkyl, C 2-10 alkenyl, Ci_io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-d-io alkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene;
  • Rii is C ⁇ - 6 alkylene or C 2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R ⁇ 2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C ⁇ -5 alkylene, and C 2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of-CH -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O) 0-2 -, -N ⁇ Q-R t )-, and -CH 2 -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(Re)-, -S(O) -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(0) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula VHb:
  • VLTb wherein:
  • X is CMO alkylene or C 2-1 o alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; n is an integer from 0 to 4; Ri is selected from the group consisting of: -R 4 ,
  • Ri' and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino,
  • Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: R ⁇ ⁇ ⁇ wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
  • X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • X" is -CH(R 13 )-alkylene- or -CH(R 13 )-alkenylene-;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O) 0-2 -,
  • R c and R d are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R d can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
  • R t is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkyl
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, CM O alkyl, C 2-1 o alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci.io alkylenyl, and aryl-d-io alkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene;
  • R ⁇ is d- 6 alkylene or C 2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C 1-5 alkylene, and C 2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R ⁇ is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of-CH -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o -2 -, and -N(R4 ;
  • a * is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O) 0-2 -, -N(-Q-R -, and -CH 2 -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(0) 2 -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R ⁇ -O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and -S(O) 2 -;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula Vm:
  • RA 2 and R ⁇ 2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
  • X is Ci-io alkylene or C -10 alkenylene
  • Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 2 , R", R la , Ri b , Ri', and Ri are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino,
  • R 2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
  • Ri a and Ri b together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
  • X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R ⁇ 3 )-alkylene- and
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O) 0- 2-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-,
  • R c and R d are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R d can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocycly
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C MO alkyl, C 2- ⁇ 0 alkenyl,
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene
  • R ⁇ is d- 6 alkylene or C -6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R 12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C 1 - 5 alkylene, and C 2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
  • R ⁇ 3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of -CH 2 -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o -2 -, -N(-Q-R4)-, and -CH 2 -;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(0) 2 -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and -S(O) 2 -;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substitutent
  • R" 1 is a non-interfering substituent
  • non-interfering means that the ability of the compound or salt, which includes a non-interfering substituent, to modulate (e.g., induce or inhibit) the biosynthesis of one or more cytokines is not destroyed by the non-interfering substitutent.
  • Illustrative non-interfering R' groups include those described herein for Ri .
  • Illustrative non- interfering R'" groups include those described herein for R and R .
  • alkyl As used herein, the terms “alkyl”, “alkenyl”, “alkynyl” and the prefix “alk-” are inclusive of both straight chain and branched chain groups and of cyclic groups, i.e. cycloalkyl and cycloalkenyl. Unless otherwise specified, these groups contain from 1 to 20 carbon atoms, with alkenyl groups containing from 2 to 20 carbon atoms, and alkynyl groups containing from 2 to 20 carbon atoms. In some embodiments, these groups have a total of up to 10 carbon atoms, up to 8 carbon atoms, up to 6 carbon atoms, or up to 4 carbon atoms.
  • Cyclic groups can be monocyclic or polycyclic and preferably have from 3 to 10 ring carbon atoms.
  • Exemplary cyclic groups include cyclopropyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, adamantyl, and substituted and unsubstituted bornyl, norbornyl, and norbornenyl.
  • alkylene, “alkenylene”, and “alkynylene” are the divalent forms of the "alkyl”, “alkenyl”, and “alkynyl” groups defined above.
  • alkylenyl alkenylenyl
  • alkynylenyl alkynylenyl
  • an arylalkylenyl group comprises an alkylene moiety to which an aryl group is attached.
  • haloalkyl is inclusive of groups that are substituted by one or more halogen atoms, including perfluorinated groups. This is also true of other groups that include the prefix "halo-”. Examples of suitable haloalkyl groups are chloromethyl, trifluoromethyl, and the like.
  • aryl as used herein includes carbocyclic aromatic rings or ring systems.
  • aryl groups include phenyl, naphthyl, biphenyl, fluorenyl and indenyl.
  • heteroatom refers to the atoms O, S, or N.
  • heteroaryl includes aromatic rings or ring systems that contain at least one ring heteroatom (e.g., O, S, N).
  • Suitable heteroaryl groups include furyl, thienyl, pyridyl, quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, triazolyl, pynolyl, tetrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl, benzofuranyl, benzothiophenyl, carbazolyl, benzoxazolyl, pyrimidinyl, benzimidazolyl, quinoxalinyl, benzothiazolyl, naphthyridinyl, isoxazolyl, isothiazolyl, purinyl, quinazolinyl, pyrazinyl, 1-oxidopyridyl, pyridazinyl, triazinyl, tetrazinyl, oxadiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, imidazoquinolinyl, and so on
  • heterocyclyl includes non-aromatic rings or ring systems that contain at least one ring heteroatom (e.g., O, S, N) and includes all of the fully saturated and partially unsaturated derivatives of the above mentioned heteroaryl groups.
  • heterocyclic groups include pynolidinyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, mo holinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, thiazolidinyl, imidazolidinyl, isothiazolidinyl, tetrahydropyranyl, quinuclidinyl, homopiperidinyl (azepanyl), homopiperazinyl (diazepanyl), 1,3-dioxolanyl, aziridinyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(lH)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(lH)-yl, dihydroquinolin- (2H)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-lH-imidazolyl, and the like.
  • heterocyclyl contains a nitrogen atom
  • the point of attachment of the heterocyclyl group may be the nitrogen atom.
  • arylene is the divalent forms of the “aryl,” “heteroaryl,” and “heterocyclyl” groups defined above.
  • arylenyl is used when “arylene,” “heteroarylene,” and “heterocyclylene”, respectively, are substituted.
  • an alkylarylenyl group comprises an arylene moiety to which an alkyl group is attached.
  • each group is independently selected, whether explicitly stated or not.
  • each R 8 group is independently selected for the formula -C(O)-N(R 8 ) 2
  • each R 8 group is independently selected for the formula -C(O)-N(R 8 ) 2
  • each R 8 group is independently selected for the formula -C(O)-N(R 8 ) 2
  • each R 8 group is independently selected for the formula -C(O)-N(R 8 ) 2
  • each R 8 group is independently selected.
  • each group is independently selected, hi a further example, when more than one Y group is present (i.e., Ri and R 3 both contain a Y group) and each Y group contains one or more R groups, then each Y group is independently selected, and each R 7 group is independently selected.
  • the invention is inclusive of the compounds described herein in any of their phannaceutically acceptable forms, including isomers (e.g., diastereomers and enantiomers), salts, solvates, polymorphs, and the like.
  • isomers e.g., diastereomers and enantiomers
  • salts e.g., sodium tartrate
  • solvates e.g., sodium tartrate
  • polymorphs e.g., sodium bicarbonate
  • polymorphs e.g., sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate, sodium bicarbonate,
  • each one of the following variables e.g., R, R', R", Ri, R 2 , R 3 , R A , R B , RAI, RBI, RA2, RB 2 , RAS, RB 3 , n, m, p, X, Y, Y', Z, and so on
  • each one of the following variables e.g., R, R', R", Ri, R 2 , R 3 , R A , R B , RAI, RBI, RA2, RB 2 , RAS, RB 3 , n, m, p, X, Y, Y', Z, and so on
  • each of the resulting combinations of variables is an embodiment of the present invention.
  • R is selected from the group consisting of halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 .
  • R is selected from the group consisting of halogen and hydroxy.
  • R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent.
  • R 1 is selected from the group consisting of -R 4 , -X'-Ri, -X'-Y-R , -X'-Y-X'-Y-R 4 , -X'-R 5 , -X'-O-NH-Y'-R!', and -X ⁇ O-N ⁇ OR.!).
  • R' is selected from the group consisting of -R , -X'-R , -X'-Y-R t , -X'-Y-X'-Y-R 4 , -X'-R 5 , -X'-O-NR -Y'-Ri b , and -X"-O-N-C(R 1 ')(R ⁇ ").
  • Ri is selected from the group consisting of -R ⁇ , -X'-R ⁇ -X-YTI4, -X'-Y-X'-Y-Rj, -X'-R 5 , -X'-O-NRia-Y'-Rib, and
  • Ri is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkylenyl, -X'-Y-R 4 , and -X'-R 5 .
  • Ri is 2-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or -X'-Y-R ⁇
  • i is 2-methylpropyl or -X'-Y-R ⁇
  • Ri is C ⁇ -6 alkyl or hydroxy-C ⁇ -6 alkyl.
  • Ri is 2- methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or butyl, hi some embodiments, R ⁇ is 2- methylpropyl or 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl. In some embodiments, Ri is 2-methyl-2- [(methylsulfonyl)amino]propyl or 4-[(methylsulfonyl)amino]butyl.
  • R ⁇ a , Ri b , Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, as well as alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O)o -2 -alkyl, -S(O) 0-2 -aryl, -NH-S(O) 2 -alkyl, -NH-S(O) 2 -aryl, haloalkoxy
  • R la , Ri , Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, as well as alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino, -S(O)o- 2 -alkyl, -S(O)o -2 -aryl, -NH-S(O) 2 -alkyl, : NH-S(O) -aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
  • R ⁇ a and Rib together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
  • R la is hydrogen.
  • R 2 and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, as well as alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy (i.e., hydroxyl), alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O)o- 2 -alkyl, -S(O) 0-2 -aryl, -NH-S(O) 2 -alkyl, -
  • R and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, as well as alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy (i.e., hydroxyl), alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino, -S(O) 0-2 -alkyl, -S(O) 0- -aryl, -NH-S(O) 2 -alkyl, -NH-S(O) 2 -aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyan
  • R 2 or R" group is refened to as substituted or optionally substituted.
  • R 2 and R" can join together to form a ring system, hi some embodiments, the ring system is selected from the group consisting of:
  • the ring system is selected from the group consisting of:
  • the ring system is
  • R" or R 2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl, wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl are optionally substituted (by this it is meant, substituted by the groups listed above as possible substituents for R 2 and R"). In some embodiments, at least one of R" or R 2 is alkyl or substituted alkyl.
  • At least one of R" or R is alkenyl or substituted alkenyl.
  • at least one of R" or R 2 is aryl, arylalkylenyl, substituted aryl, or substituted arylalkylenyl.
  • at least one of R" or R 2 is heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, substituted heteroaryl, or substituted heteroarylalkylenyl.
  • at least one of R" or R 2 is heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted heterocyclyl, or substituted heterocyclylalkylenyl.
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl, wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl are optionally substituted (by this it is meant, substituted by the groups listed above as possible substituents for R 2 ).
  • R 2 is alkyl or substituted alkyl.
  • R 2 is alkenyl or substituted alkenyl.
  • R 2 is aryl, arylalkylenyl, substituted aryl, or substituted arylalkylenyl. In some embodiments, R is heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, substituted heteroaryl, or substituted heteroarylalkylenyl. hi some embodiments, R 2 is heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted heterocyclyl, or substituted heterocyclylalkylenyl.
  • At least one of R" or R 2 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, cyclopropyl, 2-(ethoxycarbonyl)cyclopropyl, propyl, butyl, 2- methylpropyl, tert-butyl, cyclopentyl, 2-cyclopentylethyl, acetoxymethyl, (ethoxycarbonyl)methyl, furyl, furfuryl, cyclohexyl, tefrahydrofuranyl, 2-(methylthio)ethyl, phenyl, 2-methylphenyl, 3 -methylphenyl, 4-methylphenyl, 2-methoxyphenyl, 3- methoxyphenyl, 4-methoxyphenyl, 2,6-dimethoxyphenyl, 2-chlorophenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 4-chlorophenyl, 2-fluorophenyl, 3 -fluorophenyl, 4-fluorophen
  • At least one of R" or R 2 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, cyclopropyl, 2-(ethoxycarbonyl)cyclopropyl, propyl, butyl, 2- methylpropyl, tert-butyl, cyclopentyl, 2-cyclopentylethyl, acetoxymethyl,
  • R 2 and R" are independently C 1-10 alkyl. In some embodiments, at least one of R" or R 2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl. hi some embodiments, R 2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl. In some embodiments, R 2 and R" are each methyl. In some embodiments, at least one of R" or R 2 is hydrogen. In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas ma and IVa, R" is hydrogen. hi some embodiments, R 2 is C 1-4 alkyl. hi some embodiments, R" is hydrogen or C 1- alkyl. In some embodiments, R" is C 1-4 alkyl. In some embodiments, R 2 is hydrogen or C 1- alkyl. hi some embodiments, R'" is a non-interfering substituent. In some embodiments,
  • R'" is R 3 . hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula HI, R'" is R or R 3 when n is 1, R or one R and one R 3 when n is 2, or R when n is 3 to 4.
  • R is selected from the group consisting of -Z-R 4 , -Z-X'-R/i, -Z-X-Y-R , -Z-X'-Y-X'-Y-R ⁇ and -Z-X'-R 5 .
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of -Z ⁇ and -Z-X'-Y-R ⁇
  • P is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consist
  • Ri is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, or heteroaryl.
  • R 4 is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, or heteroaryl, wherein alkyl and alkenyl are optionally substituted by aryl or aryloxy and wherein aryl is optionally substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, cyano, and halogen, hi some embodiments, is alkyl or arylalkylenyl.
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of aryl or heteroaryl, each of which may be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, hydroxyalkyl, dialkylamino, and alkoxy.
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 5 is
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene. In some embodiments, R 7 is ethylene. In some embodiments, R 7 is propylene.
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-io alkyl, C 2- ⁇ 0 alkenyl, C 1-10 alkoxy-C ⁇ - ⁇ 0 alkylenyl, and aryl-d-io alkylenyl. In some embodiments, R 8 is hydrogen or methyl. In some embodiments, R 8 is hydrogen.
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl.
  • R ⁇ 0 is C 3-8 alkylene.
  • Rio is pentylene.
  • R ⁇ is C 3-9 alkylene or C 3-9 alkenylene, optionally interrupted by one hetero atom.
  • R ⁇ is C ⁇ -6 alkylene or C 2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom.
  • R u is C ⁇ -2 alkylene.
  • R ⁇ is methylene; in some embodiments, Ru is ethylene.
  • R ⁇ 2 is C 2-7 alkylene or C 2-7 alkenylene, optionally interrupted by one hetero atom.
  • R ⁇ 2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C ⁇ - alkylene, and C 2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom. In some embodiments, R ⁇ 2 is ethylene.
  • R 13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups. In some embodiments, R 13 is hydrogen.
  • RA and R B are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or when taken together, R A and R ⁇ form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R'" groups; or when taken together, R A and R B form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups.
  • particularly embodiments of Formula I, RA and R B are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 .
  • hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula I, RA and RB form a fused aryl or heteroaryl ring.
  • hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula I, R A and R ⁇ form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring.
  • R A ⁇ and R B ⁇ are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or when taken together, RA I and R BI form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups, or substituted by one R 3 group, or substituted by one R 3 group and one R group; or when taken together, R AI and R BI form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups.
  • hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula LT, R AI and R B ⁇ form a fused benzene ring which is unsubstituted.
  • hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula LT, RA I and R BI form a fused pyridine ring which is unsubstituted.
  • hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula II, RA I and R BI form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the ring is unsubstituted.
  • the fused saturated ring is a cyclohexene ring.
  • R A2 and R B are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 .
  • RA 2 and R B2 are each independently alkyl.
  • A2 and RB2 are each methyl.
  • RA 3 and R ⁇ 3 when taken together, form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups, or substituted by one R 3 group, or substituted by one R 3 group and one R group; or when taken together, RA 3 and R ⁇ 3 form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups.
  • R A3 and R B form a fused benzene ring which is unsubstituted.
  • R A3 and R B3 form a fused pyridine ring which is unsubstituted.
  • R A3 and R ⁇ 3 form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the ring is unsubstituted.
  • the fused saturated ring is a cyclohexene ring.
  • R c and R are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms. In some embodiments, at least one of R c or R d is aryl.
  • A is selected from the group consisting of -CH 2 -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o -2 -, and -N ⁇ )-. In some embodiments, A is selected from the group consisting of -CH 2 - and -O-.
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o -2 -, and -CH -.
  • A' is -CH 2 -, -O-, or -N(-Q-R )-.
  • A is -CH 2 - or -N(-Q-R 4 )-.
  • A' is -CH 2 -.
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R )-,
  • Q is a bond or -C(O)-. In some embodiments, Q is selected from the group consisting of -C(O)-, -S(O) 2 -, and -C(O)-N(R 8 )-W-.
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and -S(O) 2 -.
  • V is -N(R 8 )-C(O)-.
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -. In some embodiments, W is selected from the group consisting of a bond and -C(O)-.
  • X is Ci-io alkylene or C 2- ⁇ 0 alkenylene.
  • X is Ci-io alkylene or C 3- ⁇ o alkenylene.
  • X is C 1 - 4 alkylene.
  • X is methylene.
  • X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups.
  • X is alkylene.
  • X' is ethylene, propylene, or butylene (including isobutylene).
  • X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R ⁇ )- alkylene- and -CH(R ⁇ 3 )-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups.
  • X" is -CH(R ⁇ 3 )-alkylene- or -CH(R ⁇ 3 )-alkenylene-.
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of -S(O) 0- -, -S(0) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R 8 )-Q-, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-,
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of -S(O)o -2 -, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R 8 )-Q-, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-,
  • Y is -N(R 8 )-C(O)-, -N(R 8 )-S(O) 2 -, -N(R 8 )-S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )- -N(R 8 )-C(O)-N(R 8 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(O)-N(R 8 )-C(O)-,
  • Y is -NH-C(O)-, -NH-S(O) 2 -, -NH-S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -NH-C(O)-N(R 8 )-, -NH-C(O)-NH-C(O)-, or
  • Y' is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-
  • Y' is selected from the group consisting of -C(O)-, -S(O) 2 -, and
  • Z is a bond or Z is a bond or -O-.
  • Z is a bond, hi some embodiments, Z is -O-.
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7.
  • a and b are each 2.
  • n is an integer from 0 to 4. In some embodiments, n is 0 or
  • n is 0. In some embodiments, n is 1. hi some embodiments, n is 2. In some embodiments, n is 3 or 4.
  • m is 0 or 1. In some embodiments, m is 0. In some embodiments, m is 1. hi some embodiments, p is an integer from 0 to 3. In some embodiments, p is 0 or
  • both n and m are
  • both m and p are 0.
  • n is 0, m is 0, or both n and m are 0.
  • particularly embodiments of Formula ma m is 0 or 1; with the proviso that when m is 1 , then n is 0 or 1.
  • m is 0 or 1, with the proviso that when m is 1 , p is 0 or 1.
  • X is C ⁇ -4 alkylene; R 2 is C 1-4 alkyl; R" is hydrogen or
  • Ri is C 1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-C ⁇ -6 alkyl.
  • X is C ⁇ -4 alkylene; R" is C 1-4 alkyl; R 2 is hydrogen or C 1-4 alkyl; and Ri is C ⁇ -6 alkyl or hydroxy-C ⁇ -6 alkyl.
  • X is methylene; at least one of R" or R 2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl; and Ri is 2-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or butyl.
  • X is methylene; R" and R are methyl; and Ri is 2- methylpropyl or 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl.
  • X is C 1-4 alkylene; R" is hydrogen or C 1-4 alkyl; R 2 is C 1-4 alkyl; Ri is C 1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-C 1-6 alkyl; and n and m are 0.
  • X is C 1-4 alkylene
  • R 2 is C 1- alkyl
  • R" is hydrogen or C 1-4 alkyl
  • Ri is C 1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-C 1-6 alkyl
  • R 2 and R ⁇ 2 are each methyl.
  • X is C 1-4 alkylene; R" is C 1- alkyl; R 2 ' is hydrogen or C 1-4 alkyl; Ri is C 1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-C ⁇ _ 6 alkyl; and RA 2 and R ⁇ 2 are each methyl.
  • X is CM alkylene;
  • R 2 is C ⁇ - alkyl;
  • R" is hydrogen or C 1-4 alkyl;
  • Ri is C 1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-C 1-6 alkyl; and
  • p and m are 0.
  • X is C 1-4 alkylene; R 2 is C 1- alkyl; R" is hydrogen or C 1-4 alkyl; Ri is C 1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-C 1-6 alkyl; and n is 0. In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula V, X is C 1-4 alkylene; R 2 is C 1- alkyl; R" is hydrogen or C 1-4 alkyl; Ri is C 1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-C 1-6 alkyl; and n is 0. In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula V, X is
  • X is d- alkylene; R" is C 1-4 alkyl; R 2 is hydrogen or C 1- alkyl; Ri is C 1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-d- 6 alkyl; and n is 0.
  • X is methylene; at least one of R" or R 2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl; Ri is 2-methylpropyl; 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or butyl; and n and m are 0.
  • X is methylene; at least one of R" or R is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl; R ⁇ is 2- methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or butyl; and p and m are 0.
  • R" and R 2 are methyl; Ri is 2-methylpropyl or 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl; and p and m are 0.
  • X is methylene; R 2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl; Ri is 2-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2- methylpropyl, or butyl; and R A2 and R ⁇ 2 are each methyl.
  • X is methylene;
  • R" and R 2 are methyl; Ri is 2-methylpropyl or 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl; and R A2 and R ⁇ 2 are each methyl.
  • X is methylene; R 2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl; Ri is 2-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2- methylpropyl, or butyl; and n and m are 0.
  • X is methylene; R" and R 2 are methyl; Ri is 2-methyl ⁇ ro ⁇ yl or 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl; and n and m are 0.
  • X is methylene; R" and R are methyl; Ri is 2-methylpropyl; and n and m are 0.
  • Ri is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkylenyl, -X'-Y-R ⁇ and -X'-R 5 ; wherein X' is alkylene; Y is -N(R 8 )-C(O)-, -N(R 8 )-S(O) 2 -, -N(R 8 )-S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(O)-N(R 8 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(O)-N(R 8 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(O)-N(R 8 )-C(O)-N(R 8 )-
  • R 5 is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, or heteroaryl, wherein alkyl and alkenyl are optionally substituted by aryl or aryloxy and wherein aryl is optionally substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, cyano, and halogen; and R 5 is
  • Ri is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkylenyl, -X'-Y-R ⁇ and -X'-R 5 ; wherein X* is alkylene; Y is -N(R 8 )-C(O)-, -N(R 8 )-S(O) 2 -, -N(R 8 )-S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(O)-N(R 8 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(O)-N(R 8 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(O)-N(R 8 )-C(O)-, R 8 )-C(O)-N(R 8 )-C(O)-,
  • R is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, or heteroaryl
  • Ri is 2-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or -X'-Y-R ⁇ X' is ethylene, propylene, or butylene; Y is -NH-C(O)-, -NH-S(O) 2 -, -NH-S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -NH-C(O)-N(R 8 )-, -NH-C(O)-NH-C(O)-, or
  • Ri is 2-methylpropyl or -X'-Y-R ⁇ X' is ethylene, propylene, or butylene; Y is -NH-C(O)-, -NH-S(O) 2 -, -NH-S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -NH-C(O)-N(R 8 )-,
  • R 8 is hydrogen or methyl.
  • R' is selected from the group consisting of:
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O) 2 -, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-,
  • Ri' and Ri" are the same as R 2 and R";
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C MO alkyl, C 2- ⁇ o alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-d-io alkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C -8 alkylene;
  • R ⁇ 3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of-CH 2 -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R ⁇ )-, -S(O) 2 -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and -C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and -S(O) 2 -;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7.
  • R'" is R or R 3 when n is 1 , R or one R and one R 3 when n is 2, or R when n is 3 to 4;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ;
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-R4, -Z-X-R4, -Z-X-Y-R 4 , -Z-X'-Y-X'-Y-R 4 , and
  • n is an integer from 0 to 4;
  • Z is a bond or -O-;
  • X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • R is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C 3-8 alkylene; A is selected from the group consisting of-CH 2 -, -O-, -C(0)-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and -N(R4)-;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R 6 )-C(R 6 )-, -S(O) 2 -, -C(R 6 )-N(R 8 )-W-, -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-, -C(R 6 )-O-, and ⁇ C(R 6 )-N(OR 9 )-;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R 6 )-, -O-C(R 6 )-, -N(R 8 )-C(R 6 )-, and
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) 2 -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is ⁇ 7.
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl, wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl are optionally substituted with one or more substituents defined above in the definition of
  • R 2 - In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas a and LVa, R 2 is alkyl or substituted alkyl, and R" is hydrogen. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas ma and LVa, R 2 and R" are independently alkyl.
  • R is alkenyl or substituted alkenyl
  • R" is hydrogen
  • R 2 is aryl, arylalkylenyl, substituted aryl, or substituted arylalkylenyl, and R" is hydrogen.
  • R 2 is heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, substituted heteroaryl, or substituted heteroarylalkylenyl, and R" is hydrogen.
  • R 2 is heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted heterocyclyl, or substituted heterocyclylalkylenyl, and R" is hydrogen.
  • At least one of R" or R 2 is alkyl or substituted alkyl, and at least one of R" or R 2 is hydrogen.
  • at least one of R" or R 2 is alkenyl or substituted alkenyl, and at least one of R" or R 2 is hydrogen.
  • at least one of R" or R is aryl, arylalkylenyl, substituted aryl, or substituted arylalkylenyl, and at least one of R" or R 2 is hydrogen.
  • at least one of R" or R 2 is heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, substituted heteroaryl, or substituted heteroarylalkylenyl, and at least one of R" or R 2 is hydrogen.
  • At least one of R" or R 2 is heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted heterocyclyl, or substituted heterocyclylalkylenyl, and at least one of R" or R 2 is hydrogen.
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, cyclopropyl, 2- (ethoxycarbonyl)cyclopropyl, propyl, butyl, 2-methylpropyl, tert-butyl, cyclopentyl, 2- cyclopentylethyl, acetoxymethyl, (ethoxycarbonyl)methyl, furyl, furfuryl, cyclohexyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-(methylthio)ethyl, phenyl, 2-methylphenyl, 3 -methylphenyl, 4- methylphenyl, 2-methoxyphenyl, 3-methoxyphenyl, 4-methoxyphenyl, 2,6- dimethoxyphenyl, 2-chlorophenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 4-chlorophenyl, 2-fluorophenyl, 3- fluorophenyl, 4-fluor
  • the ring system formed by R 2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" is selected from the group consisting of: ⁇ -11 ⁇ A'
  • Ru is C ⁇ - 6 alkylene or C -6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom
  • R 1 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C 1-5 alkylene, and C -5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom
  • R c and Ra are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or R c and R can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o -2 -, -N(-Q-R -, and -CH 2 -.
  • the ring system is
  • R ⁇ is C 1-2 alkylene; A' is -CH 2 -, -O-, or -N(-Q-R )-; Q is a bond or-C(O)-; and Rj is alkyl or arylalkylenyl.
  • R ⁇ is C ⁇ - alkylene; A' is -CH - or -NX-Q-R -; Q is a bond or -C(O)-; and t is alkyl or arylalkylenyl.
  • the ring system formed by R and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" is selected from the group consisting of
  • R ⁇ is C 3-9 alkylene or C 3-9 alkenylene, optionally interrupted by one hetero atom;
  • R ⁇ is C 2 . 7 alkylene or C 2-7 alkenylene, optionally interrupted by one hetero atom;
  • Rc and R are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R 9 ) 2 ; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four hetero atoms; and
  • A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O) 0-2 -, and -CH 2 -.
  • Step (1) of Reaction Scheme I a quinoline-3,4-diamine of Formula X is reacted with a carboxylic acid or an equivalent thereof to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XI.
  • Suitable equivalents to a carboxylic acid include orthoesters, and 1,1- dialkoxyalkyl alkanoates.
  • the carboxylic acid or equivalent is selected such that it will provide the desired -X-Hal substituent in a compound of Formula XL
  • Hal-X-CO 2 H or Hal-X-C(O-alkyl) 3 will provide a compound with the desired -X-Hal substitutent at the 2-position.
  • the reaction can be run in the absence of solvent or in an inert solvent such as toluene.
  • the reaction is run with sufficient heating to drive off any alcohol or water formed as a byproduct of the reaction.
  • a catalyst such as pyridine hydrochloride can be included.
  • step (1) can be carried out by (i) reacting a compound of Formula X with an acyl halide of formula Hal-X-C(O)Cl or Hal-X-C(O)Br and then (ii) cyclizing.
  • the acyl halide is added to a solution of a compound of Formula X in an inert solvent such as acetonitrile, pyridine or dichloromethane.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature.
  • a catalyst such as pyridine hydrochloride can be included.
  • the reaction can be carried out in the presence of triethylamine.
  • the product of part (i) is heated in pyridine.
  • the two steps can be combined into a single step when the reaction is run in pyridine or solvents such as dichloromethane or dichloroethane in the presence of triethylamine.
  • step (2) of Reaction Scheme I a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XI is oxidized to provide an N-oxide of Formula XII using a conventional oxidizing agent that is capable of forming N-oxides.
  • the reaction can be carried out by treating a solution of a compound of Formula XI in a suitable solvent such as chloroform or dichloromethane with 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid at ambient temperature.
  • step (3) of Reaction Scheme I an N-oxide of Formula XLT is aminated to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine of Formula XHI.
  • the reaction is carried out in two parts.
  • a compound of Formula XLI is reacted with an acylating agent.
  • Suitable acylating agents include alkyl- or arylsulfonyl chorides (e.g., benzenesulfonyl choride, methanesulfonyl choride, or 7-toluenesulfonyl chloride).
  • the product of part (i) is reacted with an excess of an animating agent.
  • Suitable animating agents include ammonia (e.g. in the form of ammonium hydroxide) and ammonium salts (e.g., ammonium carbonate, ammonium bicarbonate, ammonium phosphate).
  • ammonia e.g. in the form of ammonium hydroxide
  • ammonium salts e.g., ammonium carbonate, ammonium bicarbonate, ammonium phosphate.
  • the reaction can be carried out by dissolving a compound of Formula XfL in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane or chloroform, adding ammonium hydroxide to the solution, and then adding ?-toluenesulfonyl chloride.
  • the product or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (4) of Reaction Scheme I a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine of
  • Formula Xm is treated with N-hydroxyphthalimide to provide an N-phthalimide-protected lH-imidazo[4,5-e]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula Vila.
  • the reaction is conveniently carried out by adding a base, such as triethylamine, to a solution of N- hydroxyphthalimide in a suitable solvent such as NN-dimethylformamide (DMF); and then adding the lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine of Formula XD3 in a suitable solvent
  • reaction for example, DMF
  • DMF dimethyl methyl sulfoxide
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature.
  • the product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (5) of Reaction Scheme I an N-phthalimide-protected lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula Vila is converted to a lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XLV.
  • Removal of the N-phthalimide protecting group is conveniently carried out by adding hydrazine to a suspension of an N- phthalimide-protected lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula VLTa in a suitable solvent such as ethanol.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature.
  • the product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (6) of Reaction Scheme I a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XLV is reacted with an aldehyde or ketone of Formula R 2 C(O)R" to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula Lflb, winch is a subgenus of Formulas I, LT, and ILIa.
  • Numerous aldehydes and ketones of Formula R 2 C(O)R" are commercially available; others can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding the aldehyde or ketone of Formula R 2 C(O)R" to a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLV in a suitable solvent such as methanol.
  • a suitable solvent such as methanol.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature.
  • the product or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • Ketones such as acetone, tetrahydro-4H-pyran-4-one, l-acetyl-4-piperidone, l-benzyl-4- piperidone, and l-methyl-4- ⁇ i ⁇ eridone can be used in step (6) to make prefened compounds of the invention.
  • step (1) of Reaction Scheme E a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl tert-butylcarbamate of Formula XV is treated with N-hydroxyphthalimide to provide an N-phthalimide-protected lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XVI, which is a subgenus of Formulas VLI and Vila.
  • the reaction is conveniently carried out by adding a base, such as triethylamine, to a solution of N-hydroxyphthalimide in a suitable solvent such as DMF; and then adding the lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl tert-butylcarbamate of Formula XV in a suitable solvent (for example, DMF) to the resulting mixture.
  • a base such as triethylamine
  • a suitable solvent such as DMF
  • a suitable solvent for example, DMF
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature.
  • the product or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • Compounds of Formula XV can be readily prepared using known synthetic routes; see for example, U.S. Patent No.
  • step (2) of Reaction Scheme LT an N-phthalimide-protected lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XVI is converted to a lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XVLT.
  • Removal of the N-phthalimide protecting group is conveniently carried out by adding hydrazine to a suspension of an N- phthalimide-protected lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XVI in a suitable solvent such as ethanol.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature.
  • the product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (3) of Reaction Scheme LT a lH-imidazo[4,5-e]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XVH is reacted with an aldehyde or ketone of Formula R 2 C(O)R" to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XVHI, which is a subgenus of Formulas I, LI, HI and a.
  • Numerous aldehydes and ketones of Formula R 2 C(0)R" are commercially available; others can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding the aldehyde or ketone of Formula R C(O)R" to a solution of the lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XVH in a suitable solvent such as methanol.
  • a suitable solvent such as methanol.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature.
  • the product or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • Ketones such as acetone, tetrahydro-4H-pyran-4-one, l-acetyl-4-piperidone, 1- benzyl-4-piperidone, and l-methyl-4-piperidone can be used in this step to make prefened compounds of the invention.
  • step (4) of Reaction Scheme H a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XVHI is deprotected to provide an amino group at the 1 -position of a 1H- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XLX.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by dissolving a compound of Formula XVm in a mixture of trifluoro acetic acid and a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature.
  • the product or phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof, including the trifluoroacetate salt can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XIX is converted to a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]qumolin-2-yl oxime of Formulas XX or XXI, which are subgenera of Formulas I, H, HI, and a, using conventional methods.
  • sulfonamides of Formula XX can be prepared by reacting a compound of Formula XLX with a sulfonyl chloride of Formula R 4 S(0) 2 C1.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature in an inert solvent such as chlorofonn or dichloromethane by adding the sulfonyl chloride to a compound of Fonnula XLX in the presence of a base such as NN-diisopropylethylamine, triethylamine, or pyridine.
  • an inert solvent such as chlorofonn or dichloromethane
  • a base such as NN-diisopropylethylamine, triethylamine, or pyridine.
  • Sulfamides of Formula XX can be prepared by reacting a compound of Formula XIX with a sulfamoyl chloride of Formula R 4 (R 8 ) ⁇ S(O) 2 Cl or with sulfuryl chloride to generate a sulfamoyl chloride in situ, and then reacting the sulfamoyl chloride with an amine of Formula HN(R 8 )R .
  • the product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • sulfamoyl chlorides of Formula R 4 (R 8 )NS(O) 2 Cl and many sulfonyl chlorides of Formula R 4 S(O) 2 Cl and amines of Formula HN(R 8 )R 4 are commercially available; others can be prepared using known synthetic methods.
  • step (5a) of Reaction Scheme H a lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XIX is reacted with a chloroalkanesulfonyl chloride of Formula Cl-R 7 -S(O) 2 Cl to provide a compound of Fonnula XXI, wherein R 5a is a ring having the structure
  • the reaction is preferably carried out by adding the chloroalkanesulfonyl chloride to a solution of a compound of Formula XIX in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane in the presence of a base such as triethylamine.
  • a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane
  • the intermediate chloroalkanesulfonamide may optionally be isolated before treatment with a stronger base such as 1,8- diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene (DBU) at ambient temperature. If the intermediate chloroalkanesulfonamide is isolated, the reaction with DBU can be carried out in a suitable solvent such as DMF.
  • the product or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • Amides of Formulas XX and XXI can be prepared from lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XIX using conventional methods.
  • a compound of Formula XIX can be reacted with an acid chloride of Formula R 4 C(O)Cl to provide a compound of Formula XX.
  • the reaction can be carried out by adding the acid chloride to a solution of a compound of Formula XLX in a suitable solvent such as chloroform, optionally in the presence of a base such as N,N-diisopropylethylamine, triethylamine, or pyridine, at ambient temperature.
  • a base such as N,N-diisopropylethylamine, triethylamine, or pyridine
  • step (5a) a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XIX is reacted with a chloroalkanoyl chloride compound of Formula Cl-R 7 -C(O)Cl to provide a compound of Formula XXI, wherein R 5a is a ring having the structure
  • the reaction is preferably carried out by adding the chloroalkanoyl chloride compound to a compound of Fonnula XIX in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane in the presence of a base such as N,N-diisopropylethylamine.
  • a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane
  • the intermediate chloroalkanamide may optionally be isolated before treatment with a stronger base such as DBU at ambient temperature. If the intermediate chloroalkanamide is isolated, the reaction with DBU can be carried out in a suitable solvent such as DMF.
  • the product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • Ureas and thioureas of Formulas XX and XXI can be prepared from liJ- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oximes of Formula XLX using conventional methods.
  • a compound of Formula XIX can be reacted with an isocyanate of Formula
  • the reaction can be carried out by adding the isocyanate to a solution of a compound of Formula XLX in a suitable solvent such as chloroform, optionally in the presence of a base such as NN-diisopropylethylamine, or triethylamine, at ambient temperature.
  • the product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • R 2 , R", and n are as defined above;
  • X c is C MO alkylene;
  • P is a removable protecting group, such as an alkanoyloxy group (e.g., acetoxy) or an aroyloxy group (e.g., benzoyloxy);
  • R B is selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, alkoxy, -N(R 9 ) 2 ;
  • Ri c is a subset of Ri as defined above, which does not include those groups that one skilled in the art would recognize as being susceptible to reduction in step (5).
  • step (1) of Reaction Scheme HI a quinoline-3,4-diamine of Formula Xa is reacted with a carboxylic acid of the formula, HO-X-CO H, with a trialkyl orthoester of the formula, HO-X-C(O-C ⁇ - alkyl) 3 , or with a combination thereof (wherein "alkyl” is a straight or branched chain) to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl alcohol of Formula XXH.
  • steps (1) and (2) it is possible to combine steps (1) and (2) when an acid chloride of the Formula PO-X-CO 2 Cl is used under the conditions of step (1).
  • Some acid chlorides of this type for example, acetoxyacetyl chloride, are commercially available.
  • step (3) of Reaction Scheme HI a lH-imidazo [4, 5 -cjquinoline of Formula XXLfl is oxidized to provide an N-oxide of Formula XXLV using a conventional oxidizing agent that is capable of forming N-oxides.
  • the reaction can be carried out by treating a solution of a compound of Formula XXfH in a suitable solvent such as chloroform or dichloromethane with 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid at ambient temperature.
  • step (4) of Reaction Scheme m an N-oxide of Formula XXLV is aminated and the protecting group removed to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine of
  • Formula XXV The animation reaction is carried out in two parts, hi part (i) a compound of Formula XXLV is reacted with an acylating agent.
  • Suitable acylating agents include alkyl- or arylsulfonyl chorides (e.g., benzenesulfonyl choride, methanesulfonyl choride, or >-toluenesulfonyl chloride).
  • Suitable aminating agents include ammonia (e.g.
  • ammonium hydroxide in the form of ammonium hydroxide
  • ammonium salts e.g., ammonium carbonate, ammonium bicarbonate, ammonium phosphate
  • the reaction can be carried out by dissolving a compound of Formula XXLV in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane or chloroform, adding ammonium hydroxide to the solution, and then adding -toluenesulfonyl chloride.
  • the protecting group is removed by using conventional methods.
  • the product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (5) of Reaction Scheme ffl a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine of Formula XXV is reduced to provide a 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4- amine of Formula XXVI.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by suspending or dissolving a compound of Formula XXV in ethanol, adding a catalytic amount of rhodium on carbon, and hydrogenating.
  • the reaction can be carried out by suspending or dissolving a compound of Formula XXV in trifluoroacetic acid, and adding platinum(LV) oxide, and hydrogenating.
  • the reaction can be carried out in a Pan apparatus.
  • the product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (6) of Reaction Scheme LH a 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-
  • 4-amine of Formula XXVI is treated with N-hydroxyphthalimide under Mitsunobu reaction conditions to provide an N-phthalimide-protected 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula VHc.
  • the reaction is conveniently carried out by adding triphenylphosphine and N-hydroxyphthalimide to a solution of a compound of Formula XXVI in a suitable solvent such as tetrahydrofuran or DMF, and then slowly adding diethyl azodicarboxylate or diisopropyl azodicarboxylate.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature or at an elevated temperature, such as 60 °C.
  • step (6) may be carried out in two parts by (i) converting the hydroxy group in a compound of Formula XXVI to a leaving group and (ii) displacing the leaving group with N-hydroxyphthalimide in the presence of a base.
  • Part (i) of step (6) is conveniently carried out by treating the hydroxy-substituted 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine of Formula XXVI with thionyl chloride in a suitable solvent such as 1,2-dichloroethane.
  • the reaction may be carried out at ambient temperature, and the product may be isolated by conventional methods.
  • step (6) Part (i ⁇ ) of step (6) can be carried out under the conditions described in step (4) of Reaction Scheme I, and the product of Formula VHc or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (7) of Reaction Scheme HI an N-phthalimide-protected 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula VHc is converted to a 6,7,8,9- tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XX VH.
  • Removal of the N-phthalimide protecting group is conveniently carried out by adding hydrazine to a suspension of an N-phthalimide-protected 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin- 2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula VHc in a suitable solvent such as ethanol.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature.
  • the product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (8) of Reaction Scheme m a 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin- 2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XXVH is reacted with an aldehyde or ketone of Formula R 2 C(O)R" to provide a 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula LVb as in step (3) of Reaction Scheme H.
  • the product or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (1) of Reaction Scheme LV a halogen substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula fflc is coupled with a boronic acid of the formula R 3a -B(OH) 2 (or the conesponding anhydride or esters, R 3a -B(O-alkyl) 25 thereof) using Suzuki coupling conditions to provide a 17J- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula Hid.
  • a compound of Formula LHc is combined with a boronic acid of the formula R 3a -B(OH) 2 or an ester or anhydride thereof in the presence of palladium (H) acetate, triphenylphosphine and abase such as aqueous sodium carbonate in a suitable solvent such as 7*-propanol or n-propanol and water.
  • the reaction can be canied out at an elevated temperature (e.g., 80 °C-100 °C).
  • the product or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • Halogen substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oximes of Formula mc can be prepared as described above in steps (l)-(6) of Reaction Scheme I or steps (1) - (5) or (5a) or Reaction Scheme H, wherein one of the R groups is hal.
  • Numerous boronic acids of Formula R 3a -B(OH) 2 , anhydrides thereof, and boronic acid esters of Formula R 3a -B(O-alkyl) 2 are commercially available; others can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods.
  • R l5 R 2 , R", R, X, and Hal are as defined above;
  • E is carbon (imidazoquinoline ring) or nitrogen (imidazonaphthyridine ring); n is an integer from 0 to 4 (imidazoquinoline ring) or 0 to 3 (imidazonaphthyridine ring) with the proviso that when m is 1, then n is 0 or 1; and D is -Br, -I, or -OCH 2 Ph; wherein Ph is phenyl.
  • an aniline or aminopyridine of Formula XXVHI is heated with the condensation product generated from 2,2-dimethyl-l,3-dioxane-4,6-dione (Meldrum's acid) and triethyl orthoformate to provide an imine of Formula XXIX.
  • the reaction is conveniently carried out by adding a solution of an aniline or aminopyridine of Formula XXVm to a heated mixture of Meldrum's acid and triethyl orthoformate and heating the reaction at an elevated temperature.
  • the product can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • Many anilines and aminopyridines of Formula XXVLH are commercially available; others can be prepared by known synthetic methods.
  • benzyloxypyridines of Formula XXVIH can be prepared using the method of Holladay et al, Biorg. Med. Chem. Lett., 8, pp. 2797-2802, (1998).
  • step (2) of Reaction Scheme V an imine of Formula XXLX undergoes thermolysis and cyclization to provide a compound of Formula XXX.
  • the reaction is conveniently carried out in a medium such as DOWTHERM A heat transfer fluid at a temperature of 200 °C to 250 °C.
  • the product can be isolated using conventional methods. Isomers of the compound of Formula XX VIH or Formula XXX, wherein E is nitrogen, can also be synthesized and can be used to prepare compounds of the invention.
  • step (3) of Reaction Scheme V a compound of Formula XXX is nitrated under conventional nitration conditions to provide a compound of Formula XXXI.
  • the reaction is conveniently carried out by adding nitric acid to the compound of Formula XXX in a suitable solvent such as propionic acid and heating the mixture at an elevated temperature.
  • the product can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • a 3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridin-4-ol or 3- nitroquinolin-4-ol of Formula XXXI is chlorinated using conventional chlorination chemistry to provide a 4-chloro-3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridine or 4-chloro-3-nitroquinoline of Formula XXXH.
  • the reaction is conveniently carried out by treating the compound of Formula XXXI with phosphorous oxychloride in a suitable solvent such as DMF.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature or at an elevated temperature such as 100 °C, and the product can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (5) of Reaction Scheme V a 4-chloro-3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridine or 4- chloro-3-nitroquinoline of Formula XXXH is treated with an amine of Formula R ⁇ -NH 2 to provide a compound of Formula XXXtH.
  • amines of Formula R ⁇ -NH 2 are commercially available; others can be prepared by known synthetic methods.
  • the reaction is conveniently carried out by adding the amine of Formula R ⁇ -NH 2 to a solution of the 4- chloro-3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridine or 4-chloro-3-nitroquinoline of Formula XXXH in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane in the presence of a tertiary amine such as triethylamine.
  • a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature or at a sub-ambient temperature such as, for example, 0 °C.
  • the reaction product can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • a compound of Formula XXXLfl is reduced to provide a diamine of Formula XXXLV.
  • the reaction can be carried out by hydrogenation using a heterogeneous hydrogenation catalyst such as palladium on carbon or platinum on carbon.
  • a heterogeneous hydrogenation catalyst such as palladium on carbon or platinum on carbon.
  • the hydrogenation is conveniently carried out in a Pan apparatus in a suitable solvent such as toluene, methanol, acetonitrile, or ethyl acetate.
  • the prefened catalyst is platinum on carbon.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature, and the product can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • the reduction in step (6) can be carried out using nickel boride, prepared in situ from sodium borohydride and nickel(H) chloride.
  • the reduction is conveniently carried out by adding a solution of a compound of Formula XXXm in a suitable solvent or solvent mixture such as dichloromethane/methanol to a mixture of excess sodium borohydride and catalytic nickel(H) chloride in methanol.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature.
  • the product can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • a diamine of Formula XXXLV is reacted with a carboxylic acid equivalent to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine or 1H- imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XXXV.
  • the carboxylic acid or equivalent is selected such that it will provide the desired -X-Hal substituent in a compound of Formula XXXV and the reaction can be carried out as described in step (1) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • an acid chloride for example chloroacetyl chloride
  • the reaction can be carried out in two steps.
  • Part (i) of step (7) is conveniently carried out by adding the acid chloride to a solution of a diamine of Fonnula XXXLV in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane, chloroform, or acetonitrile.
  • a tertiary amine such as triethylamine, pyridine, or 4-dimethylaminopyridine can be added.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature.
  • the amide product or the salt thereof can be isolated and optionally purified using conventional techniques.
  • Part (ii) of step (7) involves heating the amide prepared in part (i) in the presence of base to provide a ⁇ H- imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XXXV.
  • the reaction is conveniently carried out in a suitable solvent such as ethanol in the presence of a base such aqueous sodium hydroxide, aqueous potassium carbonate, or triethylamine at elevated temperature, i some instances, the product of Formula XXXV may be obtained directly from Part (i).
  • a diamine of Formula XXXLV can be treated with ethyl chloroacetimidate hydrochloride as the carboxylic acid equivalent to provide a compound wherein X is methylene.
  • the reaction is carried out in a suitable solvent such as chloroform at ambient temperature and the product of Formula XXXV can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • Ethyl chloroacetimidate hydrochloride is a known compound that can be prepared according to the literature procedure: Stillings, M. R. et al., J. Med. Chem., 29, pp. 2280-2284 (1986).
  • a chloro-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XXXV can be converted into phthalimide-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine or ⁇ H- imidazo[4,5-e]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XXXVILT using the chemistry described in steps (2) - (4) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • Steps (8) and (9) can alternatively be combined and carried out as a one-pot procedure by adding 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid to a solution of a compound of Formula XXXV in a solvent such as dichloromethane or chloroform and then adding ammom ' um hydroxide and -toluenesulfonyl chloride without isolating the N- oxide of Formula XXXVI.
  • a solvent such as dichloromethane or chloroform
  • ammom ' um hydroxide and -toluenesulfonyl chloride without isolating the N- oxide of Formula XXXVI.
  • Compounds of Formula XXXVI, XXXVH, and XXXVm or their pharmaceutically acceptable salts can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • a phthalimide-substituted ⁇ H- imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XXXVffl is converted to a hydroxylamine-subsitituted lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XXXLX which is condensed with an aldehyde or ketone to form an oxime of Formula XL, sequentially using the chemistry described in steps (5) and (6) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • amine of Formula R ⁇ -NH 2 used in step (5) of Reaction Scheme V, may contain a protected functional group, such as a tert-butoxycarbonyl-protected amino group. The protecting group may be removed after step (12) of Reaction Scheme V to reveal an amine on the Rj group.
  • An amino group introduced in this manner may be further functionalized using the chemistry described in steps (5) and (5a) of Reaction Scheme H to provide compounds of the Formula XL in which Ri is -X'-N(R 8 )-Q-R 4 or -X'-Rs a .
  • the protecting group may be removed after step (7) in Reaction Scheme V and the resulting amino group may be functionalized as described above before step (8).
  • Formula XXXV can be subjected to steps (8) - (12) of Reaction Scheme V to provide a compound of Formula XL wherein Ri is -X'-N(R 8 )-Q-R 4 or -X'-R 5a .
  • the amine of Formula R ⁇ -NH 2 used in step (5) of Reaction Scheme V may contain an appropriately-protected hydroxyl group, for example, a tert- butyldimethylsilyl-protected hydroxyl group.
  • the protecting group may be removed after step (12) in Reaction Scheme V to provide an alcohol on the Ri group.
  • An alcohol introduced in this manner into a compound of Formula XL may be converted into a hydroxylamine upon treatment with N-hydroxyphthalimide using the Mitsunobu reaction conditions described in step (6) of Reaction Scheme HI, followed by deprotection of the resulting phthalimide-protected hydroxylamine with hydrazine in ethanol.
  • a hydroxylamine on the R ⁇ group of a compound of Formula XL, prepared as described above, can also be further functionalized to a compound of the Formula XL in which Ri is -X"-O-NR ⁇ a -Y'-Rib wherein Y' is -C(O)-, -S(O) 2 -, -C(O)-N(R 8 )-, -C(S)-N(R 8 )-, -C(O)-N(R 8 )-S(O) 2 -, -C(O)-N(R 8 )-C(O , -S(O) 2 -N(R 8 )-; R is hydrogen, and Ri is as defined above using, respectively, an acid chloride, a sulfonyl chloride or a sulfonic anhydride; an isocyanate; an acyl isocyanate, an isothiocyanate, a sulfonyl isocyanate
  • a compound of Formula XL in which Ri is -X"-O-NR ⁇ a -Y'-Rib wherein Y' is a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O) 2 -, or -C(O)-C(O)-; R ⁇ b is defined above, and R la is hydrogen, can be derivatized further upon treatment with an alkylating agent that is generated in situ from an alcohol of Formula R la -OH under Mitsunobu reaction conditions (described in step (6) of Reaction Scheme HI) or an alkylating agent of Formula R ⁇ a -Br or R la -I in the presence of a base such as cesium carbonate in a suitable solvent such as DMF.
  • the later reaction may be carried out at ambient temperature for reactive alkylating agents such as, for example, methyl iodide, benzyl bromide, and substituted benzyl bromides, or at an elevated temperature.
  • reactive alkylating agents such as, for example, methyl iodide, benzyl bromide, and substituted benzyl bromides
  • catalytic tetrabutylammonium hydrogensulfate can be added.
  • the product or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated by conventional methods.
  • One skilled in the art would recognize that the reactions described for the alkylation step would probably not be successful for R ⁇ a groups that are difficult to introduce via bimolecular nucleophilic substitution reactions. These groups include, for example, sterically hindered alkyl groups.
  • -N- C(O) -N- S(0) 2 form a ring of Formula R ? or 7
  • a reagent of the Formula P-O-R C(O)Cl, wherein P is a protecting group may react with a compound of Formula XL in which Rj is -X"-O-NH 2 to generate an isolable intermediate that can then be deprotected to yield a hydroxyalkanamide.
  • the isolable hydroxyalkanamide is cyclized under Mitsunobu conditions, described in step (6) of Reaction Scheme HI.
  • the product or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (1) is used to convert a hydroxylamine-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine or 1H- imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XXXLX to an oxime-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XLI, a subgenus of Formulas I and H, as in step (12) of Reaction Scheme V.
  • step (2) of Reaction Scheme VI a bromo- or iodo-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinoline-4-amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XLI can undergo known palladium-catalyzed coupling reactions such as the Suzuki coupling and the Heck reaction.
  • a bromo or iodo-substituted compound of Formula XLI undergoes Suzuki coupling with a boronic acid of Formula R 3a -B(OH) 2 , an anhydride thereof, or a boronic acid ester of Formula R 3a -B(O-alkyl) 2 , wherein R 3a is as defined above, according to the method described in Reaction Scheme LV.
  • the product of Formula XLH, a subgenus of Formulas I and H wherein R b is the same as R 3a , or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated by conventional methods.
  • the Heck reaction can also be used in step (2) of Reaction Scheme VI to provide compounds of Formula XLH, wherein R 3b is -X ft and -X' a -Y-R 4 , wherein X' a , Y, R 4b , and R 4 are as defined above.
  • Several of these vinyl-substituted compounds are commercially available; others can be prepared by known methods.
  • the reaction is conveniently carried out by combining the compound of Formula XLI and the vinyl-substituted compound in the presence of palladium (H) acetate, triphenylphosphine or tri-ortAo-tolylphosphine, and a base such as triethylamine in a suitable solvent such as acetonitrile or toluene.
  • the reaction can be carried out at an elevated temperature such as 100 °C -120 °C under an inert atmosphere.
  • the product of Formula XLH or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • the reduction can be carried out by hydrogenation using a conventional heterogeneous hydrogenation catalyst such as palladium on carbon.
  • a conventional heterogeneous hydrogenation catalyst such as palladium on carbon.
  • the reaction can conveniently be carried out on a Pan apparatus in a suitable solvent such as ethanol, methanol, or mixtures thereof.
  • the product or phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • the reaction can be carried out by transfer hydrogenation in the presence of a suitable hydrogenation catalyst.
  • the transfer hydrogenation is conveniently carried out by adding ammonium formate to a solution of a compound of Formula XXXLX in a suitable solvent such as ethanol in the presence of a catalyst such as palladium on carbon.
  • the reaction is carried out at an elevated temperature, for example, the refluxing temperature of the solvent.
  • the product of Formula XLIH or phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • a hydroxylamine-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinoline-4-amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XLm is converted to an oxime-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine or 1H- imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XLLV, a subgenus of Formulas I and ⁇ , according to the method of step (12) of Reaction Scheme V.
  • a hydroxy-substituted oxime of Formula XLLV is converted to a compound of Formula XLV, a subgenus of Formula I and ⁇ wherein R 3c is -O-R ⁇ , -O-X'-Ri, -O-X'-Y-R 4 , or -O-X'-Rs, using a Williamson-type ether synthesis.
  • the reaction is effected by treating a hydroxy-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4- amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XLLV with an aryl, alkyl, or arylalkylenyl halide of Formula ⁇ alide-Rj b , Halide-alkylene-R 4 , Halide-alkylene- Y-Ri, or Halide-alkylene-R 5 in the presence of a base.
  • alkyl, arylalkylenyl, and aryl halides of these formulas are commercially available, including substituted benzyl bromides and chlorides, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl or arylalkylenyl bromides and chlorides, and substituted fluorobenzenes.
  • Other halides of these fonnulas can be prepared using conventional synthetic methods. The reaction is conveniently carried out by combining an alkyl, arylalkylenyl, or aryl halide with the hydroxy-substituted compound of Formula XLLV in a solvent such as DMF in the presence of a suitable base such as cesium carbonate.
  • step (2a) may be carried out using the Ullmann ether synthesis, in which an alkali metal aryloxide prepared from the hydroxy-substituted compound of Formula XLLV reacts with an aryl halide in the presence of copper salts, to provide a compound of Formula XLV, where R c is -O-R t ⁇ ,
  • X' f is an arylene or heteroarylene.
  • Numerous substituted and unsubstituted aryl halides are commercially available; others can be prepared using conventional methods.
  • the product of Formula XLV, prepared by either of these methods, or phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • compounds of the invention are prepared according to Reaction Scheme VH, where Ri, R 2 , R", R A2 , R B2 , X, and Hal are as defined above, and Ph is phenyl.
  • step (1) of Reaction Scheme VH a 2,4-dichloro-3-nitropyridine of Formula XL VI is reacted with an amine of the Formula H 2 N-R ⁇ to form a 2-chloro-3- nitropyridine of Formula XLVH.
  • the reaction is conveniently carried out by combining an amine of Formula H 2 N-Ri and a 2,4-dichloro-3 -nifropyridine of Formula XLVI in the presence of a base such as triethylamine in an inert solvent such as DMF.
  • a base such as triethylamine
  • an inert solvent such as DMF.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature, and the product can be isolated from the reaction mixture using conventional methods.
  • Many amines of Formula H 2 N-R ⁇ are commercially available; others can be prepared by known synthetic methods.
  • Many 2,4-dichloro-3- nitropyridines of the Formula XLVI are known and can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods (see, for example, Dellaria et al, U.S. Pat. No. 6,525,064 and the references cited therein).
  • XLVH with an alkali metal azide for example, sodium azide
  • a suitable solvent such as acetonitrile/water, preferably 90/10 acetonitrile/water
  • cerium(LH) chloride preferably cerium(m) chloride heptahydrate
  • the reaction can be carried out with heating, for example, at the reflux temperature.
  • the reaction can be carried out by combining the compound of Fonnula XLVH with an alkali metal azide, for example, sodium azide, in a suitable solvent such as DMF and heating, for example to about 50-60 °C, optionally in the presence of ammonium chloride.
  • the product can be isolated from the reaction mixture using conventional methods.
  • an 8-nitrotetrazolo[l,5-a]pyridin-7-amine of Formula XLVIH is reduced to provide a compound of Formula XLIX.
  • the reaction can be carried out by hydrogenation using a heterogeneous hydrogenation catalyst such as palladium on carbon or platinum on carbon.
  • the hydrogenation is conveniently carried out in a Pan apparatus in a suitable solvent such as toluene, methanol, acetonitrile, or ethyl acetate.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature, and the product can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • a tetrazolo[l,5- ⁇ ]pyridine-7,8-diamine of Formula XLIX is reacted with a carboxylic acid or an equivalent thereof to provide a 7H- imidazo[4,5-c]tetrazolo[l,5- ]pyridine of Formula L.
  • the carboxylic acid or equivalent is selected such that it will provide the desired -X-Hal substituent in a compound of Formula L.
  • the reaction can be carried out as described in step (7) of Reaction Scheme V.
  • the product can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (5) of Reaction Scheme VH a 7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetrazolo[l,5- ⁇ ]pyridine of Formula L is treated with N-hydroxyphthalimide to provide a compound of Formula LI, which contains a N-phthalimide-protected hydroxylamine.
  • the reaction is conveniently carried out as described in step (4) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • the product or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
  • step (6) of Reaction Scheme VH the N-phthalimide-protected hydroxylamine of Formula LI is treated with hydrazine in a suitable solvent such as ethanol to provide a hydroxylamine of Formula LH.
  • reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature and the product can be isolated from the reaction mixture using conventional methods.
  • step (7) Reaction Scheme VH
  • the hydroxylamine group in a 7H-imidazo[4,5- c]tetrazolo[l,5- ⁇ ]pyridine of Formula LH reacts with an aldehyde or ketone of Formula R 2 C(O)R" to provide an oxime of Formula VHL
  • the reaction can be carried out using the conditions described above in step (6) of Reaction Scheme I and the product can be isolated from the reaction mixture using conventional methods.
  • the tetrazolo ring is removed from a 7H- imidazo[4,5-c]tetrazolo[l,5-fl]pyridine of Formula VQL by reaction with triphenylphosphine to form an N-triphenylphosphinyl intermediate of Formula L ⁇ L
  • the reaction with triphenylphosphine can be run in a suitable solvent such as toluene or 1,2- dichlorobenzene under an atmosphere of nitrogen with heating, for example at the reflux temperature.
  • an N-triphenylphosphinyl intermediate of Formula LIH is hydrolyzed to provide an oxime-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-4- amine of Formula VI.
  • the hydrolysis can be carried out by general methods well known to those skilled in the art, for example, by heating in a lower alkanol or an alkanol/water solution in the presence of an acid such as trifluoroacetic acid, acetic acid, or hydrochloric acid.
  • the product can be isolated from the reaction mixture using conventional methods as the compound of Formula VI or as a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • amines of Formula R ⁇ - ⁇ H 2 used in step (1) of Reaction Scheme VH, may contain a protected functional group, such as a tert-butoxycarbonyl-protected amino group.
  • the protecting group maybe removed later in Reaction Scheme VH after step (4) to reveal, for example, an amine on the Ri group of a compound of Formula L.
  • An amino group introduced in this manner may be further functionalized by applying the chemistry described in steps (5) and (5a) of Reaction Scheme H to provide compounds of the Formula L in which Ri is -X'-N(R 8 )-Q-R or -X'-R 5a , which can be converted into compounds of the Formula VI using the chemistry described in steps (5) - (9) of Reaction Scheme VH.
  • the protecting group may be removed after step (7) of Reaction Scheme VH to reveal an amine on the Ri group of a compound of Formula VHL
  • the amino group may be further functionalized as described above to provide compounds of the Formula VHI in which Ri is -X'-N(R 8 )-Q-R or -X'-R 5a , which can be converted into compounds of the Formula VI using the chemistry described in steps (8) and (9) of Reaction Scheme VH.
  • compositions of the invention contain a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of the invention as described above in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • a therapeutically effective amount and “effective amount” mean an amount of the compound or salt sufficient to induce a therapeutic or prophylactic effect, such as cytokine induction, immunomodulation, antitumor activity, and/or antiviral activity.
  • a therapeutic or prophylactic effect such as cytokine induction, immunomodulation, antitumor activity, and/or antiviral activity.
  • the exact amount of active compound or salt used in a pharmaceutical composition of the invention will vary according to factors known to those of skill in the art, such as the physical and chemical nature of the compound or salt, the nature of the carrier, and the intended dosing regimen, it is anticipated that the compositions of the invention will contain sufficient active ingredient to provide a dose of about 100 nanograms per kilogram (ng/kg) to about 50 milligrams per kilogram (mg/kg), preferably about 10 micrograms per kilogram ( ⁇ g/kg) to about 5 mg/kg, of the compound or salt to the subject.
  • a variety of dosage forms may be used, such as tablets, lozenges, capsules, parenteral formulations, syrups, creams, ointments, aerosol formulations, transdermal patches, transmucosal patches and the like.
  • the compounds or salts of the invention can be administered as the single therapeutic agent in the treatment regimen, or the compounds or salts of the invention may be administered in combination with one another or with other active agents, including additional immune response modifiers, antivirals, antibiotics, antibodies, proteins, peptides, oligonucleotides, etc.
  • Compounds or salts of the invention have been shown to induce the production of certain cytokines and certain compounds or salts of the invention may inhibit the production of certain cytokines in experiments performed according to the tests set forth below.
  • Cytokines whose production may be induced by the administration of compounds or salts of the invention generally include interferon- ⁇ (IFN- ⁇ ) and/or tumor necrosis factor- ⁇ (TNF- ⁇ ) as well as certain interleukins (IL). Cytokines whose biosynthesis may be induced by compounds or salts of the invention include LFN- ⁇ , TNF- ⁇ , IL-1, IL-6, TL- 10 and LL-12, and a variety of other cytokines.
  • IFN- ⁇ interferon- ⁇
  • TNF- ⁇ tumor necrosis factor- ⁇
  • IL interleukins
  • the invention provides a method of inducing cytokine biosynthesis in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt or composition of the invention to the animal.
  • the animal to which the compound or salt or composition is administered for induction of cytokine biosynthesis may have a disease as described infra, for example a viral disease or a neoplastic disease, and administration of the compound or salt may provide therapeutic treatment.
  • the compound or salt may be administered to the animal prior to the animal acquiring the disease so that administration of the compound or salt may provide a prophylactic treatment.
  • compounds or salts of the invention can affect other aspects of the innate immune response. For example, natural killer cell activity may be stimulated, an effect that may be due to cytokine induction.
  • the compounds or salts may also activate macrophages, which in turn stimulate secretion of nitric oxide and the production of additional cytokines. Further, the compounds or salts may cause proliferation and differentiation of B-lymphocytes.
  • T helper type 1 T H I
  • T helper type 2 T H 2
  • cytokines LL-4, LL-5 and IL-13 may be inhibited upon administration of the compounds or salts.
  • TNF- ⁇ tumor necrosis factor- ⁇
  • the invention provides a method of inhibiting TNF- ⁇ biosynthesis in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt or composition of the invention to the animal.
  • the animal to which the compound or salt or composition is administered for inhibition of TNF- ⁇ biosynthesis may have a disease as described infra, for example an autoimmune disease, and administration of the compound or salt may provide therapeutic treatment.
  • the compound or salt may be administered to the animal prior to the animal acquiring the disease so that administration of the compound or salt may provide a prophylactic treatment.
  • the compound or salt or composition may be administered alone or in combination with one or more active components as in, for example, a vaccine adjuvant.
  • the compound or salt and other component or components may be administered separately; together but independently such as in a solution; or together and associated with one another such as (a) covalently linked or (b) non-covalently associated, e.g., in a colloidal suspension.
  • Conditions for which fRMs identified herein may be used as treatments include, but are not limited to:
  • viral diseases such as, for example, diseases resulting from infection by an adenovirus, a herpesvirus (e.g., HSV-I, HSV-H, CMV, or VZV), a poxvirus (e.g., an orthopoxvirus such as variola or vaccinia, or molluscum contagiosum), a picornavirus (e.g., rhinovirus or enterovirus), an orthomyxovirus (e.g., mfluenzavirus), a paramyxovirus
  • a herpesvirus e.g., HSV-I, HSV-H, CMV, or VZV
  • a poxvirus e.g., an orthopoxvirus such as variola or vaccinia, or molluscum contagiosum
  • a picornavirus e.g., rhinovirus or enterovirus
  • an orthomyxovirus e.g., mfluenzavirus
  • paramyxovirus e.
  • a coronavirus e.g., SARS
  • a papovavirus e.g., papillomaviruses, such as those that cause genital warts, common warts, or plantar warts
  • a hepadnavirus e.g., hepatitis B virus
  • a flavivirus e.g., hepatitis C virus or Dengue virus
  • a retrovirus e.g., a lentivirus such as HLV
  • bacterial diseases such as, for example, diseases resulting from infection by bacteria of, for example, the genus Escherichia, Enterobacter, Salmonella, Staphylococcus, Shigella, Listeria, Aerobacter, Helicobacter, Klebsiella, Proteus, Pseudomonas, Streptococcus, Chlamydia, Mycoplasma, Pneumococcus, Neisseria, Clostridium, Bacillus, Corynebacterium, Mycobacterium, Campylobacter, Vibrio, Senatia, Providencia,
  • Chromobacterium Brucella, Yersinia, Haemophilus, or Bordetella
  • other infectious diseases such chlamydia, fungal diseases including but not limited to candidiasis, aspergillosis, histoplasmosis, cryptococcal meningitis, or parasitic diseases including but not limited to malaria, pneumocystis carnii pneumonia, leishmaniasis, cryptosporidiosis, toxoplasmosis, and trypanosome infection
  • neoplastic diseases such as intraepithelial neoplasias, cervical dysplasia, actinic keratosis, basal cell carcinoma, squamous cell carcinoma, renal cell carcinoma, Kaposi's sarcoma, melanoma
  • leukemias including but not limited to myelogeous leukemia, chronic lymphocytic leukemia, multiple myeloma, non-Hodgkin's lymphom
  • diseases associated with wound repair such as, for example, inhibition of keloid formation and other types of scarring (e.g., enhancing wound healing, including chronic wounds).
  • an fRM compound or salt of the present invention maybe useful as a vaccine adjuvant for use in conjunction with any material that raises either humoral and/or cell mediated immune response, such as, for example, live viral, bacterial, or parasitic immunogens; inactivated viral, tumor-derived, protozoal, organism-derived, fungal, or bacterial immunogens, toxoids, toxins; self-antigens; polysaccharides; proteins; glycoproteins; peptides; cellular vaccines; DNA vaccines; autologous vaccines; recombinant proteins; and the like, for use in connection with, for example, BCG, cholera, plague, typhoid, hepatitis A, hepatitis B, hepatitis C, influenza A, influenza B, parainfluenza, polio, rabies, measles, mumps, rubella, yellow fever, tetanus, diphtheria, hemophilus influenza b, tuberculosis, men
  • Certain LRM compounds or salts of the present invention may be particularly helpful in individuals having compromised immune function.
  • certain compounds or salts may be used for treating the opportunistic infections and tumors that occur after suppression of cell mediated immunity in, for example, transplant patients, cancer patients and HLV patients.
  • one or more of the above diseases or types of diseases for example, a viral disease or a neoplastic disease may be treated in an animal in need thereof (having the disease) by admimstering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of the invention to the animal.
  • An amount of a compound or salt effective to induce or inhibit cytokine biosynthesis is an amount sufficient to cause one or more cell types, such as monocytes, macrophages, dendritic cells and B-cells to produce an amount of one or more cytokines such as, for example, LFN- ⁇ , TNF- ⁇ , IL-1, E -6, IL-10 and LL- 12 that is increased (induced) or decreased (inhibited) over a background level of such cytokines.
  • the precise amount will vary according to factors known in the art but is expected to be a dose of about 100 ng/kg to about 50 mg/kg, preferably about 10 ⁇ g/kg to about 5 mg/kg.
  • the invention also provides a method of treating a viral infection in an animal and a method of treating a neoplastic disease in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt or composition of the invention to the animal.
  • An amount effective to treat or inhibit a viral infection is an amount that will cause a reduction in one or more of the manifestations of viral infection, such as viral lesions, viral load, rate of virus production, and mortality as compared to untreated control animals.
  • the precise amount that is effective for such treatment will vary according to factors known in the art but is expected to be a dose of about 100 ng/kg to about 50 mg/kg, preferably about 10 ⁇ g/kg to about 5 mg/kg.
  • An amount of a compound or salt effective to treat a neoplastic condition is an amount that will cause a reduction in tumor size or in the number of tumor foci. Again, the precise amount will vary according to factors known in the art but is expected to be a dose of about 100 ng/kg to about 50 mg/kg, preferably about 10 ⁇ g/kg to about 5 mg/kg.
  • N 4 -(2-Methylpropyl)quinoline-3,4-diamine 41 g
  • dichloromethane 550 mL
  • triethylamine 40 mL, 1.5 eq
  • chloroacetyl chloride 16.7 mL, 1.1 eq.
  • the reaction mixture was diluted with 1,2-dichloroethane (75 mL) and then washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (3 x 400 mL).
  • the reaction mixture was stined at ambient temperature for 1 hour and then filtered to remove a precipitate.
  • the filtrate was transfened to a separatory funnel and the layers were separated.
  • the aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 100 mL).
  • the combined organics were dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered through a layer of CELITE filter aid, and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 16 g of crude product as a yellow foam.
  • the foam was dissolved in 10% methanol in dichloromethane (20 mL).
  • the solution was divided and loaded onto two FLASH 40+M silica cartridges (90 g), (available from Biotage, Inc, Charlottesville, Virginia, USA).
  • the cartridges were eluted sequentially with IL 1:1 ethyl acetate :hexanes, 2% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate :hexanes, and 5% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate :hexanes.
  • the fractions containing product were combined and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 6.4 g of 2-chloromethyl-l -(2-methylpropyl)- 1H- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as an orange foam.
  • Triethylamine (536 mg, 5.19 mmol) was added to a solution of N- hydroxyphthalimide (678 mg, 4.16 mmol) in NN-dimethylformamide (DMF); after 5 minutes a solution of 2-chloromethyl-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4- amine (1 g) in DMF (10 mL) was added. The reaction mixture was stined at ambient temperature for 2 hours. The reaction mixture was diluted with dichloromethane (50 mL) and then washed with water (1 x 100 mL).
  • the aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 50 mL) and ethyl acetate (1 x 50 mL). The combined organics were dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered through a layer of CELITE filter aid, and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 1.8 g of crude product as a yellow solid.
  • the solid was dissolved in 5% methanol in chloroform (10 mL) and loaded onto a FLASH 40+M silica cartridge (90 g). The cartridge was eluted sequentially with IL 1% methanol in chloroform and 3% methanol in chloroform. The fractions containing the desired product were combined and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 950 mg of a yellow solid.
  • the reaction mixture was filtered to remove a precipitate and the filter cake was washed with ethanol and dichloromethane. ' The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure, diluted with aqueous IN hydrochloric acid (100 mL), and then washed sequentially with dichloromethane (2 x 50 mL) and ethyl acetate (1 x 50 mL). Analysis of the organic washes by LCMS indicated that they did not contain product.
  • the aqueous acidic layer was made basic ( ⁇ pH 9) with solid sodium carbonate and then extracted sequentially with dichloromethane (1 x 100 mL), ethyl acetate (1 x 100 mL), and dichloromethane (1 X 100 mL).
  • the cartridge was eluted sequentially with 500 mL 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 2% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, and 5% methanol 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes.
  • the fractions containing product were combined and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 690 mg of a yellow solid.
  • Acetaldehyde (3.5 mL) was added to a chilled (0 °C) solution of O- ⁇ [4-amino- 1 -(2- methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl ⁇ hydroxylamine (1 g) in methanol (30 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to warm to ambient temperature and stined for 4 hours. The reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure and the residue was placed under high vacuum overnight to provide 1.37 g of crude product as a brown foam. An attempt to purify by radial chromatography failed leaving 1.16 g of crude product.
  • This material was dissolved in dichloromethane (6 mL) and then loaded onto a FLASH 40+S silica cartridge (40 g).
  • the cartridge was eluted sequentially with 500 mL 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 2% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 5% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, and 6% methanol 1 : 1 ethyl acetate:hexanes.
  • the fractions containing product were combined and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 570 mg of a yellow solid.
  • the combined aqueous layers were extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 100 mL).
  • the combined organics were dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 14.1 g of crude product as a brown foam.
  • the foam was dissolved in a mixture of dichloromethane (15 mL) and methanol (0.5 mL).
  • the solution was divided and loaded onto two FLASH 40+M silica cartridges (90 g).
  • the cartridges were eluted sequentially with 1 L 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 5% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate :hexanes, and 10% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes.
  • the reaction mixture was stined at ambient temperature for 2 hours; an additional 1 g o ⁇ para- toluensulfonyl chloride was added and the reaction mixture was stined for another hour.
  • the reaction mixture was filtered to remove solids. The filtrate was transfened to a separatory funnel and the layers were separated.
  • the organic layer was washed with 1 : 1 water:saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (2 x 150 mL).
  • the combined aqueous was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 150 mL) and ethyl acetate (1 x 100 mL).
  • the combined organic extracts were concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 13.6 g of crude product as a brown foam.
  • the foam was dissolved in dichloromethane (20 mL). The solution was divided and loaded onto two FLASH 40+M silica cartridges (90 g). The first cartridge was eluted sequentially with IL 1 : 1 ethyl acetate :hexanes, 5% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, and 10% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes. The second cartridge was eluted sequentially with IL 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 7% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate :hexanes, and 7% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes.
  • Triethylamine (4.6 mL, 33.1 mmol) was added to a solution of N- hydroxyphthalimide (2.16 g, 13.2 mmol) in DMF (10 mL).
  • Trifluoroacetic acid (7 mL) was added to a suspension of tert-butyl [3-(4-amino-2- isopropylideneaminoxymethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)propyl]carbamate (4.12 g) in dichloromethane (70 mL). The reaction became homogeneous and was stined at ambient temperature for 2.5 hours. More trifluoroacetic acid (10 mL) was added and the reaction was stined for another hour.
  • reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure and placed under high vacuum overnight to provide 7.68 g of propan-2- one O- ⁇ [4-amino-l-(3-aminopropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl ⁇ oxime a white solid. Based on the weight this material was assumed to contain 5 equivalents of trifluoroacetic acid.
  • Triethylamine (3.1 mL) was added to a suspension of 2 g of material from Part F in dichloromethane (20 mL) and the reaction became homogeneous. Methanesulfonyl chloride (0.207 mL) was added and the reaction was stined at ambient temperature. Analysis by LCMS after 1 hour showed that the reaction was not complete. More methanesulfonyl chloride (0.15 mL) was added and the reaction was stined for an additional 30 minutes. The reaction mixture was washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (1 x 40 mL).
  • the aqueous wash was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 30 mL) and ethyl acetate (1 x 20 mL). The combined organics were washed with brine and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 1.5 g of crude product as a tan solid.
  • the solid was dissolved in 10% methanol in chloroform (10 mL) and then loaded onto a FLASH 40+S silica cartridge (40 g). The cartridge was eluted sequentially with 500 mL 1:1 ethyl acetate :heaxanes, 5% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 2 % methanol in chloroform, and 5 % methanol in chloroform (x3).
  • Micromass LC-TOFMS and the appropriate fractions were centrifuge evaporated to provide the trifluoroacetate salt of the desired compound.
  • the table below shows the ketone or aldehyde used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
  • Acetone 25 mL was added to a suspension of the crude material from Part D in methanol (100 mL). The resulting solution was stined at ambient temperature for 3 hours and then concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was azeotroped once with toluene, slurried with ethanol (100 mL) and then filtered. The filter cake was washed with additional ethanol. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 3.9 g of product as a yellow solid. Additional product (0.9 g) was obtained by extracting the filter cake with dichloromethane.
  • Trifluoroacetic acid (10 mL) was added to a suspension of tert-butyl [2-(4-amino- 2-isopiOpylideneaminooxymethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)ethyl]carbamate (4.8 g) in dichloromethane (100 mL). The reaction became homogeneous and was stined at ambient temperature. At 2.5 hours and 3.5 hours more trifluoroacetic acid (10 mL and 5 mL respectively) was added. After a total reaction time of 4 hours the reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • Examples 60 - 83 An acid chloride, sulfonyl chloride, carbamoyl chloride or isocyanate from the table below (1.1 equivalents) was added to a test tube containing propan-2-one O- ⁇ [4- amino- 1 -(3-aminopropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl ⁇ oxime trifluoroacetate (90 mg), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (350 ⁇ L, 10 equivalents), and chloroform (2 mL). The test tube was capped and placed on a shaker at ambient temperature overnight (approximately 18 hours). Water (1 drop) was added and then the solvent was removed by vacuum centrifugation.
  • the compounds were purified by preparative high performance liquid chromatography (prep HPLC) using a Waters Fraction Lynx automated purification system as described for Examples 6 - 51 above.
  • the table below shows the acid chloride, sulfonyl chloride, carbamoyl chloride or isocyanate used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
  • Triethylamine (50.0 mL, 360 mmol) was added to a suspension of 4-chloro-3- nitroquinoline (50.0 g, 240 mmol) in DMF (200 mL), followed by dropwise addition of a solution of l-amino-2-methyl-propan-2-ol (23.5 g, 264 mmol) in DMF (50 mL).
  • the reaction mixture was stined overnight at room temperature, then water (500 mL) was added and stirring was continued for 30 minutes. A solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water, and dried to yield 60.9 g of 2-methyl-l-[(3-nitroquinolin-4- yl)amino]propan-2-ol, which was used without further purification.
  • Part B A mixture of 2-methyl-l-[(3-nitroquinolin-4-yl)amino]propan-2-ol (60.9 g, 233 mmol), 5% platinum on carbon (6.1 g), and ethanol (500 mL) was hydrogenated on a Pan apparatus at 30 psi (2.1 x 10 5 Pa) for 3 hours. The mixture was filtered through CELITE filter agent, which was subsequently rinsed with methanol and dichloromethane. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield an oil that was concentrated twice from toluene to afford 56.6 g of a brown oil that was used directly in the next step.
  • Triethylamine (49.0 mL, 350 mmol) was added to a stined suspension of the material from Part B in dichloromethane (450 mL).
  • the reaction mixture was stined for approximately 3 days at room temperature.
  • the solution was concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • the residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate (500 mL) and 1:1 saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate/water (500 mL).
  • the aqueous layer was extracted with ethyl acetate (3 x 250 mL) and chloroform (250 mL).
  • the organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • Part D mCPBA (77% pure, 36.5 g, 163 mmol) was added over 10 minutes to a stined suspension of l-[2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl]-2-methylpropan-2-ol (23.6 g, 81.4 mmol) in chloroform (500 mL). The resulting solution was stined at room temperature for 1.5 hours. Concentrated ammonium hydroxide (200 mL) was added. After 5 minutes, jt?-toluenesulfonyl chloride (18.6 g, 97.7 mmol) was added in portions.
  • the mixture was stined at room temperature for 2.3 hours, then was transfened to a separatory funnel. The layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 100 mL, then 3 x 200 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to yield a foam.

Abstract

Imidazo ring compounds (e.g., imidazoquinolines, 6,7,8,9-tetrahydroimidazoquinolines, imidazonaphthyridines, and imidazopyridines) with an oxime substituent at the 2-position, pharmaceutical compositions containing the compounds, intermediates, and methods of use of these compounds as immunomodulators, for inducing cytokine biosynthesis in animals and in the treatment of diseases including viral and neoplastic diseases are disclosed.

Description

OXrME SUBSTITUTED IMΓDAZO RING COMPOUNDS
CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS The present application claims priority to U.S. Provisional Application Serial No. 60/520,418, filed on November 14, 2003, which is incorporated herein in its entirety.
BACKGROUND hi the 1950's the lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline ring system was developed, and l-(6- methoxy-8-quinolinyl)-2-methyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline was synthesized for possible use as an antimalarial agent. Subsequently, syntheses of various substituted 1H- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolines were reported. For example, l-[2-(4-piperidyl)ethyl]-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline was synthesized as a possible anticonvulsant and cardiovascular agent. Also, several 2-oxoimidazo[4,5-c]quinolines have been reported.
Certain lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amines and 1- and 2-substituted derivatives thereof were later found to be useful as antiviral agents, bronchodilators and immunomodulators. Subsequently, certain substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-4-amine, quinolin-4-amine, tetrahydroquinolin-4-amine, naphthyridin-4-amine, and tetrahydronaphthyridin-4-amine compounds as well as certain analogous thiazolo and oxazolo compounds were synthesized and found to be useful as immune response modifiers (LRMs), rendering them useful in the treatment of a variety of disorders.
There continues to be interest in and a need for compounds that have the ability to modulate the immune response, by induction of cytokine biosynthesis or other mechanisms.
SUMMARY The present invention provides a new class of compounds that are useful in inducing cytokine biosynthesis in animals. Such compounds are of the following Formula
I:
Figure imgf000003_0001
and, more particularly, compounds of the following Formula II:
Figure imgf000003_0002
π
wherein: R', R", RA, RB, RAI, RBI, Rb R-2, and X are as defined below. The compounds of Formulas I and LT are useful as immune response modifiers
(IRMs) due to their ability to induce cytokine biosynthesis (e.g., induce the biosynthesis or production of one or more cytokines) and otherwise modulate the immune response when administered to animals. This makes the compounds useful in the treatment of a variety of conditions, such as viral diseases and neoplastic diseases, that are responsive to such changes in the immune response.
In another aspect, the present invention provides pharmaceutical compositions containing the immune response modifier compounds, and methods of inducing cytokine biosynthesis in an animal, treating a viral disease in an animal, and treating a neoplastic disease in an animal, by admimstering an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula I and/or Formula II and/or phannaceutically acceptable salts thereof to the animal. In another aspect, the invention provides methods of synthesizing compounds of Formulas I and LI and intermediates useful in the synthesis of these compounds.
As used herein, "a," "an," "the," "at least one," and "one or more" are used interchangeably. The terms "comprising" and variations thereof do not have a limiting meaning where these terms appear in the description and claims.
The above summary of the present invention is not intended to describe each disclosed embodiment or every implementation of the present invention. The description that follows more particularly exemplifies illustrative embodiments. Guidance is also provided herein through lists of examples, which can be used in various combinations, hi each instance, the recited list serves only as a representative group and should not be interpreted as an exclusive list.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF ILLUSTRATIVE
EMBODIMENTS OF THE INVENTION
The present invention provides compounds of the following Formulas I through
VI:
Figure imgf000004_0001
Figure imgf000004_0002
π
Figure imgf000005_0001
m
Figure imgf000005_0002
ma
Figure imgf000005_0003
TV
Figure imgf000005_0004
IVa
Figure imgf000006_0001
V
Figure imgf000006_0002
VI
as well as intermediates of the following Formulas VII through Vm (some of which are active compounds):
Figure imgf000006_0003
Figure imgf000006_0004
Vila
Figure imgf000007_0001
Figure imgf000007_0002
vm
wherein: R, R', R", R'", RA, RB, RAI, RBI, RA2, RB2, RA3, RB3, RI, R2, R3, n, m, p, and X are as defined below.
h one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula
I:
Figure imgf000007_0003
wherein:
X is Cι-10 alkylene or C2-10 alkenylene;
RA and Rβ are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or when taken together, RA and RB form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R'" groups; or when taken together, RA and RB form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups; R2 and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O)0-2-alkyl,
-S(O)o-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano (i.e., nitrile), nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
X R
1 π wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000009_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9;
Rc and Rj are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-,
Figure imgf000009_0002
and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O) -, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent;
R'" is a non-interfering substituent;
R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino,
(dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-10 alkyl, C -10 alkenyl, Cι-10 alkoxy- .10 alkylenyl, and aryl-C1-10 alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rπ is C1-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; and W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
hi one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula LT:
Figure imgf000011_0001
π wherein: X is C O alkylene or C2-10 alkenylene; Ϊ and RBI are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or when taken together, RAI and Rβi form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups, or substituted by one R3 group, or substituted by one R3 group and one R group; or when taken together, RAI and RBI form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups;
R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
-N(R9)2; Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
-Rt, -X-R4, -X'-YTU,
-X-Y-X-Y-R4, -X'-R5, -X"-O-NRla-Y'-Rib, and
Figure imgf000012_0001
R , R", Rla, Rib, Ri', and R\" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O)0-2-alkyl,
-S(O)0-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or R and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: X R \
π wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000013_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Ria and Ri together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000014_0001
R is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-P ,
-Z-X'-P , -Z-X'-Y-R^ -Z-X'-Y-X'-Y^, and -Z-X'-R5; X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R13)-alkylene- and -CH(Rι )-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-,
-C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000014_0002
Figure imgf000015_0001
Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000015_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000015_0003
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Z is a bond or -O-; Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
-N- C(Rβ) -N- S(0)2 _V-,<, - N- C(R6)-N A
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R is C2- alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-10 alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl,
Ci-io alkoxy-C o alkylenyl, and aryl-C1-10 alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
Rn is C1-6 alkylene or C -6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R1 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and -N(R0-; A is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N(-Q-R )-, and -CH -;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(0)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
hi one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula HI:
Figure imgf000017_0001
m wherein:
X is C1-10 alkylene or C2-10 alkenylene; R2 and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino,
-S(O)0- -alkyl,
-S(O)0-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000019_0001
A'
11 wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000019_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9;
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N^Q-R^-, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9 ;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-;
Rc and Rd are mdependently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
R_i is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-10 alkyl, C2- 0 alkenyl, Cι-10 alkoxy-Cι.10 alkylenyl, and aryl-C1-10 alkylenyl; R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
Rπ is C1-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; n is an integer from 0 to 4; Rm is a non-interfering substituent; and
R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
In one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula ma:
Figure imgf000020_0001
wherein:
X is Ci-io alkylene or C2,10 alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
-N(R9)2; R\ is selected from the group consisting of: -R4,
-X-R4,
-X'-Y-R
-X'-Y-X'-Y-R*, -X*-Rs,
-X"-0-NRla-Y'-Rjb, and
Figure imgf000021_0001
R2, R", Rla, Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O)0-2-alkyl,
-S(O)0-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: X Rn \
11 wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000022_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Rla and Ri together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000022_0002
R3 is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-R ,
-Z-X'-R^
Figure imgf000022_0003
-Z-X'-Y-X'-Y-R^ and -Z-X'-R5; n is an integer from 0 to 4; m is 0 or 1 ; with the proviso that when m is 1 , then n is 0 or 1 ; X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(Rι3)-alkylene- and
-CH(R1 )-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)0-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000023_0001
Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond,
-C(O)-,
-C(S)-,
-S(O)2-,
-S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000024_0001
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000024_0002
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and
-C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Z is a bond or -O-;
Rc and R are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and R can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000025_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-io alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-C1-10 alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
Rii is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and
C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and
-N(RD-;
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-, -N(-Q-R4)-, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(0)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-; V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and
-S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. hi one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula ma:
Figure imgf000026_0001
ma wherein:
X is Ci-io alkylene or C -1o alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
-N(R9)2; Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000026_0002
-X-R4, -X'-Y-R
-X'-Y-X'-Y-R4,
-X*-R5,
-X'-O-NH-Y'-R! 1, and
Figure imgf000026_0003
R2, R", R\ , and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino,
-S(O)0-2-alkyl, -S(O)o-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: X
11 wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000028_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9;
R3 is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-R4, -Z-X'-R , -Z-X-Y-R4,
-Z-X'-Y-X'-Y-R^ and -Z-X'-R5; n is an integer from 0 to 4; m is 0 or 1 ; with the proviso that when m is 1 , then n is 0 or 1 ; X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; X" is -CH(R13)-alkylene- or -CH(R13)-alkenylene-; Y is selected from the group consisting of:
-S(O)0-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000029_0001
ected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000029_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000030_0001
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(-NH)-N(R8)-; Z is a bond or -O-;
Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; R-t is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
-—N IN-— CΛ(RΓVβ)
Figure imgf000030_0002
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R7 is C2-7 alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-io alkyl, C2-ιo alkenyl,
Ci-io alkoxy-C1-10 alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; R10 is C3-8 alkylene; Rπ is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o-2-, and
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-, -N(-Q-R- -, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
hi one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula IV:
Figure imgf000031_0001
rv wherein:
X is Cι_ιo alkylene or C2-10 alkenylene; R2 and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino,
-S(O)o-2-alkyl, -S(O)0-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy; -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000033_0001
1 π wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9,
Figure imgf000033_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9;
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N(-Q-R -, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-;
Rc and d are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-10 alkyl, C2-iQ alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rπ is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and
C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
-N(R9)2; n is an integer from 0 to 4; and R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
hi one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula IVa:
Figure imgf000034_0001
IVa wherein:
X is Ci-io alkylene or C2-10 alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
-N(R9)2; n is an integer from 0 to 4; Ri is selected from the group consisting of: -R4,
Figure imgf000035_0001
-X'-Y-X'-Y-R , -X'-R5, -X"-O-NRla-Y'-Rib, and
Figure imgf000035_0002
R2, R", Rla, Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino,
-S(O)0-2-alkyl,
-S(0)o-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or R and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000037_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000037_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Rla and Ri together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
-N- C(R6) -N- S(0)2 V and ;
X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R13)-alkylene- and
-CH(R13)-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000037_0003
Figure imgf000038_0001
lected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000038_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000038_0003
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Rc and R are mdependently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000039_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-io alkyl, C2-ιo alkenyl,
C1-10 alkoxy-d-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci.io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
R10 is C -8 alkylene;
Rπ is C1-6 alkylene or C -6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, Ci-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of -CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and -N(R0-; A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-,
Figure imgf000040_0001
and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(Rό)-, -O-C(R6)~, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are mdependently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
ha one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula IVa:
Figure imgf000040_0002
wherein: X is C1-10 alkylene or C2-10 alkenylene;
R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; n is an integer from 0 to 4; Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
-R4, -X'-R ,
Figure imgf000041_0001
-X-Y-X-Y-R4,
-X'-R5,
Figure imgf000041_0002
R2, R", Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino, -S(O)0-2-alkyl,
-S(O)o-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
X~ Rπ
~~\ A'
1 Λ wherein the total number of atoms m the nng is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000042_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9;
X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; X" is -CH(R13)-alkylene- or -CH(R13)-alkenylene-;
Y is selected from the group consisting of:
-S(O)o-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-,
-C(R6)-O-,
-O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-0-,
-N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000043_0001
lected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000043_0002
-C(O)-O- -C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(0)-,
Figure imgf000044_0001
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and R can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo; R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
-
Figure imgf000044_0002
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R7 is C2-7 alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-10 alkyl, C2-ιo alkenyl, C1-10 alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Cι,i0 alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
RiQ is C3-8 alkylene; Rii is C1-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, Cι-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; R1 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and -N(R4)-;
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-, -Nt-Q-R -, and -CH2-; Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)- -, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and-S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
In one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula V:
Figure imgf000045_0001
V wherein:
X is Ci-io alkylene or C2-1o alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
-Ri,
-X-R4,
-X'-Y-R^
-X'-Y-X'-Y-R4, -X-R5,
-X"-O-NRla-Y'-Rib, and
Figure imgf000046_0001
R , R", Rla, Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino,
-S(O)0-2-alkyl,
-S(O)0-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(0)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000048_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Rla and Rib together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
-N- C(Rβ) -N- S(0)2 V and R^ ;
R3 is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-R4, -Z-X-R4, -Z-X'-Y-R^ -Z-X'-Y-X'-Y-R4, and
-Z-X'-R5; p is an integer from 0 to 3; m is 0 or 1, with the proviso that when m is 1, p is 0 or 1; X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R13)-alkylene- and -CH(R13)-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)0-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-,
-O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-,
-N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-, -O-C(R6)-N(R8)- -C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000049_0001
ected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000049_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-, -C(S)-N(R8)-C(0)-,
Figure imgf000050_0001
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-;
Z is a bond or -O-;
Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R )2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; t is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000050_0002
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R7 is C2.7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, .io alkyl, C2-ι0 alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-iQ alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C3-8 alkylene;
Rπ is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of -CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and -N(R4)-;
A is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N(-Q-R4)-, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
In one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula
VI:
Figure imgf000051_0001
VI wherein:
X is C1-10 alkylene or C2-10 alkenylene;
RA2 and Rβ2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
-N(R9)2; Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
-R4, -X-R4, -X-Y-R4,
-X'-Y-X'-Y-R^ -X'-R5,
-X'-O-NRia-Y'-Rib, and -X"-O-N=C(Rι')(Ri"); R2, R", Ria, Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O)0-2-alkyl,
-S(O)0-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
the total number of atoms in the nng is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000053_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Ria and Rib together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000054_0001
X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(Rι3)-alkylene- and -CH(Rι3)-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-,
-O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-, -O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000054_0002
Figure imgf000055_0001
Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000055_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000055_0003
-C(O)-C(O)-,
-C(O)-C(O)-O-, and
-C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Rc and R are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; Rj is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
- -N|
Figure imgf000056_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =0 and =S; R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C O alkyl, C2-ιo alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
Rio is C3-8 alkylene; Rπ is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; Rι3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of -CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and -N(R4)-;
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0- -,
Figure imgf000056_0002
and -CH2- t
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C,(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-0-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
In one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula VH:
Figure imgf000057_0001
vπ wherein:
X is CMO alkylene or C2-10 alkenylene; RA and Rβ3, when taken together, form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups, or substituted by one R3 group, or substituted by one R3 group and one R group; or when taken together, RA3 and Rβ3 form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; Ri is selected from the group consisting of: -R4, -X -R ,
-X'-Y-R4, -X'-Y-X'-Y-R^
-X'-R5,
-X"-O-NRia-Y'-Rib, and -X"-O-N=C(Rι')(Rι");
Ria, Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino,
-S(O)o-2-alkyl, -S(O)o-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000059_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000059_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Ria and Ri together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of: -N- C(Rβ) ~N- S(0)2 X and ; R3 is selected from the group consisting of:
-Z-R4, -Z-X'-Rq,
-Z-X'-Y-R4, -Z-X-Y-X-Y-R4, and -Z-X*-R5; X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(Rι )-alkylene- and -CH(Rι3)-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-,
-C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-0-C(R6)-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000060_0001
Figure imgf000061_0001
Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000061_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-
-C(S)-N(R8)-, -C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-, -C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-, -C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000061_0003
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Z is a bond or -O-; Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000062_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Cι_ιo alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl; R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
Rϋ is d-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and -N(R )-;
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N(-Q-R -, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
In one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula VLTa:
Figure imgf000063_0001
VLTa wherein:
X is CMO alkylene or C -10 alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2;
Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
-R4,
-X-R4, -X-Y-R4, -X'-Y-X'-Y-FU,
-X'-R5,
-X"-O-NH-Y'-Rι', and -X"-O-N=C(R1')(R1"); Ri' and R\" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino, -S(O)0-2-alkyl,
-S(O)0-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000065_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9 ; n is an integer from 0 to 4;
X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is -CH(Rι3)-alkylene- or -CH(R13)-alkenylene-; Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)0-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-,
-C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000066_0001
ected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O>, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000066_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(0)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000066_0003
-C(O)-C(O)- -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(-NH)-N(R8)-; Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
R4 is selected from the group consistingof hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino,
(dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000067_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-10 alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl, Ci_io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-d-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
Rii is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, Cι-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; A is selected from the group consisting of-CH -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and
-N(R4)-;
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-, -N^Q-Rt)-, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(Re)-, -S(O) -, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(0)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-; V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and
-S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
In one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula VHb:
Figure imgf000068_0001
VLTb wherein:
X is CMO alkylene or C2-1o alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; n is an integer from 0 to 4; Ri is selected from the group consisting of: -R4,
-X-R4, -X'-Y-R ,
Figure imgf000069_0001
-X'-R5, -X"-O-NH-Y'-Rι', and
-X"-O-N=C(Rι')(Rι"); Ri' and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino,
-S(O)0-2-alkyl, -S(O)o-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000070_0001
π π wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000070_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9;
X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is -CH(R13)-alkylene- or -CH(R13)-alkenylene-; Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)0-2-,
-S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-,
-C(R6)-O-,
-O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-O-,
-N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000071_0001
lected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000071_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000072_0001
o
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-;
Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; Rt is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
-
Figure imgf000072_0002
R is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, CMO alkyl, C2-1o alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci.io alkylenyl, and aryl-d-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
Rϋ is d-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
Rι is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of-CH -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o-2-, and -N(R4 ; A* is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-, -N(-Q-R -, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(0)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R< -O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O) -; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
hi one aspect, the present invention provides compounds of the following Formula Vm:
Figure imgf000073_0001
vm wherein: RA2 and Rβ2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
-N(R9)2; X is Ci-io alkylene or C -10 alkenylene; Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
-R4, -X'-R4,
-X'-Y-R4,
-X'-Y-X'-Y-R^ -X'-Rs,
-X"-O-NRia-Y'-Rib, and
-X"-O-N=C(Rι')(Rι"); R2, R", Rla, Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino,
-S(O)o-2-alkyl,
-S(O)0-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000076_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000076_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Ria and Rib together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
-N- C(R6) -N- S(0)2 and .
X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(Rι3)-alkylene- and
-CH(Rι3)-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally inteπupted by one or more -O- groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)0-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-„ -O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000076_0003
Figure imgf000077_0001
ected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-; -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000077_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000077_0003
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000078_0001
.
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, CMO alkyl, C2-ι0 alkenyl,
Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
Rϋ is d-6 alkylene or C -6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; Rι3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of -CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N(-Q-R4)-, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(0)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
Certain embodiments of the present invention include non-interfering substituents. For example, in certain embodiments, R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substitutent, and in certain embodiments, R"1 is a non-interfering substituent.
Herein, "non-interfering" means that the ability of the compound or salt, which includes a non-interfering substituent, to modulate (e.g., induce or inhibit) the biosynthesis of one or more cytokines is not destroyed by the non-interfering substitutent. Illustrative non-interfering R' groups include those described herein for Ri . Illustrative non- interfering R'" groups include those described herein for R and R .
As used herein, the terms "alkyl", "alkenyl", "alkynyl" and the prefix "alk-" are inclusive of both straight chain and branched chain groups and of cyclic groups, i.e. cycloalkyl and cycloalkenyl. Unless otherwise specified, these groups contain from 1 to 20 carbon atoms, with alkenyl groups containing from 2 to 20 carbon atoms, and alkynyl groups containing from 2 to 20 carbon atoms. In some embodiments, these groups have a total of up to 10 carbon atoms, up to 8 carbon atoms, up to 6 carbon atoms, or up to 4 carbon atoms. Cyclic groups can be monocyclic or polycyclic and preferably have from 3 to 10 ring carbon atoms. Exemplary cyclic groups include cyclopropyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, adamantyl, and substituted and unsubstituted bornyl, norbornyl, and norbornenyl. Unless otherwise specified, "alkylene", "alkenylene", and "alkynylene" are the divalent forms of the "alkyl", "alkenyl", and "alkynyl" groups defined above. The terms, "alkylenyl", "alkenylenyl", and "alkynylenyl" are use when "alkylene", "alkenylene", and "alkynylene", respectively, are substituted. For example, an arylalkylenyl group comprises an alkylene moiety to which an aryl group is attached.
The term "haloalkyl" is inclusive of groups that are substituted by one or more halogen atoms, including perfluorinated groups. This is also true of other groups that include the prefix "halo-". Examples of suitable haloalkyl groups are chloromethyl, trifluoromethyl, and the like. The term "aryl" as used herein includes carbocyclic aromatic rings or ring systems.
Examples of aryl groups include phenyl, naphthyl, biphenyl, fluorenyl and indenyl.
Unless otherwise indicated, the term "heteroatom" refers to the atoms O, S, or N. The term "heteroaryl" includes aromatic rings or ring systems that contain at least one ring heteroatom (e.g., O, S, N). Suitable heteroaryl groups include furyl, thienyl, pyridyl, quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, triazolyl, pynolyl, tetrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl, benzofuranyl, benzothiophenyl, carbazolyl, benzoxazolyl, pyrimidinyl, benzimidazolyl, quinoxalinyl, benzothiazolyl, naphthyridinyl, isoxazolyl, isothiazolyl, purinyl, quinazolinyl, pyrazinyl, 1-oxidopyridyl, pyridazinyl, triazinyl, tetrazinyl, oxadiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, imidazoquinolinyl, and so on. The term "heterocyclyl" includes non-aromatic rings or ring systems that contain at least one ring heteroatom (e.g., O, S, N) and includes all of the fully saturated and partially unsaturated derivatives of the above mentioned heteroaryl groups. Exemplary heterocyclic groups include pynolidinyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, mo holinyl, thiomorpholinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, thiazolidinyl, imidazolidinyl, isothiazolidinyl, tetrahydropyranyl, quinuclidinyl, homopiperidinyl (azepanyl), homopiperazinyl (diazepanyl), 1,3-dioxolanyl, aziridinyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(lH)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(lH)-yl, dihydroquinolin- (2H)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-lH-imidazolyl, and the like. When "heterocyclyl" contains a nitrogen atom, the point of attachment of the heterocyclyl group may be the nitrogen atom. The terms "arylene," "heteroarylene," and "heterocyclylene" are the divalent forms of the "aryl," "heteroaryl," and "heterocyclyl" groups defined above. The terms, "arylenyl", "heteroarylenyl", and "heterocyclylenyl" are used when "arylene," "heteroarylene," and "heterocyclylene", respectively, are substituted. For example, an alkylarylenyl group comprises an arylene moiety to which an alkyl group is attached.
When a group (or substituent or variable) is present more than once in any Formula described herein, each group (or substituent or variable) is independently selected, whether explicitly stated or not. For example, for the formula -C(O)-N(R8)2 each R8 group is independently selected. In another example, when an Ri and an R3 group both contain an Ri group, each group is independently selected, hi a further example, when more than one Y group is present (i.e., Ri and R3 both contain a Y group) and each Y group contains one or more R groups, then each Y group is independently selected, and each R7 group is independently selected.
The invention is inclusive of the compounds described herein in any of their phannaceutically acceptable forms, including isomers (e.g., diastereomers and enantiomers), salts, solvates, polymorphs, and the like. In particular, if a compound is optically active, the invention specifically includes each of the compound's enantiomers as well as racemic mixtures of the enantiomers. It should be understood that the term "compound" includes any or all of such forms, whether explicitly stated or not (although at times, "salts" are explicitly stated).
For any of the compounds presented herein, each one of the following variables (e.g., R, R', R", Ri, R2, R3, RA, RB, RAI, RBI, RA2, RB2, RAS, RB3, n, m, p, X, Y, Y', Z, and so on) in any of its embodiments can be combined with any one or more of the other variables in any of their embodiments and associated with any one of the formulas described herein, as would be understood by one of skill in the art. Each of the resulting combinations of variables is an embodiment of the present invention. In some embodiments, R is selected from the group consisting of halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2. hi some embodiments, R is selected from the group consisting of halogen and hydroxy. hi some embodiments, R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent. In some embodiments, R1 is selected from the group consisting of -R4, -X'-Ri, -X'-Y-R , -X'-Y-X'-Y-R4, -X'-R5, -X'-O-NH-Y'-R!', and -X^O-N^^ OR.!"). In some embodiments, R' is selected from the group consisting of -R , -X'-R , -X'-Y-Rt, -X'-Y-X'-Y-R4, -X'-R5, -X'-O-NR -Y'-Rib, and -X"-O-N-C(R1')(Rι"). hi some embodiments, Ri is selected from the group consisting of -R^, -X'-R^ -X-YTI4, -X'-Y-X'-Y-Rj, -X'-R5, -X'-O-NRia-Y'-Rib, and
Figure imgf000082_0001
In some embodiments, Ri is selected from the group consisting of -R4, -X'-R4, -X-Y-R4, -X'-Y-X'-Y-R4, -X'-R5, -X"-O-NH-Y'-Ri*, and -X"-O-N=C(R1*)(R1").
In some embodiments, Ri is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkylenyl, -X'-Y-R4, and -X'-R5. In some embodiments, Ri is 2-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or -X'-Y-R^ In some embodiments, i is 2-methylpropyl or -X'-Y-R^ In some embodiments, Ri is Cι-6 alkyl or hydroxy-Cι-6 alkyl. In some embodiments, Ri is 2- methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or butyl, hi some embodiments, R\ is 2- methylpropyl or 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl. In some embodiments, Ri is 2-methyl-2- [(methylsulfonyl)amino]propyl or 4-[(methylsulfonyl)amino]butyl.
In some embodiments, Rιa, Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, as well as alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O)o-2-alkyl, -S(O)0-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl. hi some embodiments, Rla, Ri , Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, as well as alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino, -S(O)o-2-alkyl, -S(O)o-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, :NH-S(O) -aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl. hi some embodiments, R and Ri" are the same as R2 and R" (discussed below), hi some embodiments, i and R^' can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000083_0001
h some embodiments, Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
X R ~\ A'
^Rl 1 π wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000083_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9. hi some embodiments, Rιa and Rib together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
-N- C(R6) -N- S(0)2
^ 7 and ^ R 77 . In some embodiments, Rla is hydrogen. hi some embodiments, R2 and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, as well as alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy (i.e., hydroxyl), alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O)o-2-alkyl, -S(O)0-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano (i.e., nitrile), nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl. Herein, for certain embodiments, this hst of substituents is being referenced when an R2 or R" group is refened to as substituted or optionally substituted.
In some embodiments, R and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, as well as alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy (i.e., hydroxyl), alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino, -S(O)0-2-alkyl, -S(O)0- -aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano (i.e., nitrile), nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8) , -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl. Herein, for certain embodiments, this list of substituents is being referenced when an R2 or R" group is refened to as substituted or optionally substituted. In some embodiments, R2 and R" can join together to form a ring system, hi some embodiments, the ring system is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000084_0001
Preferably the ring system is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000084_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000084_0003
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9. hi some embodiments, the ring system is
Figure imgf000084_0004
In some embodiments, R" or R2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl, wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl are optionally substituted (by this it is meant, substituted by the groups listed above as possible substituents for R2 and R"). In some embodiments, at least one of R" or R2 is alkyl or substituted alkyl. hi some embodiments, at least one of R" or R is alkenyl or substituted alkenyl. In some embodiments, at least one of R" or R2 is aryl, arylalkylenyl, substituted aryl, or substituted arylalkylenyl. hi some embodiments at least one of R" or R2 is heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, substituted heteroaryl, or substituted heteroarylalkylenyl. i some embodiments, at least one of R" or R2 is heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted heterocyclyl, or substituted heterocyclylalkylenyl.
In some embodiments, R2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl, wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl are optionally substituted (by this it is meant, substituted by the groups listed above as possible substituents for R2). hi some embodiments, R2 is alkyl or substituted alkyl. hi some embodiments, R2 is alkenyl or substituted alkenyl. hi some embodiments, R2 is aryl, arylalkylenyl, substituted aryl, or substituted arylalkylenyl. In some embodiments, R is heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, substituted heteroaryl, or substituted heteroarylalkylenyl. hi some embodiments, R2 is heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted heterocyclyl, or substituted heterocyclylalkylenyl.
In some embodiments, at least one of R" or R2 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, cyclopropyl, 2-(ethoxycarbonyl)cyclopropyl, propyl, butyl, 2- methylpropyl, tert-butyl, cyclopentyl, 2-cyclopentylethyl, acetoxymethyl, (ethoxycarbonyl)methyl, furyl, furfuryl, cyclohexyl, tefrahydrofuranyl, 2-(methylthio)ethyl, phenyl, 2-methylphenyl, 3 -methylphenyl, 4-methylphenyl, 2-methoxyphenyl, 3- methoxyphenyl, 4-methoxyphenyl, 2,6-dimethoxyphenyl, 2-chlorophenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 4-chlorophenyl, 2-fluorophenyl, 3 -fluorophenyl, 4-fluorophenyl, 2-cyanophenyl, 3- cyanophenyl, 4-cyanophenyl, 4-(dimethylamino)phenyl, 3-hydroxy-4-methoxyphenyl, 4- acetamidophenyl, 4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl, 4-trifluoromethylphenyl, phenyhnethyl, phenoxymethyl, 1 -phenylethyl, 2-phenylethyl, 2-phenylethenyl, biphenyl, 2-pyridyl, 3- pyridyl, 4-pyridyl, l-methylpynol-2-yl, l-methylimidazol-2-yl, l-methylimidazol-4-yl, 3- cyclohexen-1-yl, 3,4-dihydro-2H-pyran-2-yl, 2-thienyl, 3 -thienyl, thien-2-ylmethyl, thiazol-2-yl, 5-isoxazolyl, quinolin-2-yl, quinolin-3-yl, quinolin-4-yl, l-methylindol-2-yl, l-methylindol-3-yl, hydroxymethyl, 3,4-difluorophenyl, 3-chloro-4-fluorophenyl, 3,4- dichlorophenyl, 4-hydroxyphenyl, 2-hydroxyethyl, 1-hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxy-2- methylpropyl, heptyl, and pynol-3-yl. hi some embodiments, at least one of R" or R2 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, cyclopropyl, 2-(ethoxycarbonyl)cyclopropyl, propyl, butyl, 2- methylpropyl, tert-butyl, cyclopentyl, 2-cyclopentylethyl, acetoxymethyl,
(ethoxycarbonyl)methyl, furyl, furfuryl, cyclohexyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-(methylthio)ethyl, phenyl, 2-methylphenyl, 3 -methylphenyl, 4-methylphenyl, 2-methoxyphenyl, 3- methoxyphenyl, 4-methoxyphenyl, 2,6-dimethoxyphenyl, 2-chlorophenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 4-chlorophenyl, 2-fluorophenyl, 3 -fluorophenyl, 4-fluorophenyl, 2-cyanophenyl, 3- cyanophenyl, 4-cyanophenyl, 4-(dimethylamino)phenyl, 3-hydroxy-4-methoxyphenyl, 4- acetamidophenyl, 4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl, 4-trifluoromethylphenyl, phenylmethyl, phenoxymethyl, 1 -phenylethyl, 2-phenylethyl, 2-phenylethenyl, biphenyl, 2-pyridyl, 3- pyridyl, 4-pyridyl, l-methylpynol-2-yl, l-methylimidazol-2-yl, l-methylimidazol-4-yl, 3- cyclohexen-1-yl, 3,4-dihydro-2H-pyran-2-yl, 2-thienyl, 3-thienyl, thien-2-ylmethyl, thiazol-2-yl, 5-isoxazolyl, and quinolin-2-yl. hi some embodiments, R2 and R" are independently C1-10 alkyl. In some embodiments, at least one of R" or R2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl. hi some embodiments, R2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl. In some embodiments, R2 and R" are each methyl. In some embodiments, at least one of R" or R2 is hydrogen. In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas ma and IVa, R" is hydrogen. hi some embodiments, R2 is C1-4 alkyl. hi some embodiments, R" is hydrogen or C1- alkyl. In some embodiments, R" is C1-4 alkyl. In some embodiments, R2 is hydrogen or C1- alkyl. hi some embodiments, R'" is a non-interfering substituent. In some embodiments,
R'" is R3. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula HI, R'" is R or R3 when n is 1, R or one R and one R3 when n is 2, or R when n is 3 to 4.
In some embodiments, R is selected from the group consisting of -Z-R4, -Z-X'-R/i, -Z-X-Y-R , -Z-X'-Y-X'-Y-R^ and -Z-X'-R5. In some embodiments, R3 is selected from the group consisting of -Z^ and -Z-X'-Y-Rμ In some embodiments, P is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo.
In some embodiments, Ri is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, or heteroaryl. hi some embodiments, R4 is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, or heteroaryl, wherein alkyl and alkenyl are optionally substituted by aryl or aryloxy and wherein aryl is optionally substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, cyano, and halogen, hi some embodiments, is alkyl or arylalkylenyl. In some embodiments, R4 is selected from the group consisting of aryl or heteroaryl, each of which may be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, hydroxy, cyano, hydroxyalkyl, dialkylamino, and alkoxy. In some embodiments, R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000087_0001
In some embodiments, R5 is
Figure imgf000087_0002
hi some embodiments, R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S. In some embodiments, R6 is =O.
In some embodiments, R7 is C2-7 alkylene. In some embodiments, R7 is ethylene. In some embodiments, R7 is propylene.
In some embodiments, R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-io alkyl, C2-ι0 alkenyl, C1-10 alkoxy-Cι-ι0 alkylenyl, and aryl-d-io alkylenyl. In some embodiments, R8 is hydrogen or methyl. In some embodiments, R8 is hydrogen.
In some embodiments, R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl. In some embodiments, Rι0 is C3-8 alkylene. hi some embodiments, Rio is pentylene.
In some embodiments, Rπ is C3-9 alkylene or C3-9 alkenylene, optionally interrupted by one hetero atom. In some embodiments, Rπ is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom. In some embodiments, Ru is Cι-2 alkylene. In some embodiments, Rπ is methylene; in some embodiments, Ru is ethylene. hi some embodiments, Rι2 is C2-7 alkylene or C2-7 alkenylene, optionally interrupted by one hetero atom. In some embodiments, Rι2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, Cι- alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom. In some embodiments, Rι2 is ethylene.
In some embodiments, R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups. In some embodiments, R13 is hydrogen.
In some embodiments, RA and RB are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or when taken together, RA and Rβ form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R'" groups; or when taken together, RA and RB form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula I, RA and RB are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula I, RA and RB form a fused aryl or heteroaryl ring. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula I, RA and Rβ form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring.
In some embodiments, RAι and RBι are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or when taken together, RAI and RBI form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups, or substituted by one R3 group, or substituted by one R3 group and one R group; or when taken together, RAI and RBI form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula LT, RAI and RBι form a fused benzene ring which is unsubstituted. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula LT, RAI and RBI form a fused pyridine ring which is unsubstituted. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula II, RAI and RBI form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the ring is unsubstituted. In certain of these embodiments the fused saturated ring is a cyclohexene ring. hi some embodiments, RA2 and RB are each independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2. In certain of these embodiments, RA2 and RB2 are each independently alkyl. hi some embodiments, A2 and RB2 are each methyl.
In some embodiments, RA3 and Rβ3, when taken together, form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups, or substituted by one R3 group, or substituted by one R3 group and one R group; or when taken together, RA3 and Rβ3 form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups. In some embodiments, RA3 and RB form a fused benzene ring which is unsubstituted. hi some embodiments, RA3 and RB3 form a fused pyridine ring which is unsubstituted. In some embodiments, RA3 and Rβ3 form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the ring is unsubstituted. In certain of these embodiments the fused saturated ring is a cyclohexene ring.
In some embodiments, Rc and R are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and R can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms. In some embodiments, at least one of Rc or Rd is aryl.
In some embodiments, A is selected from the group consisting of -CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o-2-, and -N^)-. In some embodiments, A is selected from the group consisting of -CH2- and -O-.
In some embodiments, A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-,
Figure imgf000090_0001
and -CH -. hi some embodiments, A' is -CH2-, -O-, or -N(-Q-R )-. In some embodiments, A is -CH2- or -N(-Q-R4)-. In some embodiments, A' is -CH2-. In some embodiments, Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R )-,
-C(R6)-C(R6>, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9 . In some embodiments, Q is a bond or -C(O)-. In some embodiments, Q is selected from the group consisting of -C(O)-, -S(O)2-, and -C(O)-N(R8)-W-. hi some embodiments, V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-. hi some embodiments, V is -N(R8)-C(O)-.
In some embodiments, W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-. In some embodiments, W is selected from the group consisting of a bond and -C(O)-.
In some embodiments, X is Ci-io alkylene or C2-ι0 alkenylene. Preferably, X is Ci-io alkylene or C3-ιo alkenylene. In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of
Formulas a and IVa, X is C1-4 alkylene. In some embodiments, X is methylene. In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula ma and IVa, X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups. In some embodiments, X is alkylene. In some embodiments, X' is ethylene, propylene, or butylene (including isobutylene). hi some embodiments, X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(Rι )- alkylene- and -CH(Rι3)-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups. In some embodiments, particularly in embodiments of Formula ma and IVa, X" is -CH(Rι3)-alkylene- or -CH(Rι3)-alkenylene-. hi some embodiments, Y is selected from the group consisting of -S(O)0- -, -S(0)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-, -O-C(R6)-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000091_0001
In some embodiments, Y is selected from the group consisting of -S(O)o-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-, -O-C(R6)-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000091_0002
hi some embodiments, Y is -N(R8)-C(O)-, -N(R8)-S(O)2-, -N(R8)-S(O)2-N(R8)- -N(R8)-C(O)-N(R8)-, -N(R8)-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000092_0001
In some embodiments, Y is -NH-C(O)-, -NH-S(O)2-, -NH-S(O)2-N(R8)-, -NH-C(O)-N(R8)-, -NH-C(O)-NH-C(O)-, or
- NH- C(O)— N X
In some embodiments, Y' is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-
-C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000092_0002
-C(O)-O-, -C(O)-N(R8)-, -C(S)-N(R8)-, -C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2- -C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-, -C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000092_0003
^- Rl° , -C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-. hi some embodiments, Y' is selected from the group consisting of -C(O)-, -S(O)2-, and
-C(O)-N(R8)-. hi some embodiments, Z is a bond or Z is a bond or -O-. hi some embodiments, Z is a bond, hi some embodiments, Z is -O-. hi some embodiments, a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7. In some embodiments, a and b are each 2. hi some embodiments, n is an integer from 0 to 4. In some embodiments, n is 0 or
1. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula LVa, n is 0. In some embodiments, n is 1. hi some embodiments, n is 2. In some embodiments, n is 3 or 4.
In some embodiments m is 0 or 1. In some embodiments, m is 0. In some embodiments, m is 1. hi some embodiments, p is an integer from 0 to 3. In some embodiments, p is 0 or
1. hi some embodiments p is 0.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula ma, both n and m are
0. In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula V, both m and p are 0. In some embodiments, n is 0, m is 0, or both n and m are 0. In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula ma, m is 0 or 1; with the proviso that when m is 1 , then n is 0 or 1. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula V, m is 0 or 1, with the proviso that when m is 1 , p is 0 or 1. In some embodiments, X is Cι-4 alkylene; R2 is C1-4 alkyl; R" is hydrogen or
-4 alkyl; and Ri is C1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-Cι-6 alkyl.
In some embodiments, X is Cι-4 alkylene; R" is C1-4 alkyl; R2 is hydrogen or C1-4 alkyl; and Ri is Cι-6 alkyl or hydroxy-Cι-6 alkyl. hi some embodiments, X is methylene; at least one of R" or R2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl; and Ri is 2-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or butyl. hi some embodiments, X is methylene; R" and R are methyl; and Ri is 2- methylpropyl or 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl. hi some embodiments, X is Cι- alkylene; R" is Cι-4 alkyl; R2 is hydrogen or Cι-4 alkyl; Ri is Cι-6 alkyl or hydroxy-Cι-6 alkyl; and n and m are 0.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula ma, X is C1-4 alkylene; R" is hydrogen or C1-4 alkyl; R2 is C1-4 alkyl; Ri is C1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-C1-6 alkyl; and n and m are 0.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula VI, X is C1-4 alkylene; R2 is C1- alkyl; R" is hydrogen or C1-4 alkyl; Ri is C1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-C1-6 alkyl; and
R 2 and Rβ2 are each methyl.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula VI, X is C1-4 alkylene; R" is C1- alkyl; R2' is hydrogen or C1-4 alkyl; Ri is C1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-Cι_6 alkyl; and RA2 and Rβ2 are each methyl. In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula V, X is CM alkylene;
R2 is Cι- alkyl; R" is hydrogen or C1-4 alkyl; Ri is C1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-C1-6 alkyl; and p and m are 0.
In some embodiments, X is C1-4 alkylene; R2 is C1- alkyl; R" is hydrogen or C1-4 alkyl; Ri is C1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-C1-6 alkyl; and n is 0. In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula V, X is
C1-4 alkylene;R" is C1-4 alkyl; R2 is hydrogen or C1-4 alkyl; Ri is C1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-C1-6 alkyl; and p and m are 0.
In some embodiments, X is d- alkylene; R" is C1-4 alkyl; R2 is hydrogen or C1- alkyl; Ri is C1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-d-6 alkyl; and n is 0. hi some embodiments, X is methylene; at least one of R" or R2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl; Ri is 2-methylpropyl; 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or butyl; and n and m are 0.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula V, X is methylene; at least one of R" or R is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl; R\ is 2- methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or butyl; and p and m are 0. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula V, X is methylene; R" and R2 are methyl; Ri is 2-methylpropyl or 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl; and p and m are 0.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula VI, X is methylene; R2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl; Ri is 2-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2- methylpropyl, or butyl; and RA2 and Rβ2 are each methyl. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula VI, X is methylene;
R" and R2 are methyl; Ri is 2-methylpropyl or 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl; and RA2 and Rβ2 are each methyl. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula ma, X is methylene; R2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl; Ri is 2-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2- methylpropyl, or butyl; and n and m are 0.
In some embodiments, X is methylene; R" and R2 are methyl; Ri is 2-methylρroρyl or 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl; and n and m are 0.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula a, X is methylene; R" and R are methyl; Ri is 2-methylpropyl; and n and m are 0. In some embodiments, Ri is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkylenyl, -X'-Y-R^ and -X'-R5; wherein X' is alkylene; Y is -N(R8)-C(O)-, -N(R8)-S(O)2-, -N(R8)-S(O)2-N(R8)-, -N(R8)-C(O)-N(R8)-, -N(R8)-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000094_0001
; is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, or heteroaryl, wherein alkyl and alkenyl are optionally substituted by aryl or aryloxy and wherein aryl is optionally substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, cyano, and halogen; and R5 is
-N- C(R6)
Figure imgf000095_0001
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas ma and LVa, Ri is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkylenyl, -X'-Y-R^ and -X'-R5; wherein X* is alkylene; Y is -N(R8)-C(O)-, -N(R8)-S(O)2-, -N(R8)-S(O)2-N(R8)-, -N(R8)-C(O)-N(R8)-, -N(R8)-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000095_0002
; R is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, or heteroaryl;
^(CH2)a -N- C(R6) -N- S(0)2 _N(R8) _C(0)_N and R5 is R? , R? , or (CH^--7 hi some embodiments, Ri is 2-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or -X'-Y-R^ X' is ethylene, propylene, or butylene; Y is -NH-C(O)-, -NH-S(O)2-, -NH-S(O)2-N(R8)-, -NH-C(O)-N(R8)-, -NH-C(O)-NH-C(O)-, or
Figure imgf000095_0003
; and R8 is hydrogen or methyl. hi some embodiments, Ri is 2-methylpropyl or -X'-Y-R^ X' is ethylene, propylene, or butylene; Y is -NH-C(O)-, -NH-S(O)2-, -NH-S(O)2-N(R8)-, -NH-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-NH-C(O)-NH-C(O)-, or
- NH- C(O)— N X
; and R8 is hydrogen or methyl. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula HI, R' is selected from the group consisting of:
-R4, (
Figure imgf000095_0004
-X'-Y-RA,
-X'-Y-X-Y-RJ, -X*-R5,
Figure imgf000096_0001
wherein: X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is -CH(R13)-alkylene- or -CH(R13)-alkenylene-; Y is selected from the group consisting of:
-S(O)o-2-,
-S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-,
-C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-O-,
-N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000096_0002
Figure imgf000097_0001
Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000097_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000097_0003
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Ri' and Ri" are the same as R2 and R"; R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be imsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo; R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
-
Figure imgf000098_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, CMO alkyl, C2-ιo alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-d-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C -8 alkylene;
3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(Rδ)-,
Figure imgf000098_0002
-S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula HI, R'" is R or R3 when n is 1 , R or one R and one R3 when n is 2, or R when n is 3 to 4; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2;
R3 is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-R4, -Z-X-R4, -Z-X-Y-R4, -Z-X'-Y-X'-Y-R4, and
-Z-X'-R5; n is an integer from 0 to 4; Z is a bond or -O-;
X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; Y is selected from the group consisting of:
-S(O)o-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-,
-C(R6)-O-,
-O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C^-N^R,)-,
Figure imgf000099_0001
Figure imgf000100_0001
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000100_0002
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R7 is C2-7 alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C O alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl,
Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C3-8 alkylene; A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(0)-, -S(O)0-2-, and -N(R4)-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and ~C(R6)-N(OR9)-; V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and
-S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7. i some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas ma and IVa, R2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl, wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl are optionally substituted with one or more substituents defined above in the definition of
R2- In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas a and LVa, R2 is alkyl or substituted alkyl, and R" is hydrogen. hi some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas ma and LVa, R2 and R" are independently alkyl.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas ma and LVa, R is alkenyl or substituted alkenyl, and R" is hydrogen.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas ma and LVa, R2 is aryl, arylalkylenyl, substituted aryl, or substituted arylalkylenyl, and R" is hydrogen.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas ma and LVa, R2 is heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, substituted heteroaryl, or substituted heteroarylalkylenyl, and R" is hydrogen.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas ma and LVa, R2 is heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted heterocyclyl, or substituted heterocyclylalkylenyl, and R" is hydrogen.
In some embodiments, at least one of R" or R2 is alkyl or substituted alkyl, and at least one of R" or R2 is hydrogen. hi some embodiments, at least one of R" or R2 is alkenyl or substituted alkenyl, and at least one of R" or R2 is hydrogen. hi some embodiments, at least one of R" or R is aryl, arylalkylenyl, substituted aryl, or substituted arylalkylenyl, and at least one of R" or R2 is hydrogen. In some embodiments at least one of R" or R2 is heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, substituted heteroaryl, or substituted heteroarylalkylenyl, and at least one of R" or R2 is hydrogen.
In some embodiments, at least one of R" or R2 is heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted heterocyclyl, or substituted heterocyclylalkylenyl, and at least one of R" or R2 is hydrogen.
In some embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas ma and LVa, R2 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, cyclopropyl, 2- (ethoxycarbonyl)cyclopropyl, propyl, butyl, 2-methylpropyl, tert-butyl, cyclopentyl, 2- cyclopentylethyl, acetoxymethyl, (ethoxycarbonyl)methyl, furyl, furfuryl, cyclohexyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-(methylthio)ethyl, phenyl, 2-methylphenyl, 3 -methylphenyl, 4- methylphenyl, 2-methoxyphenyl, 3-methoxyphenyl, 4-methoxyphenyl, 2,6- dimethoxyphenyl, 2-chlorophenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 4-chlorophenyl, 2-fluorophenyl, 3- fluorophenyl, 4-fluorophenyl, 2-cyanophenyl, 3 -cyanophenyl, 4-cyanophenyl, 4- (dimethylamino)phenyl, 3-hydroxy-4-methoxyphenyl, 4-acetamidophenyl, 4- (methoxycarbonyl)phenyl, 4-trifluoromethylphenyl, phenylmethyl, phenoxymethyl, 1- phenylethyl, 2-phenylethyl, 2-phenylethenyl, biphenyl, 2-pyridyl, 3-pyridyl, 4-pyridyl, 1- methylpynol-2-yl, l-methylimidazol-2-yl, l-methylimidazol-4-yl, 3-cyclohexen-l-yl, 3,4- dihydro-2H-pyran-2-yl, 2-thienyl, 3-thienyl, thien-2-ylmethyl, thiazol-2-yl, 5-isoxazolyl, and quinolin-2-yl. In some embodiments, R2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" join together to form a ring system.
In some embodiments, the ring system formed by R2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" is selected from the group consisting of: -11 ^ A'
1 wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000103_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; wherein
Ru is Cι-6 alkylene or C -6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; R1 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C -5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; Rc and Ra are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and R can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; and A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N(-Q-R -, and -CH2-.
In some embodiments, particularly for R2 and R", the ring system is
Figure imgf000103_0002
wherein Rπ is C1-2 alkylene; A' is -CH2-, -O-, or -N(-Q-R )-; Q is a bond or-C(O)-; and Rj is alkyl or arylalkylenyl. In certain of these embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formulas ma and LVa, Rπ is Cι- alkylene; A' is -CH - or -NX-Q-R -; Q is a bond or -C(O)-; and t is alkyl or arylalkylenyl. i some embodiments, the ring system formed by R and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" is selected from the group consisting of
Figure imgf000103_0003
and
Figure imgf000103_0004
Rπ is C3-9 alkylene or C3-9 alkenylene, optionally interrupted by one hetero atom; Rι is C2.7 alkylene or C2-7 alkenylene, optionally interrupted by one hetero atom; Rc and R are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four hetero atoms; and A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-,
Figure imgf000104_0001
and -CH2-.
Preparation of the Compounds
Compounds of the invention can be prepared according to Reaction Scheme I where Ri, R , R, R", X, and n are as defined above, and Hal is chloro, bromo, or iodo. In step (1) of Reaction Scheme I, a quinoline-3,4-diamine of Formula X is reacted with a carboxylic acid or an equivalent thereof to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XI. Suitable equivalents to a carboxylic acid include orthoesters, and 1,1- dialkoxyalkyl alkanoates. The carboxylic acid or equivalent is selected such that it will provide the desired -X-Hal substituent in a compound of Formula XL For example, Hal-X-CO2H or Hal-X-C(O-alkyl)3 will provide a compound with the desired -X-Hal substitutent at the 2-position. The reaction can be run in the absence of solvent or in an inert solvent such as toluene. The reaction is run with sufficient heating to drive off any alcohol or water formed as a byproduct of the reaction. Optionally a catalyst such as pyridine hydrochloride can be included.
Alternatively, step (1) can be carried out by (i) reacting a compound of Formula X with an acyl halide of formula Hal-X-C(O)Cl or Hal-X-C(O)Br and then (ii) cyclizing. In part (i) the acyl halide is added to a solution of a compound of Formula X in an inert solvent such as acetonitrile, pyridine or dichloromethane. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature. A catalyst such as pyridine hydrochloride can be included. Alternatively, the reaction can be carried out in the presence of triethylamine. In part (ii) the product of part (i) is heated in pyridine. The two steps can be combined into a single step when the reaction is run in pyridine or solvents such as dichloromethane or dichloroethane in the presence of triethylamine.
Many compounds of Formula X are known and can be readily prepared using known synthetic routes; see for example, U.S. Patent Nos. 4,689,338 (Gerster), 4,929,624 (Gerster et al.), 5,268,376 (Gerster), 5,389,640 (Gerster et al.), 6,331,539 (Crooks et al.), 6,451,810 (Coleman et al.), 6,541,485 (Crooks et al.) 6,660,747 (Crooks et al.), 6,670,372 (Charles et al.), 6,683,088 (Crooks et al.), 6,656,938 (Crooks et al), and 6,664,264 (Dellaria et al.).
In step (2) of Reaction Scheme I a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XI is oxidized to provide an N-oxide of Formula XII using a conventional oxidizing agent that is capable of forming N-oxides. The reaction can be carried out by treating a solution of a compound of Formula XI in a suitable solvent such as chloroform or dichloromethane with 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid at ambient temperature.
In step (3) of Reaction Scheme I an N-oxide of Formula XLT is aminated to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine of Formula XHI. The reaction is carried out in two parts. In part (i) a compound of Formula XLI is reacted with an acylating agent. Suitable acylating agents include alkyl- or arylsulfonyl chorides (e.g., benzenesulfonyl choride, methanesulfonyl choride, or 7-toluenesulfonyl chloride). In part (ii) the product of part (i) is reacted with an excess of an animating agent. Suitable animating agents include ammonia (e.g. in the form of ammonium hydroxide) and ammonium salts (e.g., ammonium carbonate, ammonium bicarbonate, ammonium phosphate). The reaction can be carried out by dissolving a compound of Formula XfL in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane or chloroform, adding ammonium hydroxide to the solution, and then adding ?-toluenesulfonyl chloride. The product or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. In step (4) of Reaction Scheme I a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine of
Formula Xm is treated with N-hydroxyphthalimide to provide an N-phthalimide-protected lH-imidazo[4,5-e]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula Vila. The reaction is conveniently carried out by adding a base, such as triethylamine, to a solution of N- hydroxyphthalimide in a suitable solvent such as NN-dimethylformamide (DMF); and then adding the lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine of Formula XD3 in a suitable solvent
(for example, DMF) to the resulting mixture. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature. The product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
In step (5) of Reaction Scheme I an N-phthalimide-protected lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula Vila is converted to a lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XLV. Removal of the N-phthalimide protecting group is conveniently carried out by adding hydrazine to a suspension of an N- phthalimide-protected lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula VLTa in a suitable solvent such as ethanol. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature. The product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
In step (6) of Reaction Scheme I, a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XLV is reacted with an aldehyde or ketone of Formula R2C(O)R" to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula Lflb, winch is a subgenus of Formulas I, LT, and ILIa. Numerous aldehydes and ketones of Formula R2C(O)R" are commercially available; others can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding the aldehyde or ketone of Formula R2C(O)R" to a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLV in a suitable solvent such as methanol. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature. The product or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. , Ketones such as acetone, tetrahydro-4H-pyran-4-one, l-acetyl-4-piperidone, l-benzyl-4- piperidone, and l-methyl-4-ρiρeridone can be used in step (6) to make prefened compounds of the invention.
Reaction Scheme I
Figure imgf000107_0001
Compounds of the invention can be prepared according to Reaction Scheme IL where R , P , R8, R, R", Q, X, X', Hal, and n are as defined above, Boc is tert- butoxycarbonyl, and R5a is
Figure imgf000107_0002
wherein V is -N(R8)-C(R6)-. In step (1) of Reaction Scheme E a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl tert-butylcarbamate of Formula XV is treated with N-hydroxyphthalimide to provide an N-phthalimide-protected lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XVI, which is a subgenus of Formulas VLI and Vila. The reaction is conveniently carried out by adding a base, such as triethylamine, to a solution of N-hydroxyphthalimide in a suitable solvent such as DMF; and then adding the lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl tert-butylcarbamate of Formula XV in a suitable solvent (for example, DMF) to the resulting mixture. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature. The product or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. Compounds of Formula XV can be readily prepared using known synthetic routes; see for example, U.S. Patent No. 6,451,485 (Crooks et al.), and 6,660,747 (Crooks et al.) to prepare a quinoline-3,4-diamine that can be treated according to steps (1) to (3) of Reaction Scheme I.
In step (2) of Reaction Scheme LT an N-phthalimide-protected lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XVI is converted to a lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XVLT. Removal of the N-phthalimide protecting group is conveniently carried out by adding hydrazine to a suspension of an N- phthalimide-protected lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XVI in a suitable solvent such as ethanol. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature. The product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
In step (3) of Reaction Scheme LT a lH-imidazo[4,5-e]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XVH is reacted with an aldehyde or ketone of Formula R2C(O)R" to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XVHI, which is a subgenus of Formulas I, LI, HI and a. Numerous aldehydes and ketones of Formula R2C(0)R" are commercially available; others can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods.
The reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding the aldehyde or ketone of Formula R C(O)R" to a solution of the lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XVH in a suitable solvent such as methanol. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature. The product or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. Ketones such as acetone, tetrahydro-4H-pyran-4-one, l-acetyl-4-piperidone, 1- benzyl-4-piperidone, and l-methyl-4-piperidone can be used in this step to make prefened compounds of the invention.
In step (4) of Reaction Scheme H a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XVHI is deprotected to provide an amino group at the 1 -position of a 1H- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XLX. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by dissolving a compound of Formula XVm in a mixture of trifluoro acetic acid and a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature. The product or phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof, including the trifluoroacetate salt, can be isolated using conventional methods. In steps (5) and (5a) of Reaction Scheme H a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XIX is converted to a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]qumolin-2-yl oxime of Formulas XX or XXI, which are subgenera of Formulas I, H, HI, and a, using conventional methods. For example, sulfonamides of Formula XX can be prepared by reacting a compound of Formula XLX with a sulfonyl chloride of Formula R4S(0)2C1. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature in an inert solvent such as chlorofonn or dichloromethane by adding the sulfonyl chloride to a compound of Fonnula XLX in the presence of a base such as NN-diisopropylethylamine, triethylamine, or pyridine. Sulfamides of Formula XX can be prepared by reacting a compound of Formula XIX with a sulfamoyl chloride of Formula R4(R8)ΝS(O)2Cl or with sulfuryl chloride to generate a sulfamoyl chloride in situ, and then reacting the sulfamoyl chloride with an amine of Formula HN(R8)R . The product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. Some sulfamoyl chlorides of Formula R4(R8)NS(O)2Cl and many sulfonyl chlorides of Formula R4S(O)2Cl and amines of Formula HN(R8)R4 are commercially available; others can be prepared using known synthetic methods. In another example shown in step (5a) of Reaction Scheme H, a lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XIX is reacted with a chloroalkanesulfonyl chloride of Formula Cl-R7-S(O)2Cl to provide a compound of Fonnula XXI, wherein R5a is a ring having the structure
Figure imgf000109_0001
The reaction is preferably carried out by adding the chloroalkanesulfonyl chloride to a solution of a compound of Formula XIX in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane in the presence of a base such as triethylamine. The intermediate chloroalkanesulfonamide may optionally be isolated before treatment with a stronger base such as 1,8- diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene (DBU) at ambient temperature. If the intermediate chloroalkanesulfonamide is isolated, the reaction with DBU can be carried out in a suitable solvent such as DMF. The product or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
Amides of Formulas XX and XXI can be prepared from lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XIX using conventional methods. For example, a compound of Formula XIX can be reacted with an acid chloride of Formula R4C(O)Cl to provide a compound of Formula XX. The reaction can be carried out by adding the acid chloride to a solution of a compound of Formula XLX in a suitable solvent such as chloroform, optionally in the presence of a base such as N,N-diisopropylethylamine, triethylamine, or pyridine, at ambient temperature. The product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
In another example shown in step (5a), a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula XIX is reacted with a chloroalkanoyl chloride compound of Formula Cl-R7-C(O)Cl to provide a compound of Formula XXI, wherein R5a is a ring having the structure
Figure imgf000110_0001
The reaction is preferably carried out by adding the chloroalkanoyl chloride compound to a compound of Fonnula XIX in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane in the presence of a base such as N,N-diisopropylethylamine. The intermediate chloroalkanamide may optionally be isolated before treatment with a stronger base such as DBU at ambient temperature. If the intermediate chloroalkanamide is isolated, the reaction with DBU can be carried out in a suitable solvent such as DMF. The product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
Ureas and thioureas of Formulas XX and XXI can be prepared from liJ- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oximes of Formula XLX using conventional methods. For example, a compound of Formula XIX can be reacted with an isocyanate of Formula
R4Ν=C=O. The reaction can be carried out by adding the isocyanate to a solution of a compound of Formula XLX in a suitable solvent such as chloroform, optionally in the presence of a base such as NN-diisopropylethylamine, or triethylamine, at ambient temperature. Alternatively, a compound of Formula XLX can be reacted with a thioisocyanate of Formula R4Ν=C=S, a sulfonyl isocyanate of Formula R S(O)2N=C=O or a carbamoyl chloride of Formula R4N(R8)C(O)Cl. The product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
Figure imgf000111_0001
Compounds of the invention can be prepared according to Reaction Scheme HI where R2, R", and n are as defined above; Xc is CMO alkylene; P is a removable protecting group, such as an alkanoyloxy group (e.g., acetoxy) or an aroyloxy group (e.g., benzoyloxy); RB is selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkyl, alkoxy, -N(R9)2; and Ric is a subset of Ri as defined above, which does not include those groups that one skilled in the art would recognize as being susceptible to reduction in step (5). These groups include, for example, alkenyl, alkynyl, and aryl groups, and groups bearing nitro and -S- substitutents. In step (1) of Reaction Scheme HI a quinoline-3,4-diamine of Formula Xa is reacted with a carboxylic acid of the formula, HO-X-CO H, with a trialkyl orthoester of the formula, HO-X-C(O-Cι- alkyl)3, or with a combination thereof (wherein "alkyl" is a straight or branched chain) to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl alcohol of Formula XXH. The reaction is run with sufficient heating to drive off any alcohol or water formed as a byproduct of the reaction. Optionally a catalyst such as pyridine hydrochloride can be included. Compounds of Formula Xa are a subset of compounds of Formula X, which are shown in Reaction Scheme I. hi step (2) of Reaction Scheme HI, the hydroxyl group of a lH-imidazo[4,5- cjquinoline of Formula XXH is protected with a removable protecting group such as an alkanoyloxy group (e.g., acetoxy) or aroyloxy group (e.g., benzoyloxy) to provide a 1H- imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline of Fonnula XXDL. Suitable protecting groups and reactions for their placement and removal are well known to those skilled in the art. See, for example, U.S. Patent No. 4,689,338 (Gerster), Examples 115 and 120 and 5,389,640 (Gerster et al.), Examples 2 and 3.
For some embodiments, it is possible to combine steps (1) and (2) when an acid chloride of the Formula PO-X-CO2Cl is used under the conditions of step (1). Some acid chlorides of this type, for example, acetoxyacetyl chloride, are commercially available.
In step (3) of Reaction Scheme HI, a lH-imidazo [4, 5 -cjquinoline of Formula XXLfl is oxidized to provide an N-oxide of Formula XXLV using a conventional oxidizing agent that is capable of forming N-oxides. The reaction can be carried out by treating a solution of a compound of Formula XXfH in a suitable solvent such as chloroform or dichloromethane with 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid at ambient temperature.
In step (4) of Reaction Scheme m, an N-oxide of Formula XXLV is aminated and the protecting group removed to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine of
Formula XXV. The animation reaction is carried out in two parts, hi part (i) a compound of Formula XXLV is reacted with an acylating agent. Suitable acylating agents include alkyl- or arylsulfonyl chorides (e.g., benzenesulfonyl choride, methanesulfonyl choride, or >-toluenesulfonyl chloride). In part (ii) the product of part (i) is reacted with an excess of an animating agent. Suitable aminating agents include ammonia (e.g. in the form of ammonium hydroxide) and ammonium salts (e.g., ammonium carbonate, ammonium bicarbonate, ammonium phosphate). The reaction can be carried out by dissolving a compound of Formula XXLV in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane or chloroform, adding ammonium hydroxide to the solution, and then adding -toluenesulfonyl chloride. The protecting group is removed by using conventional methods. The product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. In step (5) of Reaction Scheme ffl a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine of Formula XXV is reduced to provide a 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4- amine of Formula XXVI. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by suspending or dissolving a compound of Formula XXV in ethanol, adding a catalytic amount of rhodium on carbon, and hydrogenating. Alternatively, the reaction can be carried out by suspending or dissolving a compound of Formula XXV in trifluoroacetic acid, and adding platinum(LV) oxide, and hydrogenating. The reaction can be carried out in a Pan apparatus. The product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. In step (6) of Reaction Scheme LH a 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-
4-amine of Formula XXVI is treated with N-hydroxyphthalimide under Mitsunobu reaction conditions to provide an N-phthalimide-protected 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula VHc. The reaction is conveniently carried out by adding triphenylphosphine and N-hydroxyphthalimide to a solution of a compound of Formula XXVI in a suitable solvent such as tetrahydrofuran or DMF, and then slowly adding diethyl azodicarboxylate or diisopropyl azodicarboxylate. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature or at an elevated temperature, such as 60 °C. The product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. Alternatively, step (6) may be carried out in two parts by (i) converting the hydroxy group in a compound of Formula XXVI to a leaving group and (ii) displacing the leaving group with N-hydroxyphthalimide in the presence of a base. Part (i) of step (6) is conveniently carried out by treating the hydroxy-substituted 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine of Formula XXVI with thionyl chloride in a suitable solvent such as 1,2-dichloroethane. The reaction may be carried out at ambient temperature, and the product may be isolated by conventional methods. Part (iϊ) of step (6) can be carried out under the conditions described in step (4) of Reaction Scheme I, and the product of Formula VHc or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. hi step (7) of Reaction Scheme HI an N-phthalimide-protected 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula VHc is converted to a 6,7,8,9- tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XX VH. Removal of the N-phthalimide protecting group is conveniently carried out by adding hydrazine to a suspension of an N-phthalimide-protected 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin- 2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula VHc in a suitable solvent such as ethanol. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature. The product or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
In step (8) of Reaction Scheme m a 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin- 2-yl hydroxylamine of Formula XXVH is reacted with an aldehyde or ketone of Formula R2C(O)R" to provide a 6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula LVb as in step (3) of Reaction Scheme H. The product or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
Figure imgf000115_0001
Compounds of the invention can be prepared according to Reaction Scheme LV where Ri, R2, R, R", and X are as defined above, hal is bromo or iodo, p is 0 to 3, and R3a is - ft, -X'a-R^ -XVY-R4, or -XVR5; where X'a is alkenylene; X'b is arylene, heteroarylene, and alkenylene interrupted or terminated by arylene or heteroarylene; R^ is aryl or heteroaryl where the aryl or heteroaryl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted as defined in R above; and R4, R5, and Y are as defined above. In step (1) of Reaction Scheme LV a halogen substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula fflc is coupled with a boronic acid of the formula R3a-B(OH)2 (or the conesponding anhydride or esters, R3a-B(O-alkyl)25 thereof) using Suzuki coupling conditions to provide a 17J- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oxime of Formula Hid. A compound of Formula LHc is combined with a boronic acid of the formula R3a-B(OH)2 or an ester or anhydride thereof in the presence of palladium (H) acetate, triphenylphosphine and abase such as aqueous sodium carbonate in a suitable solvent such as 7*-propanol or n-propanol and water. The reaction can be canied out at an elevated temperature (e.g., 80 °C-100 °C). The product or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. Halogen substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl oximes of Formula mc can be prepared as described above in steps (l)-(6) of Reaction Scheme I or steps (1) - (5) or (5a) or Reaction Scheme H, wherein one of the R groups is hal. Numerous boronic acids of Formula R3a-B(OH)2, anhydrides thereof, and boronic acid esters of Formula R3a-B(O-alkyl)2 are commercially available; others can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods.
Reaction Scheme LV
Figure imgf000116_0001
Compounds of the invention can be prepared according to Reaction Scheme V where Rl5 R2, R", R, X, and Hal, are as defined above; E is carbon (imidazoquinoline ring) or nitrogen (imidazonaphthyridine ring); n is an integer from 0 to 4 (imidazoquinoline ring) or 0 to 3 (imidazonaphthyridine ring) with the proviso that when m is 1, then n is 0 or 1; and D is -Br, -I, or -OCH2Ph; wherein Ph is phenyl. hi step (1) of Reaction Scheme V, an aniline or aminopyridine of Formula XXVHI is heated with the condensation product generated from 2,2-dimethyl-l,3-dioxane-4,6-dione (Meldrum's acid) and triethyl orthoformate to provide an imine of Formula XXIX. The reaction is conveniently carried out by adding a solution of an aniline or aminopyridine of Formula XXVm to a heated mixture of Meldrum's acid and triethyl orthoformate and heating the reaction at an elevated temperature. The product can be isolated using conventional methods. Many anilines and aminopyridines of Formula XXVLH are commercially available; others can be prepared by known synthetic methods. For example, benzyloxypyridines of Formula XXVIH can be prepared using the method of Holladay et al, Biorg. Med. Chem. Lett., 8, pp. 2797-2802, (1998). In step (2) of Reaction Scheme V, an imine of Formula XXLX undergoes thermolysis and cyclization to provide a compound of Formula XXX. The reaction is conveniently carried out in a medium such as DOWTHERM A heat transfer fluid at a temperature of 200 °C to 250 °C. The product can be isolated using conventional methods. Isomers of the compound of Formula XX VIH or Formula XXX, wherein E is nitrogen, can also be synthesized and can be used to prepare compounds of the invention.
In step (3) of Reaction Scheme V, a compound of Formula XXX is nitrated under conventional nitration conditions to provide a compound of Formula XXXI. The reaction is conveniently carried out by adding nitric acid to the compound of Formula XXX in a suitable solvent such as propionic acid and heating the mixture at an elevated temperature. The product can be isolated using conventional methods.
In step (4) of Reaction Scheme V, a 3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridin-4-ol or 3- nitroquinolin-4-ol of Formula XXXI is chlorinated using conventional chlorination chemistry to provide a 4-chloro-3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridine or 4-chloro-3-nitroquinoline of Formula XXXH. The reaction is conveniently carried out by treating the compound of Formula XXXI with phosphorous oxychloride in a suitable solvent such as DMF. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature or at an elevated temperature such as 100 °C, and the product can be isolated using conventional methods.
The 4-chloro-3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridine of Formula XXXH wherein m and n are both 0 is known and can be readily prepared using a known synthetic route; see for example, U.S. Patent No. 6,194,425 (Gerster et al.).
In step (5) of Reaction Scheme V, a 4-chloro-3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridine or 4- chloro-3-nitroquinoline of Formula XXXH is treated with an amine of Formula Rι-NH2 to provide a compound of Formula XXXtH. Several amines of Formula Rι-NH2 are commercially available; others can be prepared by known synthetic methods. The reaction is conveniently carried out by adding the amine of Formula Rι-NH2 to a solution of the 4- chloro-3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridine or 4-chloro-3-nitroquinoline of Formula XXXH in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane in the presence of a tertiary amine such as triethylamine. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature or at a sub-ambient temperature such as, for example, 0 °C. The reaction product can be isolated using conventional methods. hi step (6) of Reaction Scheme V, a compound of Formula XXXLfl is reduced to provide a diamine of Formula XXXLV. The reaction can be carried out by hydrogenation using a heterogeneous hydrogenation catalyst such as palladium on carbon or platinum on carbon. The hydrogenation is conveniently carried out in a Pan apparatus in a suitable solvent such as toluene, methanol, acetonitrile, or ethyl acetate. For compounds of the Formula XXXm wherein m is 1 and D is -OCH2Ph, the prefened catalyst is platinum on carbon. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature, and the product can be isolated using conventional methods.
Alternatively, the reduction in step (6) can be carried out using nickel boride, prepared in situ from sodium borohydride and nickel(H) chloride. The reduction is conveniently carried out by adding a solution of a compound of Formula XXXm in a suitable solvent or solvent mixture such as dichloromethane/methanol to a mixture of excess sodium borohydride and catalytic nickel(H) chloride in methanol. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature. The product can be isolated using conventional methods. hi step (7) of Reaction Scheme V, a diamine of Formula XXXLV, is reacted with a carboxylic acid equivalent to provide a lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine or 1H- imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XXXV. The carboxylic acid or equivalent is selected such that it will provide the desired -X-Hal substituent in a compound of Formula XXXV and the reaction can be carried out as described in step (1) of Reaction Scheme I. When an acid chloride, for example chloroacetyl chloride, is used as the carboxylic acid equivalent, the reaction can be carried out in two steps. Part (i) of step (7) is conveniently carried out by adding the acid chloride to a solution of a diamine of Fonnula XXXLV in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane, chloroform, or acetonitrile. Optionally, a tertiary amine such as triethylamine, pyridine, or 4-dimethylaminopyridine can be added. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature. The amide product or the salt thereof can be isolated and optionally purified using conventional techniques. Part (ii) of step (7) involves heating the amide prepared in part (i) in the presence of base to provide a \H- imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XXXV. The reaction is conveniently carried out in a suitable solvent such as ethanol in the presence of a base such aqueous sodium hydroxide, aqueous potassium carbonate, or triethylamine at elevated temperature, i some instances, the product of Formula XXXV may be obtained directly from Part (i). Alternatively, a diamine of Formula XXXLV can be treated with ethyl chloroacetimidate hydrochloride as the carboxylic acid equivalent to provide a compound wherein X is methylene. The reaction is carried out in a suitable solvent such as chloroform at ambient temperature and the product of Formula XXXV can be isolated using conventional methods. Ethyl chloroacetimidate hydrochloride is a known compound that can be prepared according to the literature procedure: Stillings, M. R. et al., J. Med. Chem., 29, pp. 2280-2284 (1986). hi steps (8) - (10) of Reaction Scheme V, a chloro-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XXXV can be converted into phthalimide-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine or \H- imidazo[4,5-e]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XXXVILT using the chemistry described in steps (2) - (4) of Reaction Scheme I. Steps (8) and (9) can alternatively be combined and carried out as a one-pot procedure by adding 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid to a solution of a compound of Formula XXXV in a solvent such as dichloromethane or chloroform and then adding ammom'um hydroxide and -toluenesulfonyl chloride without isolating the N- oxide of Formula XXXVI. Compounds of Formula XXXVI, XXXVH, and XXXVm or their pharmaceutically acceptable salts can be isolated using conventional methods. In steps (11) and (12) of Reaction Scheme V, a phthalimide-substituted \H- imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XXXVffl is converted to a hydroxylamine-subsitituted lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XXXLX which is condensed with an aldehyde or ketone to form an oxime of Formula XL, sequentially using the chemistry described in steps (5) and (6) of Reaction Scheme I. Compounds of Formula XXXLX and XL or their phannaceutically acceptable salts can be isolated using conventional methods. For some embodiments, compounds shown in Reaction Scheme V can be further elaborated using conventional synthetic methods. For example, an amine of Formula Rι-NH2, used in step (5) of Reaction Scheme V, may contain a protected functional group, such as a tert-butoxycarbonyl-protected amino group. The protecting group may be removed after step (12) of Reaction Scheme V to reveal an amine on the Rj group. An amino group introduced in this manner may be further functionalized using the chemistry described in steps (5) and (5a) of Reaction Scheme H to provide compounds of the Formula XL in which Ri is -X'-N(R8)-Q-R4 or -X'-Rsa. Alternatively, the protecting group may be removed after step (7) in Reaction Scheme V and the resulting amino group may be functionalized as described above before step (8). The resulting compound of
Formula XXXV can be subjected to steps (8) - (12) of Reaction Scheme V to provide a compound of Formula XL wherein Ri is -X'-N(R8)-Q-R4 or -X'-R5a.
Alternatively, the amine of Formula Rι-NH2 used in step (5) of Reaction Scheme V may contain an appropriately-protected hydroxyl group, for example, a tert- butyldimethylsilyl-protected hydroxyl group. The protecting group may be removed after step (12) in Reaction Scheme V to provide an alcohol on the Ri group. An alcohol introduced in this manner into a compound of Formula XL may be converted into a hydroxylamine upon treatment with N-hydroxyphthalimide using the Mitsunobu reaction conditions described in step (6) of Reaction Scheme HI, followed by deprotection of the resulting phthalimide-protected hydroxylamine with hydrazine in ethanol. A hydroxylamine on the Ri group can undergo reaction with a ketone or aldehyde of Formula Rι'C(O)Rι" to form an oxime using the reaction conditions described in step (6) of Reaction Scheme I to yield a compound of Formula XL in which i is -X"-O-Ν=C(Rι ')(Ri") where X", Ri ', and Ri" are as defined above. A hydroxylamine on the R\ group of a compound of Formula XL, prepared as described above, can also be further functionalized to a compound of the Formula XL in which Ri is -X"-O-NRιa-Y'-Rib wherein Y' is -C(O)-, -S(O)2-, -C(O)-N(R8)-, -C(S)-N(R8)-, -C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-, -C(O)-N(R8)-C(O , -S(O)2-N(R8)-; R is hydrogen, and Ri is as defined above using, respectively, an acid chloride, a sulfonyl chloride or a sulfonic anhydride; an isocyanate; an acyl isocyanate, an isothiocyanate, a sulfonyl isocyanate, a carbamoyl chloride, or a sulfamoyl chloride. The reaction can be carried out using the conditions described in step (5) of Reaction Scheme H. A large number of the reagents listed above are commercially available; others can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods.
A compound of Formula XL in which Ri is -X"-O-NRιa-Y'-Rib wherein Y' is a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, or -C(O)-C(O)-; Rιb is defined above, and Rla is hydrogen, can be derivatized further upon treatment with an alkylating agent that is generated in situ from an alcohol of Formula Rla-OH under Mitsunobu reaction conditions (described in step (6) of Reaction Scheme HI) or an alkylating agent of Formula Rιa-Br or Rla-I in the presence of a base such as cesium carbonate in a suitable solvent such as DMF. The later reaction may be carried out at ambient temperature for reactive alkylating agents such as, for example, methyl iodide, benzyl bromide, and substituted benzyl bromides, or at an elevated temperature. Optionally, catalytic tetrabutylammonium hydrogensulfate can be added. The product or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated by conventional methods. One skilled in the art would recognize that the reactions described for the alkylation step would probably not be successful for Rιa groups that are difficult to introduce via bimolecular nucleophilic substitution reactions. These groups include, for example, sterically hindered alkyl groups.
A compound of Formula XL in which Ri is -X"-O-NRιa-Y'-Rib, where Rla and Ri together with the nitrogen atom and Y' group to which they are bonded join together to
-N- C(O) -N- S(0)2 form a ring of Formula R? or 7 , can be prepared in a two-step procedure from a compound of Formula XL in which Ri is -X"-O-NH2, using the methods described in step 5a of Reaction Scheme I. Alternatively, a reagent of the Formula P-O-R C(O)Cl, wherein P is a protecting group, may react with a compound of Formula XL in which Rj is -X"-O-NH2 to generate an isolable intermediate that can then be deprotected to yield a hydroxyalkanamide. The isolable hydroxyalkanamide is cyclized under Mitsunobu conditions, described in step (6) of Reaction Scheme HI. The product or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. Reaction Scheme V
Figure imgf000122_0001
Figure imgf000122_0003
Figure imgf000122_0002
Figure imgf000122_0004
Compounds of the invention can be prepared according to Reaction Scheme VI, wherein D, E, R, Rls R2, R", and hal are as defined above, m is 1, n is 0 or 1, and R3 and R3c are as defined below. In Reaction Scheme VI, when D is -Br or -I, step (1) is used to convert a hydroxylamine-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine or 1H- imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XXXLX to an oxime-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XLI, a subgenus of Formulas I and H, as in step (12) of Reaction Scheme V. In step (2) of Reaction Scheme VI, a bromo- or iodo-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinoline-4-amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XLI can undergo known palladium-catalyzed coupling reactions such as the Suzuki coupling and the Heck reaction. For example, a bromo or iodo-substituted compound of Formula XLI undergoes Suzuki coupling with a boronic acid of Formula R3a-B(OH)2, an anhydride thereof, or a boronic acid ester of Formula R3a-B(O-alkyl)2, wherein R3a is as defined above, according to the method described in Reaction Scheme LV. The product of Formula XLH, a subgenus of Formulas I and H wherein R b is the same as R3a, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated by conventional methods. The Heck reaction can also be used in step (2) of Reaction Scheme VI to provide compounds of Formula XLH, wherein R3b is -X ft and -X'a-Y-R4, wherein X'a, Y, R4b, and R4 are as defined above. The Heck reaction is carried out by coupling a compound of Formula XLI with a compound of the Fonnula H2C:=:C(H)-R4b or H2C-C(H)-Y-R . Several of these vinyl-substituted compounds are commercially available; others can be prepared by known methods. The reaction is conveniently carried out by combining the compound of Formula XLI and the vinyl-substituted compound in the presence of palladium (H) acetate, triphenylphosphine or tri-ortAo-tolylphosphine, and a base such as triethylamine in a suitable solvent such as acetonitrile or toluene. The reaction can be carried out at an elevated temperature such as 100 °C -120 °C under an inert atmosphere. The product of Formula XLH or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
Compounds of Formula XLH, wherein R3b is -XVR4, X'c is alkynylene, and Rt is as defined above, can also be prepared by palladium catalyzed coupling reactions such as the Stille coupling or Sonogashira coupling. These reactions are carried out by coupling a compound of Formula XLI with a compound of the Fonnula (alkyfkSn-C≡C-R^
(alkyrbSi-C≡C-Rt, or H-C≡C-R^
Compounds of Formula XLH prepared as described above by palladium-mediated coupling reactions, wherein R3b is -XVR4, -XVY-R4, -X'^-Y-Ri, -X'b2-R5, or -X RJ, where X'b2 is alkenylene interrupted or terminated by arylene or heteroarylene, and X'a, X'c, Y, R4, and R5 are as defined above, can undergo reduction of the alkenylene or alkynylene group present to provide compounds of Formula XL wherein R3b is -X'd-Ri, -X'd-Y-P^, -X'e-Y-Rt, or -X'e-R5, where X'd is alkylene; X'e is alkylene interrupted or terminated by arylene or heteroarylene; and Rt., R5, and Y are as defined above. The reduction can be carried out by hydrogenation using a conventional heterogeneous hydrogenation catalyst such as palladium on carbon. The reaction can conveniently be carried out on a Pan apparatus in a suitable solvent such as ethanol, methanol, or mixtures thereof. The product or phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
Compounds of Formula XXXLX wherein D is -OCH2Ph can be converted in Reaction Scheme VI to compounds of Formula XLV wherein R c is -O-Rib, -O-X'-Ri, -O-X'-Y-P , or -O-X'-R5; wherein R , R b, R5, X', and Y are as defined above. In step
(la) of Reaction Scheme VI, the benzyl group in a lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XXXLX, wherein D is -OCH2Ph, is cleaved to provide a hydroxy group. The cleavage is conveniently carried out on a Pan apparatus under hydrogenolysis conditions using a suitable heterogeneous catalyst such as palladium or platinum on carbon in a solvent such as ethanol.
Alternatively, the reaction can be carried out by transfer hydrogenation in the presence of a suitable hydrogenation catalyst. The transfer hydrogenation is conveniently carried out by adding ammonium formate to a solution of a compound of Formula XXXLX in a suitable solvent such as ethanol in the presence of a catalyst such as palladium on carbon. The reaction is carried out at an elevated temperature, for example, the refluxing temperature of the solvent. The product of Formula XLIH or phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. hi step (lb) of Reaction Scheme VI, a hydroxylamine-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinoline-4-amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XLm is converted to an oxime-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4-amine or 1H- imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XLLV, a subgenus of Formulas I and Η, according to the method of step (12) of Reaction Scheme V. hi step (2a) of Reaction Scheme VI, a hydroxy-substituted oxime of Formula XLLV is converted to a compound of Formula XLV, a subgenus of Formula I and Η wherein R3c is -O-R^, -O-X'-Ri, -O-X'-Y-R4, or -O-X'-Rs, using a Williamson-type ether synthesis. The reaction is effected by treating a hydroxy-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-4- amine or lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine-4-amine of Formula XLLV with an aryl, alkyl, or arylalkylenyl halide of Formula Ηalide-Rjb, Halide-alkylene-R4, Halide-alkylene- Y-Ri, or Halide-alkylene-R5 in the presence of a base. Numerous alkyl, arylalkylenyl, and aryl halides of these formulas are commercially available, including substituted benzyl bromides and chlorides, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl or arylalkylenyl bromides and chlorides, and substituted fluorobenzenes. Other halides of these fonnulas can be prepared using conventional synthetic methods. The reaction is conveniently carried out by combining an alkyl, arylalkylenyl, or aryl halide with the hydroxy-substituted compound of Formula XLLV in a solvent such as DMF in the presence of a suitable base such as cesium carbonate. Optionally, catalytic tetrabutylammonium bromide can be added. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature or at an elevated temperature, for example 65 °C or 85 °C, depending on the reactivity of the halide reagent. Alternatively, step (2a) may be carried out using the Ullmann ether synthesis, in which an alkali metal aryloxide prepared from the hydroxy-substituted compound of Formula XLLV reacts with an aryl halide in the presence of copper salts, to provide a compound of Formula XLV, where R c is -O-Rtø,
-O-X'f-Ri, or -O-X'r Y-R4, wherein X'f is an arylene or heteroarylene. Numerous substituted and unsubstituted aryl halides are commercially available; others can be prepared using conventional methods. The product of Formula XLV, prepared by either of these methods, or phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods.
Reaction Scheme VI
Figure imgf000126_0001
For some embodiments, compounds of the invention are prepared according to Reaction Scheme VH, where Ri, R2, R", RA2, RB2, X, and Hal are as defined above, and Ph is phenyl. In step (1) of Reaction Scheme VH, a 2,4-dichloro-3-nitropyridine of Formula XL VI is reacted with an amine of the Formula H2N-Rι to form a 2-chloro-3- nitropyridine of Formula XLVH. The reaction is conveniently carried out by combining an amine of Formula H2N-Ri and a 2,4-dichloro-3 -nifropyridine of Formula XLVI in the presence of a base such as triethylamine in an inert solvent such as DMF. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature, and the product can be isolated from the reaction mixture using conventional methods. Many amines of Formula H2N-Rι are commercially available; others can be prepared by known synthetic methods. Many 2,4-dichloro-3- nitropyridines of the Formula XLVI are known and can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods (see, for example, Dellaria et al, U.S. Pat. No. 6,525,064 and the references cited therein). hi step (2) of Reaction Scheme VH, a 2-chloro-3-nitropyridine of Formula XLVH is reacted with an alkali nietal azide to provide an 8-nitrotetrazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-amine of Formula XLVm. The reaction can be carried out by combining the compound of Formula
XLVH with an alkali metal azide, for example, sodium azide, in a suitable solvent such as acetonitrile/water, preferably 90/10 acetonitrile/water, in the presence of cerium(LH) chloride, preferably cerium(m) chloride heptahydrate. Optionally, the reaction can be carried out with heating, for example, at the reflux temperature. Alternatively, the reaction can be carried out by combining the compound of Fonnula XLVH with an alkali metal azide, for example, sodium azide, in a suitable solvent such as DMF and heating, for example to about 50-60 °C, optionally in the presence of ammonium chloride. The product can be isolated from the reaction mixture using conventional methods. hi step (3) of Reaction Scheme VH, an 8-nitrotetrazolo[l,5-a]pyridin-7-amine of Formula XLVIH is reduced to provide a compound of Formula XLIX. The reaction can be carried out by hydrogenation using a heterogeneous hydrogenation catalyst such as palladium on carbon or platinum on carbon. The hydrogenation is conveniently carried out in a Pan apparatus in a suitable solvent such as toluene, methanol, acetonitrile, or ethyl acetate. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature, and the product can be isolated using conventional methods. hi step (4) of Reaction Scheme VH, a tetrazolo[l,5-α]pyridine-7,8-diamine of Formula XLIX, is reacted with a carboxylic acid or an equivalent thereof to provide a 7H- imidazo[4,5-c]tetrazolo[l,5- ]pyridine of Formula L. The carboxylic acid or equivalent is selected such that it will provide the desired -X-Hal substituent in a compound of Formula L. The reaction can be carried out as described in step (7) of Reaction Scheme V. The product can be isolated using conventional methods.
In step (5) of Reaction Scheme VH, a 7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetrazolo[l,5-α]pyridine of Formula L is treated with N-hydroxyphthalimide to provide a compound of Formula LI, which contains a N-phthalimide-protected hydroxylamine. The reaction is conveniently carried out as described in step (4) of Reaction Scheme I. The product or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be isolated using conventional methods. In step (6) of Reaction Scheme VH, the N-phthalimide-protected hydroxylamine of Formula LI is treated with hydrazine in a suitable solvent such as ethanol to provide a hydroxylamine of Formula LH. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature and the product can be isolated from the reaction mixture using conventional methods. In step (7) Reaction Scheme VH, the hydroxylamine group in a 7H-imidazo[4,5- c]tetrazolo[l,5-α]pyridine of Formula LH reacts with an aldehyde or ketone of Formula R2C(O)R" to provide an oxime of Formula VHL The reaction can be carried out using the conditions described above in step (6) of Reaction Scheme I and the product can be isolated from the reaction mixture using conventional methods. hi step (8) of Reaction Scheme VH, the tetrazolo ring is removed from a 7H- imidazo[4,5-c]tetrazolo[l,5-fl]pyridine of Formula VQL by reaction with triphenylphosphine to form an N-triphenylphosphinyl intermediate of Formula LΗL The reaction with triphenylphosphine can be run in a suitable solvent such as toluene or 1,2- dichlorobenzene under an atmosphere of nitrogen with heating, for example at the reflux temperature. hi step (9) of Reaction Scheme VH, an N-triphenylphosphinyl intermediate of Formula LIH is hydrolyzed to provide an oxime-substituted lH-imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-4- amine of Formula VI. The hydrolysis can be carried out by general methods well known to those skilled in the art, for example, by heating in a lower alkanol or an alkanol/water solution in the presence of an acid such as trifluoroacetic acid, acetic acid, or hydrochloric acid. The product can be isolated from the reaction mixture using conventional methods as the compound of Formula VI or as a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
For some embodiments, compounds shown in Reaction Scheme VH can be further elaborated using conventional synthetic methods. For Example, amines of Formula Rι-ΝH2, used in step (1) of Reaction Scheme VH, may contain a protected functional group, such as a tert-butoxycarbonyl-protected amino group. The protecting group maybe removed later in Reaction Scheme VH after step (4) to reveal, for example, an amine on the Ri group of a compound of Formula L. An amino group introduced in this manner may be further functionalized by applying the chemistry described in steps (5) and (5a) of Reaction Scheme H to provide compounds of the Formula L in which Ri is -X'-N(R8)-Q-R or -X'-R5a, which can be converted into compounds of the Formula VI using the chemistry described in steps (5) - (9) of Reaction Scheme VH. Alternatively, the protecting group may be removed after step (7) of Reaction Scheme VH to reveal an amine on the Ri group of a compound of Formula VHL The amino group may be further functionalized as described above to provide compounds of the Formula VHI in which Ri is -X'-N(R8)-Q-R or -X'-R5a, which can be converted into compounds of the Formula VI using the chemistry described in steps (8) and (9) of Reaction Scheme VH.
Compounds of the Formula VI in which Ri is -X"-O-N=C(Ri')(Ri") or -X"-O-NRla-Y'-Rib can be synthesized from compounds shown in Reaction Scheme VH using the chemistry described above in association with Reaction Scheme V.
Reaction Scheme VH
Figure imgf000129_0001
VI Llll Pharmaceutical Compositions and Biological Activity
Pharmaceutical compositions of the invention contain a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of the invention as described above in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
The terms "a therapeutically effective amount" and "effective amount" mean an amount of the compound or salt sufficient to induce a therapeutic or prophylactic effect, such as cytokine induction, immunomodulation, antitumor activity, and/or antiviral activity. Although the exact amount of active compound or salt used in a pharmaceutical composition of the invention will vary according to factors known to those of skill in the art, such as the physical and chemical nature of the compound or salt, the nature of the carrier, and the intended dosing regimen, it is anticipated that the compositions of the invention will contain sufficient active ingredient to provide a dose of about 100 nanograms per kilogram (ng/kg) to about 50 milligrams per kilogram (mg/kg), preferably about 10 micrograms per kilogram (μg/kg) to about 5 mg/kg, of the compound or salt to the subject. A variety of dosage forms may be used, such as tablets, lozenges, capsules, parenteral formulations, syrups, creams, ointments, aerosol formulations, transdermal patches, transmucosal patches and the like. The compounds or salts of the invention can be administered as the single therapeutic agent in the treatment regimen, or the compounds or salts of the invention may be administered in combination with one another or with other active agents, including additional immune response modifiers, antivirals, antibiotics, antibodies, proteins, peptides, oligonucleotides, etc. Compounds or salts of the invention have been shown to induce the production of certain cytokines and certain compounds or salts of the invention may inhibit the production of certain cytokines in experiments performed according to the tests set forth below. These results indicate that the compounds or salts are useful as immune response modifiers that can modulate the immune response in a number of different ways, rendering them useful in the treatment of a variety of disorders. Cytokines whose production may be induced by the administration of compounds or salts of the invention generally include interferon-α (IFN-α) and/or tumor necrosis factor-α (TNF-α) as well as certain interleukins (IL). Cytokines whose biosynthesis may be induced by compounds or salts of the invention include LFN-α, TNF-α, IL-1, IL-6, TL- 10 and LL-12, and a variety of other cytokines. Among other effects, these and other cytokines can inhibit virus production and tumor cell growth, making the compounds or salts useful in the treatment of viral diseases and neoplastic diseases. Accordingly, the invention provides a method of inducing cytokine biosynthesis in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt or composition of the invention to the animal. The animal to which the compound or salt or composition is administered for induction of cytokine biosynthesis may have a disease as described infra, for example a viral disease or a neoplastic disease, and administration of the compound or salt may provide therapeutic treatment. Alternatively, the compound or salt may be administered to the animal prior to the animal acquiring the disease so that administration of the compound or salt may provide a prophylactic treatment.
In addition to the ability to induce the production of cytokines, compounds or salts of the invention can affect other aspects of the innate immune response. For example, natural killer cell activity may be stimulated, an effect that may be due to cytokine induction. The compounds or salts may also activate macrophages, which in turn stimulate secretion of nitric oxide and the production of additional cytokines. Further, the compounds or salts may cause proliferation and differentiation of B-lymphocytes.
Compounds or salts of the invention can also have an effect on the acquired immune response. For example, the production of the T helper type 1 (THI) cytokine LFN- γ may be induced indirectly and the production of the T helper type 2 (TH2) cytokines LL-4, LL-5 and IL-13 may be inhibited upon administration of the compounds or salts.
Other cytokines whose production may be inhibited by the administration of compounds or salts of the invention include tumor necrosis factor-α (TNF-α). Among other effects, inhibition of TNF-α production can provide prophylaxis or therapeutic treatment of TNF-α mediated diseases in animals, making the compounds or salt useful in the treatment of, for example, autoimmune diseases. Accordingly, the invention provides a method of inhibiting TNF-α biosynthesis in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt or composition of the invention to the animal. The animal to which the compound or salt or composition is administered for inhibition of TNF-α biosynthesis may have a disease as described infra, for example an autoimmune disease, and administration of the compound or salt may provide therapeutic treatment. Alternatively, the compound or salt may be administered to the animal prior to the animal acquiring the disease so that administration of the compound or salt may provide a prophylactic treatment.
Whether for prophylaxis or therapeutic treatment of a disease, and whether for effecting innate or acquired immunity, the compound or salt or composition may be administered alone or in combination with one or more active components as in, for example, a vaccine adjuvant. When administered with other components, the compound or salt and other component or components may be administered separately; together but independently such as in a solution; or together and associated with one another such as (a) covalently linked or (b) non-covalently associated, e.g., in a colloidal suspension. Conditions for which fRMs identified herein may be used as treatments include, but are not limited to:
(a) viral diseases such as, for example, diseases resulting from infection by an adenovirus, a herpesvirus (e.g., HSV-I, HSV-H, CMV, or VZV), a poxvirus (e.g., an orthopoxvirus such as variola or vaccinia, or molluscum contagiosum), a picornavirus (e.g., rhinovirus or enterovirus), an orthomyxovirus (e.g., mfluenzavirus), a paramyxovirus
(e.g., parainfluenzavirus, mumps virus, measles virus, and respiratory syncytial virus (RSV)), a coronavirus (e.g., SARS), a papovavirus (e.g., papillomaviruses, such as those that cause genital warts, common warts, or plantar warts), a hepadnavirus (e.g., hepatitis B virus), a flavivirus (e.g., hepatitis C virus or Dengue virus), or a retrovirus (e.g., a lentivirus such as HLV);
(b) bacterial diseases such as, for example, diseases resulting from infection by bacteria of, for example, the genus Escherichia, Enterobacter, Salmonella, Staphylococcus, Shigella, Listeria, Aerobacter, Helicobacter, Klebsiella, Proteus, Pseudomonas, Streptococcus, Chlamydia, Mycoplasma, Pneumococcus, Neisseria, Clostridium, Bacillus, Corynebacterium, Mycobacterium, Campylobacter, Vibrio, Senatia, Providencia,
Chromobacterium, Brucella, Yersinia, Haemophilus, or Bordetella; (c) other infectious diseases, such chlamydia, fungal diseases including but not limited to candidiasis, aspergillosis, histoplasmosis, cryptococcal meningitis, or parasitic diseases including but not limited to malaria, pneumocystis carnii pneumonia, leishmaniasis, cryptosporidiosis, toxoplasmosis, and trypanosome infection; (d) neoplastic diseases, such as intraepithelial neoplasias, cervical dysplasia, actinic keratosis, basal cell carcinoma, squamous cell carcinoma, renal cell carcinoma, Kaposi's sarcoma, melanoma, leukemias including but not limited to myelogeous leukemia, chronic lymphocytic leukemia, multiple myeloma, non-Hodgkin's lymphoma, cutaneous T-cell lymphoma, B-cell lymphoma, and hairy cell leukemia, and other cancers; (e) TH2-mediated, atopic diseases, such as atopic dermatitis or eczema, eosinophilia, asthma, allergy, allergic rhinitis, and Ommen's syndrome;
(f) certain autoimmune diseases such as systemic lupus erythematosus, essential thrombocythaemia, multiple sclerosis, discoid lupus, alopecia areata; and
(g) diseases associated with wound repair such as, for example, inhibition of keloid formation and other types of scarring (e.g., enhancing wound healing, including chronic wounds).
Additionally, an fRM compound or salt of the present invention maybe useful as a vaccine adjuvant for use in conjunction with any material that raises either humoral and/or cell mediated immune response, such as, for example, live viral, bacterial, or parasitic immunogens; inactivated viral, tumor-derived, protozoal, organism-derived, fungal, or bacterial immunogens, toxoids, toxins; self-antigens; polysaccharides; proteins; glycoproteins; peptides; cellular vaccines; DNA vaccines; autologous vaccines; recombinant proteins; and the like, for use in connection with, for example, BCG, cholera, plague, typhoid, hepatitis A, hepatitis B, hepatitis C, influenza A, influenza B, parainfluenza, polio, rabies, measles, mumps, rubella, yellow fever, tetanus, diphtheria, hemophilus influenza b, tuberculosis, meningococcal and pneumococcal vaccines, adenovirus, HLV, chicken pox, cytomegalovirus, dengue, feline leukemia, fowl plague, HSV-1 and HSV-2, hog cholera, Japanese encephalitis, respiratory syncytial virus, rotavirus, papilloma virus, yellow fever, and Alzheimer's Disease. Certain LRM compounds or salts of the present invention may be particularly helpful in individuals having compromised immune function. For example, certain compounds or salts may be used for treating the opportunistic infections and tumors that occur after suppression of cell mediated immunity in, for example, transplant patients, cancer patients and HLV patients.
Thus, one or more of the above diseases or types of diseases, for example, a viral disease or a neoplastic disease may be treated in an animal in need thereof (having the disease) by admimstering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of the invention to the animal.
An amount of a compound or salt effective to induce or inhibit cytokine biosynthesis is an amount sufficient to cause one or more cell types, such as monocytes, macrophages, dendritic cells and B-cells to produce an amount of one or more cytokines such as, for example, LFN-α, TNF-α, IL-1, E -6, IL-10 and LL- 12 that is increased (induced) or decreased (inhibited) over a background level of such cytokines. The precise amount will vary according to factors known in the art but is expected to be a dose of about 100 ng/kg to about 50 mg/kg, preferably about 10 μg/kg to about 5 mg/kg. The invention also provides a method of treating a viral infection in an animal and a method of treating a neoplastic disease in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt or composition of the invention to the animal. An amount effective to treat or inhibit a viral infection is an amount that will cause a reduction in one or more of the manifestations of viral infection, such as viral lesions, viral load, rate of virus production, and mortality as compared to untreated control animals. The precise amount that is effective for such treatment will vary according to factors known in the art but is expected to be a dose of about 100 ng/kg to about 50 mg/kg, preferably about 10 μg/kg to about 5 mg/kg. An amount of a compound or salt effective to treat a neoplastic condition is an amount that will cause a reduction in tumor size or in the number of tumor foci. Again, the precise amount will vary according to factors known in the art but is expected to be a dose of about 100 ng/kg to about 50 mg/kg, preferably about 10 μg/kg to about 5 mg/kg.
Objects and advantages of this invention are further illustrated by the following examples, but the particular materials and amounts thereof recited in these examples, as well as other conditions and details, should not be construed to unduly limit this invention. EXAMPLES
Example 1
Propan-2-one O- { [4-amino- 1 -(2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}oxime
Figure imgf000135_0001
Part A
N4-(2-Methylpropyl)quinoline-3,4-diamine (41 g), dichloromethane (550 mL), triethylamine (40 mL, 1.5 eq), and chloroacetyl chloride (16.7 mL, 1.1 eq.) were combined and then stined at ambient temperature over the weekend. The reaction mixture was diluted with 1,2-dichloroethane (75 mL) and then washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (3 x 400 mL). The organic layer was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered through a layer of CELITE filter aid, and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 52.81 g of 2-chloromethyl-l -(2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline as a brown solid.
Part B 3-Chloroperoxybenzoic acid (mCPBA) (16.4 g of 77% max, 73.1 mmol) was added to a solution of 2-chloromethyl-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline (10 g, 36.5 mmol) in chloroform (250 mL). The reaction mixture was stined at ambient temperature overnight. Ammonium hydroxide (100 mL) was added and the reaction was stined vigorously for 15 minutes. Pαr -toluenesulfonyl chloride (8.4 g, 43.8 mmol) was added in portions over a period of 10 minutes. The reaction mixture was stined at ambient temperature for 1 hour and then filtered to remove a precipitate. The filtrate was transfened to a separatory funnel and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 100 mL). The combined organics were dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered through a layer of CELITE filter aid, and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 16 g of crude product as a yellow foam. The foam was dissolved in 10% methanol in dichloromethane (20 mL). The solution was divided and loaded onto two FLASH 40+M silica cartridges (90 g), (available from Biotage, Inc, Charlottesville, Virginia, USA). The cartridges were eluted sequentially with IL 1:1 ethyl acetate :hexanes, 2% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate :hexanes, and 5% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate :hexanes. The fractions containing product were combined and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 6.4 g of 2-chloromethyl-l -(2-methylpropyl)- 1H- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as an orange foam.
Part C
Triethylamine (536 mg, 5.19 mmol) was added to a solution of N- hydroxyphthalimide (678 mg, 4.16 mmol) in NN-dimethylformamide (DMF); after 5 minutes a solution of 2-chloromethyl-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4- amine (1 g) in DMF (10 mL) was added. The reaction mixture was stined at ambient temperature for 2 hours. The reaction mixture was diluted with dichloromethane (50 mL) and then washed with water (1 x 100 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 50 mL) and ethyl acetate (1 x 50 mL). The combined organics were dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered through a layer of CELITE filter aid, and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 1.8 g of crude product as a yellow solid. The solid was dissolved in 5% methanol in chloroform (10 mL) and loaded onto a FLASH 40+M silica cartridge (90 g). The cartridge was eluted sequentially with IL 1% methanol in chloroform and 3% methanol in chloroform. The fractions containing the desired product were combined and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 950 mg of a yellow solid. This material was recrystallized from acetonitrile, isolated by filtration, washed sequentially with acetonitrile and diethyl ether, and then dried in a vacuum oven at 65 °C overnight to provide 640 mg of 2-{[4-amino-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl]methoxy}isoindole- 1,3 -dione as a yellow crystalline solid, mp 221-222 °C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.10 (d, J= 7.6 Hz, IH), 7.88 (s, 4H), 7.63 (dd, J= 8.3 Hz, 1.2 Hz, IH), 7.48 (m, IH), 7.32 (m, IH), 6.69 (br s, 2H), 5.51 (s, 2H), 4.73 (d, J= 1.6 Hz, 2H), 2.35 (m, IH), 1.01 (d, J= 6.6 Hz, 6H); MS (APCI) m/z 448.0 (M + H)+; Anal. Calc'd for C23H21N5O3»0.5CH3CN «0.5H2O: C, 64.78; H, 5.32; N, 17.31. Found: C, 64.87; H, 5.28; N, 17.63.
Part D
Hydrazine hydrate (9 mL) was added to a suspension of 2-{[4-amino-l-(2- methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methoxy}isoindole-l,3-dione (3.9 g) in ethanol (90 mL). The resulting solution was stined at ambient temperature for 3 hours.
The reaction mixture was filtered to remove a precipitate and the filter cake was washed with ethanol and dichloromethane. ' The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure, diluted with aqueous IN hydrochloric acid (100 mL), and then washed sequentially with dichloromethane (2 x 50 mL) and ethyl acetate (1 x 50 mL). Analysis of the organic washes by LCMS indicated that they did not contain product. The aqueous acidic layer was made basic (~ pH 9) with solid sodium carbonate and then extracted sequentially with dichloromethane (1 x 100 mL), ethyl acetate (1 x 100 mL), and dichloromethane (1 X 100 mL). The combined organic extracts were dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 2.07 g of O-{[4-amino-l-(2- methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}hydroxylamine as a tan foam.
Part E
Acetone (3.5 mL) was added to a solution of O-{[4-amino-l -(2-methylpropyl)- 1H- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}hydroxylamine (1 g) in methanol (30 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir at ambient temperature for 4 hours and then it was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was placed under high vacuum overnight to provide 1.07 g of crude product as a brown foam. The foam was dissolved in dichloromethane (9 mL) and then loaded onto a FLASH 40+S silica cartridge (40 g), (available from Biotage, Inc, Charlottesville, Virginia, USA). The cartridge was eluted sequentially with 500 mL 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 2% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, and 5% methanol 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes. The fractions containing product were combined and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 690 mg of a yellow solid. This material was recrystallized from ethyl acetate, isolated by filtration, washed with diethyl ether, and then dried under high vacuum to provide 430 mg of propan-2-one O-{[4-amino-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2- yljmethyl} oxime as a light yellow crystalline solid, mp 194-195 °C.
1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.03 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, IH), 7.63 (dd, J = 8.2 Hz, 0.8 Hz, IH), 7.45 (dd, J = 7.9, 7.9 Hz, IH), 7.29 (m, IH), 6.65 (br s, 2H), 5.30 (s, 2H), 4.48 (d, J = 7.6 Hz, 2H), 2.25 (m, IH), 1.82 (s, 3H), 1.81 (s, 3H), 0.92 (d, J - 6.6 Hz, 6H); 13C NMR (75 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 156.2, 152.4, 149.4, 145.6, 133.3, 127.2, 127.0, 126.7, 121.5, 121.0, 115.1, 67.3, 52.2, 29.0, 21.6, 19.6 (2), 15.8;
MS (APCI) m/z 326.2 (M + H)+;
Anal. Calc'd for C18H23N5O: C, 66.44; H, 7.12; N, 21.52. Found: C, 66.44; H, 7.14; N, 21.37.
Example 2
Acetaldehyde O- { [4-amino- 1 -(2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}oxime
Figure imgf000138_0001
Acetaldehyde (3.5 mL) was added to a chilled (0 °C) solution of O- {[4-amino- 1 -(2- methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl} hydroxylamine (1 g) in methanol (30 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to warm to ambient temperature and stined for 4 hours. The reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure and the residue was placed under high vacuum overnight to provide 1.37 g of crude product as a brown foam. An attempt to purify by radial chromatography failed leaving 1.16 g of crude product. This material was dissolved in dichloromethane (6 mL) and then loaded onto a FLASH 40+S silica cartridge (40 g). The cartridge was eluted sequentially with 500 mL 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 2% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 5% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, and 6% methanol 1 : 1 ethyl acetate:hexanes. The fractions containing product were combined and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 570 mg of a yellow solid. This material was purified by radial chromatography using a 4 mm plate and eluting with 1%, 3%, 5% and 10% methanol in hexanes to provide 480 mg of a yellow solid. This material was recrystallized from acetonitrile; isolated by filtration; washed sequentially with acetonitrile, ethyl acetate, and diethyl ether; and then dried under high vacuum to provide 115 mg of acetaldehyde O- {[4-amino- 1 -(2- methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}oxime as a light yellow crystalline solid, mp 155-156 °C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.02 (d, J= 8.0 Hz, IH), 7.62 (dd, J= 8.2 Hz, 0.8 Hz,
IH), 7.52 (minor isomer, q, J= 5.8 Hz, 0.33H), 7.44 (ddd, J= 8.0, 7.1, 0.9 Hz, IH), 7.27 (ddd, J= 8.2, 7.0, 1.1 Hz, IH), 6.94 (major isomer, q, J= 5.5 Hz, 0.67H), 6.64 (br s, 2H), 5.37 (major isomer, s, 1.33H), 5.30 (minor isomer, s, 0.67H), 4.48-4.44 (m, 2H), 2.31-2.17 (m, IH), 1.79-1.76 (m, 3H), 0.92 (d, J= 6.6 Hz, 6H); MS (APCI) m/z 312.2 (M + H)+;
Anal. Calc'd for C17H2ιN5O: C, 65.57; H, 6.80; N, 22.49. Found: C, 65.29; H, 7.04; N, 22.46.
Example 3 Benzaldehye 0-{ [4-amino- l-(2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}oxime
Figure imgf000139_0001
Benzaldehyde (0.94 mL) was added to a solution of O- {[4-amino- 1 -(2- methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}hydroxylamine (2.2 g) in methanol
(50 mL). The reaction mixture was stined at ambient temperature. After 2 hours an additional 1 mL of benzaldehyde was added and the reaction was stined overnight. The reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting residue was dissolved in 10% methanol in chloroform (10 mL) and then loaded onto a FLASH 40+M silica cartridge (90 g). The cartridge was eluted sequentially with 1 L 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 500 mL 2 %, 3%, 4%, and 5% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate :hexanes. The fractions containing product were combined and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 1.14 g of a tan solid. This material was recrystallized from acetonitrile, isolated by filtration, washed with acetonitrile, and then dried under high vacuum to provide 708 mg of benzaldehye O-{[4-amino-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2- yljmethyl} oxime as a peach crystalline solid, mp 180-181 °C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.35 (s, IH) 8.04 (d, J = 7.8 Hz, IH), 7.65-7.61 (m, 3H),
7.48-7.41 (m, 4H), 7.31-7.25 (m, IH), 6.68 (br s, 2H), 5.52 (s, 2H), 4.54 (d, J = 7.6 Hz,
2H), 2.35-2.20 (m, IH), 0.95 (d, J = 6.6 Hz, 6H);
MS (APCI) m/z 374.2 (M + H)+;
Anal. Calc'd for C22H23N5O: C, 70.76; H, 6.21; N, 18.75. Found: C, 70.53; H, 6.20; N, 18.75.
Example 4 Pyridine-3-carboxaldehyde O- {[4-amino- l-(2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}oxime Dihydrochloride
Figure imgf000140_0001
A solution of O-{[4-amino-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2- yl]methyl}hydroxylamine (2.2 g) in methanol (50 mL) was combined with 3- pyridinecarboxaldehyde (3.6 mL) and stined at ambient temperature until analysis by LCMS indicated that the reaction was complete. The reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure and the residue was loaded onto a FLASH 40+M silica cartridge (90 g). The cartridge was eluted sequentially with 1 L ethyl acetate, 2.5%, 5%, and 10% methanol in ethyl acetate. The fractions containing product were combined and then concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting residue was dissolved in dichloromethane (50 mL) and then combined with 4M hydrochloric acid in dioxane (30 mL). A white solid precipitated. The mixture was concentrated and then dissolved in hot ethanol. The ethanol solution was chilled in a freezer over the weekend. The resulting precipitate was isolated by filtration; washed sequentially with ethanol, acetonitrile, and diethyl ether; and then dried under high vacuum to provide 230 mg of pyridine-3- carboxaldehyde O- { [4-amino- 1 -(2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c] quinolin-2- yljmethyl} oxime dihydrochloride as a tan crystalline solid, mp 213-215 °C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.97 (s, IH), 8.83 (m, IH), 8.58 (s, IH), 8.42 (d, J = 8.1
Hz, IH), 8.26 (d, J - 8.2 Hz, IH), 7.85 (m, 2H), 7.74 (dd, J = 7.3, 7.3 Hz, IH), 7.61 (m, IH), 5.72 (s, 2H), 4.65 (d, J = 7.6 Hz, 2H), 2.26 (m, IH), 0.99 (d, J = 6.6 Hz, 6H); 13C NMR (75 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 151.9, 149.7, 147.5, 146.6, 144.3, 138.8, 135.7, 134.3, 130.3, 129.7, 126.4, 125.4, 125.3, 122.6, 118.9, 112.9, 68.1, 52.6, 29.1, 19.5(2); MS (APCI) m/z 375.1 (M + H)+;
Anal. Calc'd for C21H22N6O -2 HCl • 0.5H2O: C, 56.17; H, 5.79; N, 17.87. Found: C, 56.04; H, 5.75; N, 17.90.
Example 5 N- [3 -(4- Amino-2-isopropylideneaminooxymethyl- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)propyl]methanesulfonamide
Figure imgf000141_0001
Part A Triethylamine (9 mL, 64.7 mmol) was added to a solution of tert-butyl [3-(3- aminoquinolin-4-ylamino)propyl]carbamate (13.65 g, 43.1 mmol) in dichloromethane (150 mL). Chloroacetyl chloride (3.8 mL, 47.5 mmol) was added dropwise over a period of 10 minutes. The reaction mixture was stined at ambient temperature over the weekend and then concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate (100 mL) and 1:1 water:saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate. The organic layer was washed with brine (100 mL). The combined aqueous layers were extracted with ethyl acetate (2 x 100 mL). The combined organics were dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 14.1 g of crude product as a brown foam. The foam was dissolved in a mixture of dichloromethane (15 mL) and methanol (0.5 mL). The solution was divided and loaded onto two FLASH 40+M silica cartridges (90 g). The cartridges were eluted sequentially with 1 L 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 5% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate :hexanes, and 10% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes. The fractions containing product were combined and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 8.96 g of tert-butyl [3-(2-chloromethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-l-yl)propyl]carbamate as a light brown foam.
Part B 3-Chloroperoxybenzoic acid (13.3 g of 77% max, 59.4 eq.) was added in portions over a period of 5 minutes to a solution of tert-butyl [3-(2-chloromethyl-17J-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-l-yl)propyl]carbamate (8.9 g, 23.7 mmol) in chloroform (200 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir at ambient temperature overnight. Ammonium hydroxide (50 mL) was added and the reaction mixture was stined vigorously. Para- toluensulfonyl chloride (5.43 g, 28.5 mmol) was added over a period of 5 minutes. The reaction mixture was stined at ambient temperature for 2 hours; an additional 1 g oϊpara- toluensulfonyl chloride was added and the reaction mixture was stined for another hour. The reaction mixture was filtered to remove solids. The filtrate was transfened to a separatory funnel and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with 1 : 1 water:saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (2 x 150 mL). The combined aqueous was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 150 mL) and ethyl acetate (1 x 100 mL). The combined organic extracts were concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 13.6 g of crude product as a brown foam. The foam was dissolved in dichloromethane (20 mL). The solution was divided and loaded onto two FLASH 40+M silica cartridges (90 g). The first cartridge was eluted sequentially with IL 1 : 1 ethyl acetate :hexanes, 5% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, and 10% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes. The second cartridge was eluted sequentially with IL 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 7% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate :hexanes, and 7% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes. The fractions containing product were combined and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 4.3 g of tert-butyl [3-(4-amino-2-chloromethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l- yl)propyl]carbamate as a light yellow foam.
Part C
Triethylamine (4.6 mL, 33.1 mmol) was added to a solution of N- hydroxyphthalimide (2.16 g, 13.2 mmol) in DMF (10 mL). A solution of of tert-butyl [3-
(4-amino-2-chloromethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)propyl]carbamate (4.3 g, 11.0 mmol) in DMF (20 ml) was added. The reaction was stined at ambient temperature for
3.5 hours and then diluted with water (100 mL). The resulting precipitate was isolated by filtration, washed with water, and then dried in a vacuum oven at 60°C over the weekend to provide 4.25 g of tert-butyl (3-{4-amino-2-[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydroisoindol-2- yl)oxymethyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl}propyl)carbamate as a light yellow solid. 1H ΝMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.2 (d, J- 8.0 Hz, IH), 7.9 (s, 4H), 7.7 (m, IH), 7.5 (m,
IH), 7.3 (m, IH), 7.2 (m, IH), 6.7 (br s, 2H), 5.5 (s, 2H), 4.8 (m, 2H), 3.2 (m, 2H), 2.2 (m, 2H), 1.4 (s, 9H); MS (APCI) m/z 517.3 (M + H)+.
Part D Hydrazine hydrate (8 mL of 55%) was added to a suspension of of tert-butyl (3- {4- amino-2-[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydroisoindol-2-yl)oxymethyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l- yl}propyl)carbamate (4.25 g, 8.23 mmol) in ethanol (70 mL). The reaction became homogeneous after about 2 minutes. A precipitate started forming after about 1 hour. After stirring at ambient temperature for a total of 2 hours the reaction mixture was filtered and the filter cake was washed with dichloromethane. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was azeotroped twice with toluene to provide 3.63 g of tert- butyl [3-(4-amino-2-aminooxymethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)propyl]carbamate as a white solid. Part E
Acetone (20 mL) was added to a solution of tert-butyl [3-(4-amino-2- aminooxymethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)propyl]carbamate (3.6 g) in methanol (70 mL). The reaction mixture was stined at ambient temperature overnight and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 4.12 g of tert-butyl [3-(4-amino-2- isopropylideneaminoxymethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)propyl]carbamate as a light yellow foam.
Part F
Trifluoroacetic acid (7 mL) was added to a suspension of tert-butyl [3-(4-amino-2- isopropylideneaminoxymethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)propyl]carbamate (4.12 g) in dichloromethane (70 mL). The reaction became homogeneous and was stined at ambient temperature for 2.5 hours. More trifluoroacetic acid (10 mL) was added and the reaction was stined for another hour. The reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure and placed under high vacuum overnight to provide 7.68 g of propan-2- one O-{[4-amino-l-(3-aminopropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}oxime a white solid. Based on the weight this material was assumed to contain 5 equivalents of trifluoroacetic acid.
Part G
Triethylamine (3.1 mL) was added to a suspension of 2 g of material from Part F in dichloromethane (20 mL) and the reaction became homogeneous. Methanesulfonyl chloride (0.207 mL) was added and the reaction was stined at ambient temperature. Analysis by LCMS after 1 hour showed that the reaction was not complete. More methanesulfonyl chloride (0.15 mL) was added and the reaction was stined for an additional 30 minutes. The reaction mixture was washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (1 x 40 mL). The aqueous wash was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 30 mL) and ethyl acetate (1 x 20 mL). The combined organics were washed with brine and then concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 1.5 g of crude product as a tan solid. The solid was dissolved in 10% methanol in chloroform (10 mL) and then loaded onto a FLASH 40+S silica cartridge (40 g). The cartridge was eluted sequentially with 500 mL 1:1 ethyl acetate :heaxanes, 5% methanol in 1:1 ethyl acetate:hexanes, 2 % methanol in chloroform, and 5 % methanol in chloroform (x3). The fractions containing product were combined and concentrated. The residue was recrystallized from acetonitrile, isolated by filtration, washed with diethyl ether, and then dried under high vacuum to provide 623 mg ofN-[3-(4-amino-2-isopropylideneaminooxymethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l- yl)propyl]methanesulfonamide as a white crystalline solid, mp 178-179 °C.
1H ΝMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.13 (d, J- 7.9 Hz, IH), 7.64 (dd, J= 8.3 Hz, 0.8 Hz, IH), 7.49-7.43 (m, IH), 7.30-7.25 (m, 2H), 6.67 (br s, 2H), 5.33 (s, 2H), 4.67 (t, J= 7.6 Hz, 2H), 3.17-3.15 (m, 2H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 2.08-2.03 (m, 2H), 1.82 (d, J= 7.0 Hz, 6H); MS (APCI) m/z 405.2 (M + H)+; Anal. Calc'd for C18H24Ν6O3S: C, 53.45; H, 5.98; N, 20.78. Found: C, 53.35; H, 6.22; N,
20.78.
Examples 6 - 51
An aldehyde or ketone from the table below (1.1 equivalents) was added to a test tube containing a solution of O-{[4-amino-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-
2-yl]methyl} hydroxylamine (30 mg) in methanol (1 mL). The test tube was capped and placed on a shaker at ambient temperature overnight (approximately 18 hours). The solvent was removed by vacuum centrifugation. The compounds were purified by preparative high performance liquid chromatography (prep HPLC) using a Waters Fraction Lynx automated purification system. The prep HPLC fractions were analyzed using a
Micromass LC-TOFMS, and the appropriate fractions were centrifuge evaporated to provide the trifluoroacetate salt of the desired compound. Column: Phenomenex LUNA C18(2), 21.2 x 50 millimeters (mm), 10 micron particle size, 100 Angstroms (A) pore; flow rate: 25 mL/min; non-linear gradient elution from 5-95% B in 9 min, then hold at 95% B for 2 min, where A is 0.05% trifluoroacetic acid/water and B is 0.05% trifluoroacetic acid/acetonitrile; fraction collection by mass-selective triggering. The table below shows the ketone or aldehyde used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
Figure imgf000146_0001
Figure imgf000147_0001
Figure imgf000148_0001
Figure imgf000149_0001
Figure imgf000150_0001
Examples 52 - 59
Part A Using the general method of Example 5 Part A, tert-butyl [2-(3-aminoquinolin-4- ylamino)ethyl]carbamate (43.5 g, 144 mmol) was reacted with chloroacetyl chloride (17.72 g, 158 mmol) to provide 37.39 g of tert-butyl [2-(2-chloromethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5- c] quinolin- 1 -yl)ethyl]carbamate.
Part B Using the general method of Example 5 Part B, a solution of tert-butyl [2-(2- chloromethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)ethyl]carbamate (27.45 g, 76.1 mmol) in chloroform (500 mL) was treated with 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid (25.6 g of 77% max,
114 mmol) and the resulting 5-oxide was animated using ammonium hydroxide (150 mL) andjp rø-toluenesulfonyl chloride (17.4 g, 91.3 mmol) to provide 41.83 g of crude tert- butyl [2-(4-amino-2-chloromethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)ethyl]carbamate as a brown solid. A portion (~32 g) of the crude material was dissolved in dichloromethane and then washed with 1 N hydrochloric acid (x3). The organic layer was allowed to stand for several days and a precipitate formed. This material was isolated by filtration to provide 7.0 g of of tert-butyl [2-(4-amino-2-chloromethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l- yl)ethyl] carbamate as an off white solid.
Part C
Using the general method of Example 5 Part C, tert-butyl [2-(4-amino-2- chloromethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)ethyl]carbamate (7 g, 19 mmol)) was reacted with N-hydroxyphthalimide (3.65 g, 22.3 mmol) to provide 6.37 g of of tert-butyl (2-{4-amino-2-[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydroisoindol-2-yl)oxymethyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-l-yl}ethyl)carbamate as a yellow solid.
1H ΝMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.3 (d, J= 8.5 Hz, IH), 7.9 (s, 4H), 7.6 (m, IH), 7.5 (m, IH), 7.3 (m, IH), 7.1 (m, IH), 6.6 (br s, 2H), 5.5 (s, 2H), 4.9 (m, 2H), 3.6 (m, 2H), 1.3 (s,
9H); MS (APCL) m/z 503.2 (M + H)+.
Part D Using the general method of Example 5 Part D, the N-phthalimide protecting group was removed from tert-butyl (2-{4-amino-2-[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydroisoindol-2- yl)oxymethyl]-17J-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl}ethyl)carbamate (6.35 g) to provide crude tert-butyl [2-(4-amino-2-aminooxymethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l- yl)ethyl] carbamate .
Part E
Acetone (25 mL) was added to a suspension of the crude material from Part D in methanol (100 mL). The resulting solution was stined at ambient temperature for 3 hours and then concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was azeotroped once with toluene, slurried with ethanol (100 mL) and then filtered. The filter cake was washed with additional ethanol. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 3.9 g of product as a yellow solid. Additional product (0.9 g) was obtained by extracting the filter cake with dichloromethane. The two lots were combined to provide 4.8 g of tert- butyl [2-(4-amino-2-isopropylideneaminooxymethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l- yl)ethyl]carbamate. Part F
Trifluoroacetic acid (10 mL) was added to a suspension of tert-butyl [2-(4-amino- 2-isopiOpylideneaminooxymethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)ethyl]carbamate (4.8 g) in dichloromethane (100 mL). The reaction became homogeneous and was stined at ambient temperature. At 2.5 hours and 3.5 hours more trifluoroacetic acid (10 mL and 5 mL respectively) was added. After a total reaction time of 4 hours the reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was azeotroped with toluene (x3) and then placed under high vacuum overnight to provide 9.97 g of propan-2-one O-{[4- amino-l-(2-aminoethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}oxime as a yellow solid. Based on the weight this material was assumed to contain 5 equivalents of trifluoroacetic acid.
Part G
An acid chloride, sulfonyl chloride, carbamoyl chloride or isocyanate from the table below (1.1 equivalents) was added to a test tube containing propan-2-one O- {[4- amino-l-(2-aminoethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}oxime trifluoroacetate
(~90 mg) prepared in Part F, NN-diisopropylethylamine (350 μL, 10 equivalents), and chlorofonn (2 mL). The test tube was capped and placed on a shaker at ambient temperature overnight (approximately 18 hours). The solvent was removed by vacuum centrifugation. The compounds were purified by preparative high performance liquid chromatography (prep HPLC) using a Waters Fraction Lynx automated purification system as described for Examples 6 - 51 above. The table below shows the acid chloride, sulfonyl chloride, carbamoyl chloride or isocyanate used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
Figure imgf000153_0001
Figure imgf000154_0001
Examples 60 - 83 An acid chloride, sulfonyl chloride, carbamoyl chloride or isocyanate from the table below (1.1 equivalents) was added to a test tube containing propan-2-one O-{[4- amino- 1 -(3-aminopropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl} oxime trifluoroacetate (90 mg), N,N-diisopropylethylamine (350 μL, 10 equivalents), and chloroform (2 mL). The test tube was capped and placed on a shaker at ambient temperature overnight (approximately 18 hours). Water (1 drop) was added and then the solvent was removed by vacuum centrifugation. The compounds were purified by preparative high performance liquid chromatography (prep HPLC) using a Waters Fraction Lynx automated purification system as described for Examples 6 - 51 above. The table below shows the acid chloride, sulfonyl chloride, carbamoyl chloride or isocyanate used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
Figure imgf000155_0001
Figure imgf000156_0001
Figure imgf000157_0001
Example 84 Acetone O- {[4-amino-l -(2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2- yl]methyl} oxime
Figure imgf000158_0001
Part A
Triethylamine (50.0 mL, 360 mmol) was added to a suspension of 4-chloro-3- nitroquinoline (50.0 g, 240 mmol) in DMF (200 mL), followed by dropwise addition of a solution of l-amino-2-methyl-propan-2-ol (23.5 g, 264 mmol) in DMF (50 mL). The reaction mixture was stined overnight at room temperature, then water (500 mL) was added and stirring was continued for 30 minutes. A solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water, and dried to yield 60.9 g of 2-methyl-l-[(3-nitroquinolin-4- yl)amino]propan-2-ol, which was used without further purification.
Part B A mixture of 2-methyl-l-[(3-nitroquinolin-4-yl)amino]propan-2-ol (60.9 g, 233 mmol), 5% platinum on carbon (6.1 g), and ethanol (500 mL) was hydrogenated on a Pan apparatus at 30 psi (2.1 x 105 Pa) for 3 hours. The mixture was filtered through CELITE filter agent, which was subsequently rinsed with methanol and dichloromethane. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield an oil that was concentrated twice from toluene to afford 56.6 g of a brown oil that was used directly in the next step.
Part C
Triethylamine (49.0 mL, 350 mmol) was added to a stined suspension of the material from Part B in dichloromethane (450 mL). A solution of chloroacetyl chloride (21.0 mL, 257 mmol) in dichloromethane (50 mL) was added dropwise over 45 minutes.
The reaction mixture was stined for approximately 3 days at room temperature. The solution was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate (500 mL) and 1:1 saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate/water (500 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with ethyl acetate (3 x 250 mL) and chloroform (250 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting pale brown solid was crystallized from dichloromethane (80 mL) to afford 25.7 g of l-[2-(chloromethyl)~lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-l-yl]-2-methylpropan-2-ol as pale yellow crystals. The mother liquor was concentrated and crystallized from dichloromethane (40 mL) to yield an additional 3.56 g of product. The mother liquor was concentrated under reduced pressure and the resulting residue was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (an automated, modular high-performance flash purification product available from Biotage, Inc, Charlottesville, Virginia, USA) (silica gel, gradient elution with 3-13% methanol in ethyl acetate) to afford 15.5 g of l-[2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl]-2- methylpropan-2-ol.
Part D mCPBA (77% pure, 36.5 g, 163 mmol) was added over 10 minutes to a stined suspension of l-[2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl]-2-methylpropan-2-ol (23.6 g, 81.4 mmol) in chloroform (500 mL). The resulting solution was stined at room temperature for 1.5 hours. Concentrated ammonium hydroxide (200 mL) was added. After 5 minutes, jt?-toluenesulfonyl chloride (18.6 g, 97.7 mmol) was added in portions. The mixture was stined at room temperature for 2.3 hours, then was transfened to a separatory funnel. The layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 100 mL, then 3 x 200 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to yield a foam. The crude product was purified in portions by chromatography on a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, elution with 5% methanol in chloroform followed by gradient elution with 5-15% methanol in chloroform) to yield 9.42 g of l-[4-amino-2-(chloromethyl)-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl]-2-methylpropan-2-ol as a pale yellow solid.
Part E A solution of l-[4-amino-2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl]-2- methylpropan-2-ol (1.00 g, 3.28 mmol) in DMF (3.0 mL) was added to a solution of N- hydroxyphthalimide (642 mg, 3.94 mmol) and triethylamine (0.915 mL, 6.56 mmol) in DMF (3.0 mL). The flask containing the solution of l-[4-amino-2-(chloromethyl)-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl]-2-methylpropan-2-ol was rinsed with DMF (3.0 mL), which was added to the reaction solution. The solution was stined at room temperature for 3 hours and a solid formed. The solid was isolated by filtration, washed with dichloromethane, and dried. The off-white solid was dissolved in hot DMF (20 mL). Acetonitrile (50 mL) was added to the solution, which was then placed in a freezer. Crystals formed and were isolated by filtration, washed with acetonitrile, and dried to provide 288 mg of 2- {[4-amino- l-(2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo [4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl]methoxy}-lH-isoindole-l,3(2H)-dione as orange crystals, mp 270.0-272.0
°C.
Anal calcd. for C23H21N5O4: C, 64.03; H, 4.91; N, 16.23. Found: C, 63.65; H, 4.65; N, 16.50.
Part F
Hydrazine (20 mL) was added to a stined suspension of 2-{[4-amino-l-(2- hydroxy-2-methylpropyl)-lH-iιnidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methoxy}-lH-isoindole- l,3(2H)-dione (14.0 g, 32.4 mmol) in ethanol (100 mL). The mixture was stined at room temperature and after 5 minutes a solution formed. After 1 hour, a solid began to form and additional ethanol (100 mL) was added. After 4.5 hours, the solid was isolated by filtration, washed with dichloromethane, and dried to yield 9.30 g of l-{4-amino-2- [(aminooxy)methyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl}-2-methylpropan-2-ol as a yellow solid, some of which was used without further purification in the next step. Two batches of the product (6.63 g and 1.00 g) were purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 5-15% of 2 M NH3 in methanol/chloroform) to provide 4.45 g and 650 mg of l-{4-amino-2-[(aminooxy)methyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-l-yl}-2-methylpropan-2-ol as a yellow solid, respectively. Some of the chromatographed product (650 mg) was crystallized from acetonitrile to yield 377 mg of l-{4-amino-2-[(aminooxy)methyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl}-2-methylpropan-2-ol as pale yellow crystals, mp 178.0-179.0 °C. Anal calcd. for Cι5H19N5O2: C, 59.79; H, 6.36; N, 23.24. Found: C, 59.93; H, 6.38; N, 23.40.
Part G A solution of l-{4-amino-2-[(aminooxy)methyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl}-
2-methylpropan-2-ol (800 mg, 2.65 mmol) in acetone (10 mL) and methanol (10 mL) was stined for 20 hours at room temperature, then was concentrated under reduced pressure.
The resulting yellow solid was purified by chromatography on a HORIZON HPFC system
(silica gel, gradient elution with 5-15% methanol in chloroform) followed by crystallization from acetonitrile to yield 400 mg of acetone O- { [4-amino- 1 -(2-hydroxy-2- methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}oxime as pale yellow crystals, mp
212-216 °C.
1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.27 (d, J= 8.3 Hz, IH), 7.60 (dd, J= 8.3, 1.3 Hz, IH),
7.41 (ddd, J= 8.3, 7.0, 1.3 Hz, IH), 7.21 (ddd, J= 8.3, 7.0, 1.3 Hz, IH), 6.61 (s, 2H), 5.44 (br s, 2H), 4.93 (s, IH), 4.73 (br s, 2H), 1.80 (s, 3H), 1.78 (s, 3H), 1.17 (br s, 6H);
MS (APCI) m/z 342.1 (M + H)+;
Anal, calcd for C18H23N5O2: C, 63.32; H, 6.79; N, 20.51. Found: C, 63.32; H, 7.00; N,
20.65.
Example 85
N-{2-[4-Amino-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy} methyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-
1 -yl] ethyl} -N-isopropylurea
Figure imgf000161_0001
Isopropyl isocyanate (0.262 mL, 2.66 mmol) was added to a stined solution of the material prepared in Parts A-F of Examples 52-59 (2.42 mmol) and triethylamine (1.70 mL, 12.1 mmol) in dichloromethane (25 mL) at room temperature. After 10 minutes, a solid formed. After 1 hour, the reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield a solid that was purified by chromatography on a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 5-25% methanol in chloroform). The appropriate fractions were combined and concentrated under reduced pressure to yield 1.73 g of a white solid that was crystallized from acetonitrile to afford 650 mg of N-{2-[4-amino-2-({[(l- methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl]ethyl}-N- isopropylurea as a hydrate and partial trifluoroacetate salt, white crystals, mp 230.0-231.0
°C.
1H ΝMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 9.17 (br s, 2H), 8.54 (d, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 7.81 (dd, J= 8.3, 0.9 Hz, IH), 7.73 (m, IH), 7.56 (m, IH), 6.08 (t, J= 5.7 Hz IH), 5.92 (d, J= 7.8 Hz,
IH), 5.32 (s, 2H), 4.75 (t, J= 6.1 Hz, 2H), 3.61 (m, IH), 3.49 (m, 2H), 1.84 (s, 3H), 1.80 (s, 3H), 0.98 (d, J= 6.4 Hz, 6H); MS (APCI) m/z 398.2 (M + H)+; Anal calcd. for C20H27Ν7O2 »0.7 CF3CO2H-1.0 H2O: C, 51.89; H, 6.04; N, 19.80. Found: C, 51.99; H, 5.78; N, 19.74.
Example 86 N-{3-[4-Amino-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-
' l-yl]propyl}-N-isopropylurea
Figure imgf000162_0001
The method described in Example 85 was used to convert the material prepared in
Parts A-F of Example 5 (2.58 mmol) into 440 mg of N-{3-[4-amino-2-({[(l- methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl]propyl}-N- isopropylurea, which was isolated as the hydrate and partial trifluoroacetate salt, white crystals, mp 184.0-186.0 °C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.55 (br s, 2H), 8.18 (d, J= 7.8 Hz, Iff), 7.77 (dd, J= 8.4, 1.1 Hz, IH), 7.67 (m, IH), 7.49 (m, IH), 6.05 (t, J= 5.8 Hz IH), 5.86 (d, J= 1.1 Hz, IH), 5.34 (s, 2H), 4.65 (t, J= 7.8 Hz, 2H), 3.70 (m, IH), 3.20 (m, 2H), 1.97 (m, 2H), 1.84 (s, 3H), 1.81 (s, 3H), 1.05 (d, J= 6.6 Hz, 6H); MS (APCI) m/z 412.2 (M + H)+;
Anal calcd. for C21H29N7O2*0.5 CF3CO2H'1.0 H2O: C, 54.31; H, 6.53; N, 20.15. Found: C, 54.19; H, 6.14; N, 20.13.
Example 87 N-{4-[4-Amino-6,7-dimethyl-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-l-yl]butyl}methanesulfonamide
Figure imgf000163_0001
Part A
A solution of tert-butyl 4-aminobutylcarbamate (8.50 g, 45.2 mmol) inDMF (20 mL) in an addition funnel was added over 1 hour to a stined solution of 2,4-dichloro-5,6- dimethyl-3-nitropyridine (10.0 g, 45.2 mmol) and triethylamine (9.30 mL, 67.8 mmol) in DMF (100 mL). The addition funnel was rinsed with DMF (17 mL) and the solution was added to the reaction vessel. After the reaction solution was stined overnight at room temperature, additional tert-butyl 4-aminobutylcarbamate (0.1 equivalent) was added. The solution was allowed to stir an additional 2 hours, then was concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting oil was partitioned between ethyl acetate (400 mL) and water (100 mL). The organic phase was washed with water (4 x 50 mL), then was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, elution with 33% ethyl acetate in hexanes followed by 66% ethyl acetate in hexanes) to afford 9.2 g of tert-butyl 4-[(2-chloro-5,6- dimethyl-3-mtropyridin-4-yl)amino]butylcarbamate. Part B
The purified tert-butyl 4-[(2-chloro-5,6-dimethyl-3-nifropyridin-4- yl)amino]butylcarbamate from A was combined with crude tert-butyl 4-[(2-chloro-5,6- dimethyl-3-nitropyridin-4-yl)amino]butylcarbamate from a similar experiment to yield 38 g (approximately 101 mmol) of material, which was combined with sodium azide (13.0 g, 202 mmol), cerium(LH) chloride heptahydrate (19.0 g, 51.0 mmol), and 9:1 acetontrile/water (300 mL). The reaction mixture was heated at reflux for 3 days, then was allowed to cool to room temperature and was filtered. The filter cake was rinsed with DMF. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield an oil that was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, elution with 2:1:1 ethyl acetate/hexanes/chloroform, followed by 4:1 ethyl acetate/chloroform) to afford 23 g of tert-butyl 4-[(5,6-dimethyl-8-mtrotetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl)amino]butylcarbamate.
Part C
A mixture of tert-butyl 4-[(5,6-dimethyl-8-nitrotetraazolo[l,5-a]pyridin-7- yl)amino]butylcarbamate (9.00 g, 23.7 mmol), 10% palladium on carbon (900 mg), and acetontrile (100 mL) was hydrogenated on a Parr apparatus for 5 hours. The mixture was filtered through CELITE filter agent, which was rinsed afterwards with methanol. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield 6.70 g of tert-butyl 4-[(8-amino-
5,6-dimethyltetraazolo[ 1 ,5-α]pyridin-7-yl)amino]butylcarbamate.
Part D
Ethyl 2-chloroethanimidoate hydrochloride (ethyl chloroacetimidate hydrochloride) (2.58 g, 16.4 mmol) was added to a solution of tert-butyl 4-[(8-amino-5,6- dimethyltetraazolo[l,5-Ω]pyridin-7-yl)amino]butylcarbamate (3.80 g, 10.9 mmol) in chloroform (75 mL). The solution was stined for 3 days, then saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (40 mL) was added. The aqueous phase was extracted with chloroform (3 x 40 mL). The organic phases were combined, washed with water (2 x 20 mL) and saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (20 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford 4.3 g of tert-butyl 4-[8-(chloromethyl)-5,6- dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-fl]pyridin-7-yl]butylcarbamate, which was used in the next step without purification.
Part E tert-Butyl 4-[8-(chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5- ]pyridin-7-yl]butylcarbamate (4.05 g, 9.40 mmol) was dissolved in 4 M HCl in dioxane (25 mL). Almost immediately, a solid precipitated and methanol was added (25 mL). After 10 minutes, the reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure and the residue was dried under vacuum. The residue was dissolved in dichloromethane (50 mL) and the solution was cooled to 0 °C, then triethylamine (5.24 mL, 37.6 mmol) was added followed by methanesulfonic anhydride (2.46 g, 14.1 mmol). After 10 minutes, more triethylamine and methanesulfonic anhydride (2 equivalents each) were added and stirring was continued for 50 minutes. The reaction mixture was partitioned between saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (20 mL) and dichloromethane (40 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 15 mL). The organic layers were combined, washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (2 x 20 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to yield an off-white solid. The solid was dissolved in dichloromethane/chloroform and the solution was transferred to a separatory funnel. The solution was washed with saturated aqueous sodium carbonate, water, and saturated aqueous sodium carbonate. The solution was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to yield 2.1 g of N-{4-[8- (chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5- ]pyridin-7- yl]butyl}methanesulfonamide.
Part F
N-Hydroxyphthalimide (64 mg, 0.39 mmol) was added to a stined solution of N- {4-[8-(chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7- yl]butyl}methanesulfonamide (100 mg, 0.26 mmol) in DMF (2.6 mL). Triethylamine (0.109 mL, 0.78 mmol) was added dropwise, causing the solution to turn red. After 3 hours, more N-hydroxyphthalimide and triethylamine (3 equivalents each) were added and stirring was continued overnight. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure. To the resulting oil was added ethyl acetate and water, which caused a yellow solid to form. The solid was isolated by filtration, washed with chloroform, and then was triturated with ethyl acetate and isolated by filtration to afford N-[4-(8-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H- isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl}-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7- yl)butyl]methanesulfonamide as a yellow solid.
Part G
A mixture of N-[4-(8-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H-isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl}-5,6- dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5- ]pyridin-7-yl)butyl]methanesulfonamide (205 mg, 0.40 mmol), hydrazine hydrate (0.4 mL), and ethanol (4 mL) was stined for 30 minutes. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was partitioned between 1 M aqueous HCl (20 mL) and dichloromethane (10 mL). The aqueous phase was washed with dichloromethane (3 x 8 mL), then was adjusted to pH 12 with 1 M aqueous sodium hydroxide and was concentrated under reduced pressure. To the residue was added acetone (10 mL) and methanol (10 mL), and the reaction mixture was stined for 3 hours. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was partitioned between dichloromethane (20 mL) and saturated aqueous sodium carbonate (20 mL). The aqueous phase was extracted with dichloromethane (3 x 10 mL). The organic layers were combined, washed with saturated aqueous sodium carbonate (3 x 10 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude product was purified by chromatography on a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 20-40% CMA in chloroform, where CMA is 80:18:2 chloroform/methanol concentrated ammonium hydroxide) to yield 91 mg of N-{4-[5,6- dimethyl-8-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5- α]pyridin-7-yl]butyl}methanesulfonamide as a white foam.
Part H
A mixture of N- {4- [5 ,6-dimethyl-8-( { [( 1 -methylethylidene)amino] oxy} methyl)- 7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl]butyl}methanesulfonamide (720 mg, 1.70 mmol), triphenylphosphine (670 mg, 2.55 mmol), and 1,2-dichlorobenzene (15 mL) was heated at 110 °C for 2 days. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 15-45% CMA in chloroform) to yield starting material and the ylide product, which were combined and resubmitted to the reaction conditions for 5 days. After 5 days, the temperature was increased to 120 °C and stining was continued for another day. The reaction was allowed to cool to room temperature and was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield a residue that was purified using the conditions described above to afford the N-triphenylphosphinyl ylide product. That material was divided and treated with 1 M HCl in methanol at room temperature or with methanol and water at 60 °C. The two reactions were combined and the methanol was removed under reduced pressure. The acidic aqueous layer was washed with dichloromethane (3 x 5 mL), then was adjusted to a basic pH with sodium carbonate. The mixture was extracted with dichloromethane (3 x 20 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude product was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 15- 35% CMA in chloroform) followed by crystallization from dichloromethane/heptane to afford 104 mg of N-{4-[4-amino-6,7-dimethyl-2-({[(l- methylethylidene)amino] oxy} methyl)- lH-imidazo [4,5 -clpyridin- 1 - yl]butyl}methanesulfonamide as a white powder, mp 157.0-159.0 °C. Anal. Calcd for C17H28Ν6O3S: C, 51.50; H, 7.12; N, 21.19; Found: C, 51.41; H, 7.22; N, 21.17.
Example 88
N-{4-[4-Amino-6,7-dimethyl-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH- imidazo [4,5 -cjpyridin- 1 -yljbutyl} -N-cyclohexylurea
Figure imgf000168_0001
Part A
Concentrated hydrochloric acid (10 mL) was added to a suspension of tert-butyl 4- [8-(chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7- yljbutylcarbamate (prepared in Parts A-D of Example 87, 1.00 g, 2.30 mmol) in methanol (23 mL). The reaction mixture was stined at room temperature for 2 hours, then was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield a residue. The residue was concentrated twice from toluene to remove residual water, then was triturated with methanol. A solid was isolated by filtration and was dried under vacuum to provide 0.68 g of 4-[8- (chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-a]pyridin-7-yl]butan-l- amine hydrochloride.
Part B
Cyclohexyl isocyanate (0.285 mL, 2.20 mmol) was added to a flask containing 4- [8-(chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7iJ-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl]butan-l- amine hydrochloride (680 mg, 1.98 mmol), triethylamine (0.311 mL, 2.2 mmol), and dichloromethane (20 mL). The reaction mixture was stined at room temperature for 2 hours and additional triethylamine and cyclohexyl isocyanate (1.1 equivalents each) were added. The reaction mixture was stined overnight at room temperature, then was partitioned between dichloromethane (50 mL) and 2:1 water/saturated aqueous sodium carbonate (30 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (3 x 20 mL). The organic layers were combined, washed with 0.5 M aqueous sodium hydroxide (2 x 30 mL), and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting white solid was triturated with ethyl acetate, isolated by filtration, and washed with ethyl acetate and water to provide 777 mg of N-{4-[8-(chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5- α]pyridin-7-yl]butyl}-N-cyclohexylurea.
Part C
N-Hydroxyphthalimide (5.32 g, 32.6 mmol) and triethylamine (4.54 mL, 32.6 mmmol) were added to a suspension of N-{4-[8-(chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H- imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl]butyl}-N-cyclohexylurea (9.00 g, 23.3 mmol) in DMF (1 L). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir overnight, then was concentrated under reduced pressure to a white slurry. Methanol was added and a white solid was isolated by filtration, washed with methanol, and dried under vacuum to afford 11.6 g of N-cyclohexyl-N-[4-(8-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H-isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl}-5,6- dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl)butyl]urea.
Part D
Anhydrous hydrazine (0.50 mL, 16.1 mmol) was added to a stined suspension of N-cyclohexyl-N-[4-(8-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H-isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl}-5,6- dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl)butyl]urea (3.00 g, 5.36 mmol) in ethanol (36 mL). Over the next hour, dichloromethane (40 mL) and ethanol (20 mL) were added to prevent the reaction from solidifying. After one more hour, the solvent was removed under reduced pressure, then acetone (27 mL) and methanol (27 mL) were added. The mixture was stined at room temperature for 2 hours, then a solid was isolated by filtration and washed with methanol. To the solid was added 1 M aqueous sodium hydroxide and the mixture was sonicated for 1 minute. The solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water, and dried under vacuum at 70 °C to provide 2.36 g of N- cyclohexyl-N-{4-[5,6-dimethyl-8-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-7H- imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[ 1 ,5-α]pyridin-7-yl]butyl}urea. Part E
A mixture of N-cyclohexyl-N-{4-[5,6-dimethyl-8-({[(l- methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-β]pyridin-7- yl]butyl}urea (2.30 g, 4.90 mmol), triphenylphosphine (2.81 g, 10.7 mmol), and 1,2- dichlorobenzene (50 mL) was heated at 120 °C for 1 day. The reaction mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature and was stined overnight. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was triturated with methanol/ethyl acetate to afford 1.5 g of the starting material after filtration. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure and the residue was combined with the 1.5 g of starting material. The combined material was resubjected to the reaction conditions for 2 days. The reaction mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature, concentrated under reduced pressure, and was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 5-30% CMA in chloroform) to provide the ylide product. The ylide product was dissolved in methanol/water/acetic acid and heated at 50 °C for 1 day. More acetic acid was added and the reaction was heated at 55 °C for 1 more day. The reaction was allowed to cool to room temperature and was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was partitioned between saturated aqueous sodium carbonate (100 mL) and chloroform (100 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with chloroform (3 x 40 mL). The organic layers were combined, washed with saturated aqueous sodium carbonate (2 x 20 mL), dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The material was purified by chromatography, followed by trituration with dichloromethane/ethyl acetate, followed by crystallization from 2-propanol/water to afford a solid that was treated with 1 M aqueous HCl, isolated by filtration, and dried to afford 38 mg of N-{4-[4-amino- 6,7-dimethyl-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-l- yl]butyl}-N-cyclohexylurea as a white powder, mp 210.0-212.0 °C.
Anal. Calcd for C23H37Ν7O2*1.0 HC1-0.2 H2O: C, 57.12; H, 8.00; N, 20.27; Found: C, 57.42; H, 8.39; N, 20.30. Example 89
N-{4-[4-Amino-6,7-dimethyl-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-l-yl]butyl}benzamide
Figure imgf000171_0001
Part A
Benzoic anhydride (3.1 g, 13.8 mmol) was added to a flask containing 4-[8- (chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[ 1 ,5- ]pyridin-7-yl]butan- 1 - amine hydrochloride (prepared as described in Part A of Example 88, 4.30 g, 12.5 mmol), triethylamine (3.70 mL, 26.3 mmol), and dichloromethane (100 mL) at 0 °C. The reaction mixture was stined at room temperature for 1 day and additional triethylamine (0.5 mL) and benzoic anhydride (0.8 g) were added. The reaction mixture was stined for 6 hours at room temperature. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure and water (50 mL) followed by ethyl acetate (50 mL) were added to the solid residue. The mixture was sonicated for 1 minute, then the solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water and ethyl acetate, and dried under vacuum to afford 4.7 g of N-{4-[8-(chloromethyl)-5,6- dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl]butyl}benzamide.
Part B
The method described in Part C of Example 88 was used to convert 4.7 g of N-{4- [8-(chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tefraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7- yl]butyl}benzamide into 5.7 g of N-[4-(8-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H-isoindol-2- yl)oxy]methyl}-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7- yl)butyl]benzamide. Part C
Anhydrous hydrazine (0.47 mL, 15 mmol) was added to a stined suspension of N- [4-(8-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H-isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl}-5,6-dimethyl-7H- imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl)butyl]benzamide (2.8 g, 5.0 mmol) in ethanol (50 mL). After two hours, a solid was isolated by filtration and the filter calce was washed with ethanol. Acetone (25 mL) and methanol (25 mL) were added to the solid and the mixture was stined overnight. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure to afford a solid that was triturated with 1 M aqueous sodium hydroxide (10 mL) and 1:1 methanol/acetone (4 mL). The solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water, and dissolved in chloroform (100 mL). The solution was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, concentrated under reduced pressure, and dried under vacuum to afford 1.9 g of a N-{4-[5,6-dimethyl-8-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-7H-imidazo[4,5- c]tefraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl]butyl}benzamide as a white solid.
Part D
A mixture of N-{4-[5,6-dimethyl-8-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)- 7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tefraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl]butyl}benzamide (1.9 g, 4.2 mmol), triphenylphosphine (2.2 g, 8.4 mmol), and 1,2-dichlorobenzene (40 mL) was heated at 125 °C for 2 days. The reaction was allowed to cool to room temperature and was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in methanol (20 mL) and
1 M aqueous hydrochloric acid (20 mL) and heated at 40 °C for 6 hours. The reaction was allowed to stand at room temperature overnight and a white precipitate formed that was removed by filtration. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure and the residue was partitioned between 1 M aqueous hydrochloric acid (20 mL) and chloroform (10 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with chloroform (3 x 10 mL). The organic layers were combined, washed with saturated aqueous sodium carbonate, dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The solid was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 10- 35% CMA in chloroform). The appropriate fractions were combined and concentrated under reduced pressure. The solid was triturated with ethyl acetate and was isolated by filtration, washed with ethyl acetate, and dried under vacuum at 50 °C overnight to provide 0.85 g ofN-{4-[4-amino-6,7-dimethyl-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH"- imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-l-yl]butyl}benzamide as a white powder, mp 206.0-208.0 °C. Anal. Calcd for C23H30Ν6O2«0.06 CHC13: C, 64.46; H, 7.05; N, 19.56; Found: C, 64.31; H, 7.06; N, 19.55.
Example 90
N-{4-[4-Amino-6,7-dimethyl-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-l-yl]butyl}-2-methylpropanamide
Figure imgf000173_0001
Part A
Isobutyric anhydride (2.28 mL, 13.8 mmol) was added to a flask containing 4-[8- (chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl]butan-l- amine hydrochloride (prepared as described in Part A of Example 88, 4.30 g, 12.5 mmol), triethylamine (3.66 mL, 26.3 mmol), and dichloromethane (100 mL) at 0 °C. The reaction mixture was stined at room temperature for 3 hours. The solution was concentrated under reduced pressure and water (50 mL) followed by ethyl acetate (50 mL) were added to the solid residue. The mixture was sonicated for 1 minute, then the solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water and ethyl acetate. Toluene was added to the solid and the mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure. The solid was dried under vacuum to afford 4.12 g of N-{4-[8-(chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5- ]pyridin-7-yl]butyl}-2-methylpropanamide.
Part B
The general method described in Part C of Example 88 was used to convert 4.10 g N- {4-[8-(chloromethyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tefraazolo[ 1 ,5-α]pyridin-7- yl]butyl}-2-methylproρanamide into 4.92 g of N-[4-(8-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H- isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl}-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7- yl)butyl]-2-methylpropanamide.
Part C Anhydrous hydrazine (0.91 mL, 29 mmol) was added to a stined suspension of N-
[4-(8-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H-isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl}-5,6-dimethyl-7H- imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl)butyl]-2-methylpropanamide (4.90 g, 9.71 mmol) in ethanol (100 mL). Dichloromethane (50 mL) was added. After four hours, acetone (50 L) was added and the reaction mixture was stirred overnight. A solid was removed by filtration and washed with methanol. The filtrate was concenfrated to provide a solid that was triturated with 1:1 saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate/water. The solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water, and dissolved in chloroform (300 mL). The solution was washed with water (2 x 50 mL), dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, concentrated under reduced pressure, and dried under vacuum to afford N-{4-[5,6- dimethyl-8-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5- α]pyridin-7-yl]butyl}-2-methylpropanamide that was used in the next experiment.
Part D
A mixture of N-{4-[5,6-dimethyl-8-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)- 7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[ 1 ,5-α]pyridin-7-yl]butyl} -2-methylpropanamide (from Part
C, approximately 9.71 mmol), triphenylphosphine (5.1 g, 19 mmol), and 1,2- dichlorobenzene (97 mL) was heated at 125 °C for 2 days, then stined at room temperature for 3 days, then heated at 130 °C for 5 hours. The reaction was allowed to cool to room temperature and was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in methanol (80 mL) and 1 M aqueous hydrochloric acid (40 mL) and heated at 40 °C for 6 hours. The reaction was allowed to stir at room temperature overnight and a white precipitate formed that was removed by filtration. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure and the residue was partitioned between 1 M aqueous hydrochloric acid (20 mL) and chloroform (10 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with chloroform (3 x 10 mL). The organic layers were combined, washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate, dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The solid was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 5-55% CMA in chloroform). The appropriate fractions were combined and concenfrated under reduced pressure. The resulting solid was triturated with acetonitrile and then was recrystallized from acetonitrile to provide N-{4-[4-amϊno- 6,7-dimethyl-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-l- yl]butyl}-2-methylpropanamide as a white powder, mp 180.0-181.0 °C. Anal. Calcd for C20H32Ν6O2: C, 61.83; H, 8.30; N, 21.63; Found: C, 61.65; H, 8.65; N, 21.70.
Example 91
N-{4-[4-Amino-2-({[ethylideneamino]oxy}methyl)-6,7-dimethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]pyridin-l-yl]butyl}benzamide
Figure imgf000175_0001
Part A Anhydrous hydrazine (0.481 mL, 15.3 mmol) was added to a stined suspension of
N-[4-(8-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H-isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl}-5,6-dimethyl-7H- imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl)butyl]benzamide (prepared as described in Part B of Example 89, 2.86 g, 5.11 mmol) in ethanol (50 mL). The reaction was stined overnight and then was concentrated under reduced pressure. Methanol (25 mL) was added and the mixture was cooled to 0 °C. Acetaldehyde (2.9 mL) was added and the reaction mixture was stined overnight. The reaction mixture was concenfrated partially under reduced pressure, then 1 M aqueous sodium hydroxide (50 mL) was added and the mixture was sonicated for 1 minute. The solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water, and dried under vacuum at 70 °C to provide a 3:1 ratio of oxime isomers of N-{4- [8-({[ethylideneamino]oxy}methyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H-imidazo[4,5-c]tetraazolo[l,5- α]pyridin-7-yl]butyl}benzamide. Part B
A mixture of N-{4-[8-({[ethylideneamino]oxy}methyl)-5,6-dimethyl-7H- imidazo[4,5-c]tefraazolo[l,5-α]pyridin-7-yl]butyl}benzamide (2.0 g, 4.6 mmol), triphenylphosphine (2.4 g, 9.2 mmol), and 1,2-dichlorobenzene (50 mL) was heated at 125 °C for 2 days. The reaction mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature and was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in methanol (40 mL) and 1 M aqueous hydrochloric acid (20 mL) was added. The mixture was heated at 50 °C for 6 hours. The mixture was allowed to stand at room temperature overnight and a white precipitate formed that was removed by filtration. The methanol was removed under reduced pressure and chloroform (20 mL) was added. The aqueous phase was adjusted to pH 12 with 1 M aqueous sodium hydroxide. The aqueous phase was extracted with chloroform (3 x 10 mL). The organic phases were combined, dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The material was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 10- 35% CMA in chloroform). The appropriate fractions were combined and concenfrated under reduced pressure to provide a solid that was triturated with acetontrile, crystallized from acetontrile, and purified again by chromatography as described above using 5-40% CMA in chloroform as the eluent to provide 32 mg of N-{4-[4-amino-2- ({[ethylideneamino]oxy}methyl)-6,7-dimethyl-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-l- yl]butyl}benzamide as a white powder and as a mixture (approximately 1 : 1 mixture) of oxime isomers, mp 192.0-194.0 °C.
Anal. Calcd for C22H28Ν6O2 «0.07 CHC13: C, 63.59; H, 6.79; N, 20.16; Found: C, 63.25; H, 7.03; N, 20.43.
Example 92
N-{3-[4-Amino-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c] [ 1 ,5]naphthyridin- 1 -yljpropyl} -2-methylpropanamide
Figure imgf000177_0001
Part A
A solution of tert-butyl 3-aminopropylcarbamate (15.7 g, 90.2 mmol) in dichloromethane (50 mL) was added dropwise over 30 minutes to a solution of 4-chloro-3- nitro[l,5]naphthyridine (18.0 g, 85.9 mmol) and triethylamine (15.6 mL, 112 mmol) in dichloromethane (235 mL) at room temperature. The reaction mixture was stined for 2.5 hours and then concentrated under reduced pressure to afford an orange solid. Water (300 mL) was added and the mixture was stined for 1 hour. The solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water (3 x 50 mL), and dried under vacuum at 70 °C to afford 29.5 g of tert- butyl 3-[(3-nifro[l,5]naphthyridin-4-yl)aιnino]propylcarbamate as a yellow solid.
Part B
A mixture of tert-butyl 3-[(3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridin-4-yl)amino]propylcarbamate (20.0 g, 57.6 mmol), 5% platinum on carbon, and ethyl acetate was hydrogenated on a Pan apparatus for 2 hours at 30 psi (2.1 x 105 Pa). The mixture was filtered through CELITE filter agent, which was rinsed afterwards with ethyl acetate (150 mL). The filtrate was concentrated to afford tert-butyl 3-[(3-amino[l,5]naphthyridin-4- yl)amino]propylcarbamate as a yellow foam, all of which was used in the next step.
Part C
Chloroacetyl chloride (5.00 mL, 63.4 mmol) was added dropwise to a 0 °C solution of tert-butyl 3-[(3-amino[ 1 ,5]naphthyridin-4-yl)amino]propylcarbamate (from Part B, approximately 57.6 mmol) in dichloromethane (230 mL). The reaction was allowed to warm to room temperature and was stined for 1 hour. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure to afford tert-butyl 3-({3-[(chloroacetyl)amino]-[l,5]naphthyridin-4- yl}amino)propylcarbamate hydrochloride as a solid, all of which was used in the next step.
Part D
To a solution of tert-butyl 3-({3-[(chloroacetyl)amino][l,5]naphthyridin-4- yl}amino)propylcarbamate hydrochloride (from Part C, approximately 57.6 mmol) in 3:1 ethanol/water (240 mL) was added 6 M aqueous potassium carbonate. The reaction mixture was stined at room temperature for 1 hour, 40 °C for 1.5 hour, then at room temperature overnight. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure and the residue was partitioned between dichloromethane (250 mL) and water (150 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 75 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford 18.9 g of tert-butyl 3-[2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-l- yljpropylcarbamate.
Part E
Concentrated hydrochloric acid (15 mL) was added to a suspension of tert-butyl 3- [2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl]propylcarbamate (8.0 g, 21.3 mmol) in methanol (90 mL). The resulting solution was allowed to stir at room temperature for 72 hours. A solid formed that was isolated by filtration, washed with a minimal amount of methanol, and dried under vacuum to afford 6.11 g of 3-[2- (chloromethyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c] [ 1 ,5]naphthyridin- 1 -yljpropan- 1 -amine hydrochloride as a pale yellow solid.
Part F wo-Butyric anhydride (0.850 mL, 5.11 mmol) and triethylamine (1.50 mL, 10.7 mmol) were added to a suspension of 3-[2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl]propan-l-amine hydrochloride (1.33 g, 4.26 mmol) in dichloromethane (25 mL). The reaction mixture was stined for 3 hours and the suspension slowly dissolved. The solution was partitioned between dichloromethane (20 mL) and saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (30 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (20 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated to afford 1.41 g ofN-{3-[2-(chloromethyl)-lH- imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl]propyl}-2-methylpropanamide, which was used without further purification.
Part G mCPBA (0.985 g, 5.71 mmol) was added to a suspension of N-{3-[2- (chloromethyl)- lH-imidazo [4,5-c] [ 1 ,5]naphthyridin- 1 -yljpropyl} -2-methylpropanamide
(1.41 g, 4.08 mmol) in chloroform (20 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir for 4 hours at room temperature. Concentrated ammonium hydroxide (5 mL) followed by p- toluenesulfonyl chloride (0.854 g, 4.48 mmol) were added and the mixture was stined at room temperature for 1 hour. The mixture was diluted with chloroform (25 mL) and brine (40 mL) and transfened to a separatory funnel. The aqueous layer was extracted with chloroform (20 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concenfrated to afford a tan solid. Trituration with methanol and isolation by filtration afforded 0.670 g ofN-{3-[4-amino-2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c] [ 1 ,5]naphthyridin- 1 -yljpropyl} -2-methylpropanamide.
Part H
Triethylamine (0.340 mL, 2.41 mmol) and N-hydroxyphthalimide (0.333 g, 2.04 mmol) were added to a suspension of N-{3-[4-amino-2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-l -yljpropyl} -2-methylpropanamide (0.670 g, 1.86 mmol) in DMF (10 mL). The reaction was allowed to stir at room temperature for 4 hours, then was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was triturated with methanol to afford 0.848 g of N-[3-(4-amino-2-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H-isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl}-lH- imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl)propyl]-2-methylpropanamide as a tan solid. Part i
Anhydrous hydrazine (0.160 mL, 5.22 mmol) was added to a suspension of N-[3- (4-amino-2-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H-isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl}-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]- [l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl)propyl]-2-methylpropanamide (0.848 g, 1.74 mmol) in ethanol (10 mL). The mixture was allowed to stir at room temperature for 2.5 hours, then was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield crude N-(3-{4-amino-2-[(aminooxy)methyl]- lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl}propyl)-2-methylpropanamide as a yellow solid, all of which was used in the next step.
Part J
Acetone (1 mL) was added to a solution of the N-(3-{4-amino-2- [(aminooxy)methyl]- lH-imidazo[4,5-c] [ 1 ,5]naphthyridin- 1 -yl}propyl)-2- methylpropanamide from Part I in methanol (10 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir overnight at room temperature. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure and the residue was purified by chromatography on a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel,
0-25% CMA in chloroform) to afford 0.495 g of N-{3-[4-amino-2-({[(l- methylethylidene)amino]oxy} methyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl]propyl}-2- methylpropanamide as off-white needles, mp 195-197 °C. MS (APCI) m/z 398 (M + H)+; Anal, calcd for C20H27Ν7O2: C, 60.44; H, 6.85; N, 24.67. Found: C, 60.28; H, 7.14; N,
24.34.
Example 93
N-{3-[4-Amino-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]-l,5- naphthyridin- 1 -yljpropyl} -N-cyclohexylurea
Figure imgf000181_0001
Part A
Cyclohexyl isocyanate (0.70 mL, 5.50 mmol) and triethylamine (1.74 mL, 12.5 mmol) were added to a stined suspension of 3-[2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl]propan-l -amine hydrochloride (prepared as described in Parts A- E of Example 92, 1.56 g, 5.00 mmol) in dichloromethane (25 mL). A solution eventually formed from which a solid precipitated: The mixture was allowed to stand at room temperature overnight, then the solid was isolated by filtration and washed with a minimal amount of dichloromethane to afford 1.52 g of N-{3-[2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl]propyl}-N-cyclohexylurea as a white solid.
Part B mCPBA (0.982 g, 5.69 mmol) was added to a suspension of N-{3-[2- (chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl]propyl}-N-cyclohexylurea (1.52 g, 3.79 mmol) in chloroform (20 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir for 4 hours, then additional mCPBA (1 equivalent) was added. After 2 hours, the reaction mixture was diluted with chloroform and washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (2 x 40 mL). The aqueous layers were combined and back-extracted with chloroform (20 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated to afford 1.61 g of a pale yellow solid. The solid was suspended in chloroform (20 mL) and concentrated ammonium hydroxide (5 mL) andp- toluenesulfonyl chloride (0.795 g, 4.17 mmol) were added. The reaction mixture was allowed to stir at room temperature for 2 hours, then the product was isolated by filtration to afford 0.972 g ofN-{3-[4-amino-2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin- 1 -yljpropyl} -N-cyclohexylurea as a white solid.
Part C
The general method described in Part H of Example 92 was used to convert N-{3- [4-amino-2-(chloromethyl)-lHr-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl]propyl}-N- cyclohexylurea (0.972 g, 2.34 mmol) into 0.738 g of N-[3-(4-amino-2-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3- dihydro-2H-isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl} - lH-imidazo [4,5-c] [ 1 ,5]naphthyridin- 1 -yl)propyl] - N-cyclohexylurea, which was isolated as a white solid.
Part D
The general method described in Part I of Example 92 was used to convert N-[3-(4- amino-2-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H-isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl}-lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl)propyl]-N-cyclohexylurea (0.738 g, 1.36 mmol) into 0.561 g of N-(3- {4-amino-2-[(aminooxy)methyl]- lH-imidazo[4,5-c] [ 1 ,5]naphthyridin-l -yl}propyl)- N-cyclohexylurea, which was isolated as a white solid and used without purification in the next step.
Part E (
A modification on the general method described in Part J of Example 92 was used to convert N-(3- {4-amino-2-[(aminooxy)methyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5-c] [ 1 ,5]naphthyridin- 1 - yl}propyl)-N-cyclohexylurea (from Part D, approximately 1.36 mmol) into 0.403 g of N- {3-[4-amino-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl]propyl}-N-cyclohexylurea. The crude product was purified by chromatography on a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, 0-30% CMA in chloroform). N-{3-[4-amino-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH'-imidazo[4,5-c]-l,5- naphthyridin-1 -yljpropyl} -N-cyclohexylurea was isolated as white needles, mp 207-208 °C.
MS (APCI) m/z 453 (M + H)+; Anal, calcd for C23H32N8O2: C, 61.04; H, 7.13; N, 24.76. Found: C, 60.98; H, 7.27; N, 24.80.
Example 94 tert-Butyl 3 - [4-amino-2-( { [( 1 -methylethylidene)amino] oxy} methyl)- lH-imidazo [4, 5 -c] -
1,5-naphthyridin-l-yljpropylcarbamate
Figure imgf000183_0001
Part A
N-Hydroxyphthalimide (2.06 g, 12.7 mmol) and triethylamine (2.40 mL, 17.3 mmol) were added to a solution of tert-butyl 3-[2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yljpropylcarbamate (prepared as described in Parts A-D of Example 92, 11.5 mmol) in DMF (60 mL). The reaction was allowed to stir overnight at room temperature. The resulting orange suspension was diluted with water (40 mL) and the solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water (2 x 30 mL), and dried in a vacuum oven at 70 °C to afford 4.86 g of tert-butyl 3-(2-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H-isoindol-2- yl)oxy]methyl}-lH-imidazo[4,5-cj[l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl)propylcarbamate as a white solid. The material was used without further purification in the next step.
Part B mCPBA (2.33 g, 13.5 mmol) was added to a suspension of tert-butyl 3-(2-{[(l,3- dioxo- 1 ,3 -dihydro-2H-isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl} - lH-imidazo[4,5-cj [ 1 ,5]naphthyridin- 1 - yl)propylcarbamate (4.86 g, 9.67 mmol) in chloroform (50 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir for 4 hours, then concentrated ammonium hydroxide (27 mL) and p- toluenesulfonyl chloride (2.03 g, 10.6 mmol) were added. The reaction mixture was allowed to stir overnight at room temperature, then was filtered. The filtrate was diluted with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (50 mL) and exfracted with chloroform (2 x 40 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concenfrated to afford a brown solid that was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 0-30% CMA in chloroform) to afford 1.00 g of tert-butyl 3-{4-amino-2-[(aminooxy)methyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5- cJ[l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl}propylcarbamate as a yellow solid that contained some minor impurities.
Part C A modification on the general method described in Part J of Example 92 was used to convert tert-butyl 3-{4-amino-2-[(aminooxy)methyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl}propylcarbamate (1.00 g, 2.58 mmol) into 1.11 g of crude tert- butyl 3-[4-amino-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)aminojoxy} methyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]-l,5- naphthyridin-l-yl]propylcarbamate. Some of the product (0.709 g) was purified by chromatography on a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 0-25 %
CMA in chloroform) to afford 0.271 g of tert-butyl 3-[4-amino-2-({[(l- methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-l- yljpropylcarbamate as off-white needles, mp 148-150 °C. MS (APCI) m/z 428 (M + H)+; Anal, calcd for C21H29N7O3: C, 59.00; H, 6.84; N, 22.93. Found: C, 58.69; H, 6.86; N,
22.80.
Example 95 Acetone O- { [4-amino- 1 -(2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c] - 1 ,5 -naphthyridin-2- yljmethyl} oxime
Figure imgf000185_0001
Part A
Isobutylamine (15.6 mL, 157 mmol) was added dropwise to a 5 °C solution of 4- chloro-3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridine (15.0 g, 71.6 mmol) in dichloromethane (300 mL). The reaction was allowed to stir at room temperature for 4 hours, then was concentrated under reduced pressure to afford a residue that was treated with water (300 mL). The mixture was stined for 30 minutes, then a solid was isolated by filtration, rinsed with water (100 mL), and dried in a vacuum oven at 50 °C overnight to afford 17.25 g of N-(2- methylpropyl)-3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine as a yellow solid.
Part B The general method described in Part B of Example 92 was used to convert N-(2- methylpropyl)-3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine (17.25 g, 70.0 mmol) into N4-^- methylpropyl)[l,5]naphthyridine-3,4-diamine, which was isolated as a thick, yellow oil and used directly in the next step without purification.
Part C
The general method described in Part C of Example 92 was used to convert N4-^- methylpropyl)[l,5]naphthyridine-3,4-diamine (from Part B) into 2-chloro-N-{4-[(2- methylpropyl)aminoj[l,5]naphthyridin-3-yl}acetamide hydrochloride, which was isolated as a pale yellow solid that was used directly in the next step without purification. Part D
To a solution of 2-chloro-N-{4-[(2-methylpropyl)amino][l,5]naphthyridin-3- yl}acetamide hydrochloride (from Part C, approximately 70 mmol) in 3:1 ethanol/water (280 mL) was added 6 M aqueous potassium carbonate (17.5 mL). The reaction mixture was stined at room temperature over the weekend. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure and the residue was partitioned between dichloromethane (200 mL) and brine (100 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 50 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford 19.5 g of 2-(chloromethyl)-l -(2-methylpropyl)- 1H- imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine, which contained a small amount of dichloromethane and was used without further purification in the next step.
Part E mCPBA (70% pure, 9.85 g, 40.0 mmol) was added to a solution of 2- (chloromethyl)-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5jnaphthyridine (5.49 g, 20.0 mmol) in chloroform (80 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir for 1.5 hours, then was diluted with dichloromethane (150 mL) and washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (2 x 75 mL). The aqueous layers were combined and back-extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 30 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated to afford a yellow semi-solid that was used immediately without purification in the next step.
Part F
The material from Part E was dissolved in methanol (70 mL) and the solution was cooled to 0 °C. Concentrated ammonium hydroxide (6.7 mL) was added, followed by dropwise addition of benzenesulfonyl chloride (5.25 mL, 42.0 mmol). The reaction mixture was stined at 0 °C for 1 hour. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure and the residue was partitioned between dichloromethane (150 mL) and saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (75 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (50 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concenfrated. The crude product was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 0-25 % CMA in chloroform) to afford 4.14 g of approximately 85% pure 2-(chloromethyl)-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine, which was used in the next step without further purification.
Part G
The general method described in Part H of Example 92 was used to convert the material from Part F (85% pure, 4.14 g, 14.3 mmol) into 2.81 g of 2-[(4-amino-l-(2- methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-2-yl)methoxy]-lH-isoindole-l,3(2H)- dione.
Part Η
Anhydrous hydrazine (0.640 mL, 20.2 mmol) was added to a suspension of 2-[(4- amino-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-2-yl)methoxyj-lH- isoindole-l,3(2H)-dione (2.81 g, 6.75 mmol) in ethanol (40 mL). Gradually, a solution formed from which a solid began to precipitate. The reaction mixture was stined overnight at room temperature, then was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was triturated with 1 M aqueous hydrochloric acid (50 mL). The mixture was sonicated and the solid was isolated by filtration. The filtrate was adjusted to pΗ 8 with solid sodium carbonate and extracted with dichloromethane (3 x 25 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated to afford a yellow solid. The solid was triturated with methanol to afford 0.863 g of 2- [(aminooxy)methyl]-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-cj[l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine as a white solid.
Part i
The general method described in Part J of Example 92 was used to convert 2- [(aminooxy)methyl]-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine (0.555 g, 1.94 mmol) into acetone O-{[4-amino-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- cj[l,5]naphthyridin-2-yl]methyl} oxime. The crude product was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 0-30%
CMA in chloroform) followed by crystallization from methanol to afford 0.262 g of acetone O- {[4-amino-l -(2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c] [ 1 ,5]naphthyridin-2- yljmethyl} oxime as yellow crystals that were dried in a vacuum oven overnight at 85 °C, mp 173-175 °C. MS (ESI) m/z 327 (M + H)+; Anal, calcd for Cι7H22N6O: C, 62.56; H, 6.79; N, 25.75. Found: C, 62.49; H, 7.08; N,
26.01.
Example 96 Acetone O- { [4-amino-7-bromo- 1 -(2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo [4,5-c] - 1 ,5-naphthyridin- 2-yl]methyl} oxime
Figure imgf000188_0001
Part A
Isobutylamine (16.2 mL, 163 mmol) was added dropwise to a 0 °C solution of 7- bromo-4-chloro-3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridine (approximately 74.1 mmol) in dichloromethane (350 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir and warm to room temperature for 3 hours, then was diluted with dichloromethane (50 mL) and washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (300 mL). The aqueous layer was back-extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 75 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concenfrated to afford 23.06 g of 7-bromo-N-(2-methylpropyl)-3- nitro[ 1 ,5]naphthyridin-4-amine as a yellow solid.
Part B
The general method described in Part B of Example 92 was used to convert 7- bromo-N-(2-methylpropyl)-3-nifro[l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine (23.06 g, 70.9 mmol) into 7- bromo-N4-(2-methylpropyl)[l,5]naphthyridine-3,4-diamine. The mixture was hydrogenated at 40 psi (2.8 x 105 Pa) for 2.5 hours, then worked up as described in Part B of Example 92. Part C
The general method described in Part C of Example 92 was used to convert the material from Part B into N-{7-bromo-4-[(2-methylpropyl)amino][l,5]naphthyridin-3-yl}- 2-chloroacetamide hydrochloride, which was all used in the next step.
Part D
The material from Part C (approximately 70.9 mmol) was suspended in 3:1 ethanol/water (280 mL) and 6 M aqueous potassium carbonate (17.7 mL, 106 mmol) was added. After 30 minutes, the mixture had solidified, additional ethanol was added, and stirring was resumed. The reaction mixture was stined overnight at room temperature.
Additional 6 M aqueous potassium carbonate (18 mL) was added and stirring was continued for another 2 days. The reaction mixture was concenfrated under reduced pressure, the residue was partitioned between dichloromethane (200 mL) and water (100 mL), and the mixture was adjusted to pH 8 with 2 M aqueous hydrochloric acid. The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 35 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated to yield 22.8 g of 7- bromo-2-(chloromethyl)-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridine as a tan solid.
Part E mCPBA (70%) pure, 11.2 g, 45.2 mmol) was added to a solution of 7-bromo-2- (chloromethyl)-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5jnaphthyridine (8.00 g, 22.6 mmol) in chloroform (100 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir for 3 hours, then was diluted with dichloromethane (50 mL) and washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (250 mL). The aqueous layers were combined and back-extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 30 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated to afford an oily solid that was used immediately without purification in the next step. Part F
The material from Part E was dissolved in methanol (100 mL) and the solution was cooled to 0 °C. Concentrated ammonium hydroxide (7.5 mL) was added, followed by dropwise addition of benzenesulfonyl chloride (6.10 mL, 47.5 mmol). The reaction mixture was stined at 0 °C for 1 hour. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure and the solid was triturated with dichloromethane. A tan solid (4.92 g) was isolated by filtration. The filtrate was concentrated and the resulting solid was triturated with acetonitrile. A tan solid (3.62 g) was isolated by filtration. The two batches of tan solid were combined and used without further purification in the next step.
Part G
The material from Part F was dissolved in DMF and N-hydroxyphthalimide (2.12 g, 13.0 mmol) and triethylamine (2.1 mL, 15.3 mmol) were added. The red solution was stined at room temperature overnight, then the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was triturated with methanol and a tan solid was isolated by filtration to afford 4.23 g of 2-{[4-amino-7-bromo-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-2-yl]methoxy}-lH-isoindole-l,3(2H)-dione, which was used without further purification in the next step.
Part H
Anhydrous hydrazine (0.80 mL, 25.6 mmol) was added to a suspension of 2-{[4- amino-7-bromo-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-2-yl]methoxy}- lH-isoindole-l,3(2H)-dione (4.23 g, 8.54 mmol) in ethanol (45 mL). The reaction mixture was stined overnight at room temperature, then was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was triturated with 1 M aqueous hydrochloric acid (50 mL). A tan solid was isolated by filtration and was carried on to the next step.
Part i
Acetone (10 mL) was added to a suspension of the material from Part H in methanol (80 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir overnight at room temperature. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure and the residue was triturated with dichloromethane. A solid was isolated by filtration and was purified by chromatography on a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution 0-30% CMA in chloroform) to afford a thick oil that was crystallized from acetonitrile. The crystals isolated by filtration, then were partitioned between chloroform and saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate. The organic layer was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated. The crystalline solid was triturated with acetontrile, isolated by filtration, and dried under vacuum at 120 °C to afford 1.27 g of acetone O-{[4-amino-7-bromo-l-(2- methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo [4,5-c] [ 1 ,5 jnaphthyridin-2-yl]methyl} oxime as off-white needles, mp 176.5-177.5 °C. MS (ESI) m/z 406 (M + H)+;
Anal, calcd for Cι7H2ιBrN6O: C, 50.38; H, 5.22; N, 20.74. Found: C, 50.29; H, 5.24; N, 20.95.
Example 97 Acetone O- { [4-amino- 1 -(2-methylpropyl)-7-phenyl- lJT-imidazo[4,5-c] - 1 ,5-naphthyridin-
2-yl]methyl } oxime
Figure imgf000191_0001
A flask containing mixture of acetone O-{[4-amino-7-bromo-l-(2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-2-ylJmethyl}oxime (prepared as described in Example 96, 1.16 g, 2.86 mmol), phenylboronic acid (0.42 g, 3.43 mmol), triphenylphosphine (7 mg, 0.026 mmol), 2 M aqueous sodium carbonate (4.3 mL, 8.58 mmol), and 5:1 propanol/water (18 mL) was evacuated under reduced pressure and backfilled with nitrogen gas. Palladium(Lf) acetate (2 mg, 0.009 mmol) was added, and the flask was again evacuated and back-filled with nitrogen gas. The reaction mixture was heated at 100 °C for 18 hours. The reaction mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature and was diluted with dichloromethane (40 mL) and water (30 mL). The aqueous layer was exfracted with dichloromethane (2 x 15 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated to afford a tan solid. The solid was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 0-30% CMA in chloroform) to afford a thick oil that was crystallized from acetonitrile. The crystals were isolated by filtration and dried at 80 °C in a vacuum oven to yield 0.501 g of acetone O- {[4-amino- 1 -(2-methylpropyl)-7-phenyl- \H- imidazo[4,5-cj[l,5]naphthyridin-2-yl]methyl} oxime as a white powder, mp 196-197 °C. MS (ESI) m/z 403 (M + H)+;
Anal, calcd for C23H26N6O: C, 68.63; H, 6.51; N, 20.88. Found: C, 68.56; H, 6.62; N, 21.04.
Example 98
Cyclopentanone O- { [4-amino- 1 -(2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl)- lJT-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-2-yl]methyl}oxime
Figure imgf000192_0001
Part A l-Amino-2-methyl-propan-2-ol (42.1 g, 0.472 mol) was added slowly to a solution of 4-chloro-3-nitro[l,5]naphthyridine (99.0 g, 0.472 mol) and triethylamine (132 mL, 0.945 mol) in chloroform (1.98 L) at room temperature. The reaction mixture was stined for 45 minutes. The reaction mixture, which contained a precipitate, was divided in half. Each half was washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (750 mL). The precipitate was isolated from the aqueous phases by filtration and dried overnight under vacuum. The organic phases were concenfrated under reduced pressure. The residue was triturated with hot 2-propanol and then filtered to yield short yellow needles. The crystals were combined with the solid that was isolated above, and all the material was carried on without further manipulation to the next step. Part B
The material from Part A was dissolved in 2-propanol (490 mL) and acetonitrile 1.63 L). To the solution was added 5% platinum on carbon (6.5 g). The mixture was hydrogenated overnight on a Pan apparatus, then was filtered through CELITE filter agent. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure and the residue was used directly in the next step.
Part C
Chloroacetyl chloride (32.2 mL, 0.404 mol) was added dropwise to a solution of the material from Part B in chloroform (2.8 L). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir at room temperature. Over the next 3 hours additional chloroacetyl chloride (9.9 mL, 0.125 mol) was added and a precipitate formed. The precipitate was isolated by filtration and washed with chloroform. The solid was triturated with acetone, isolated by filtration, and dried. The solid was divided into 2 portions. To each portion was added ethanol (3.7 L) and triethylamine (65 mL). The resulting solutions were stined at room temperature for one week, then were set aside for a week. The solutions were concenfrated under reduced pressure to afford solids that were triturated with acetonitrile, isolated by filtration, dried under vacuum, and combined to afford 91.1 g of l-[2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c] [ 1 ,5]naphthyridin- 1 -yl] -2-methylpropan-2-ol.
Part D
Triethylamine (4.00 mL, 28.9 mmol) and N-hydroxyphthalimide (2.36 g, 14.4 mmol) were added to a solution of l-[2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl]-2-methylρroρan-2-ol (4.00 g, 13.8 mmol) in DMF (80 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir at room temperature for 20 minutes, during which time a precipitate formed. The precipitate was isolated by filtration and used without further purification in the next step.
Part E Anhydrous hydrazine (1.74 mL, 55.0 mmol) was added to a stined suspension of the material from Part D in chloroform (115 mL) at room temperature. After 15 minutes, the reaction mixture was filtered. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure and used without purification in the next step.
Part F Cyclopentanone (0.62 mL, 7.1 mmol) was added to a stined solution of the material from Part E in methanol (40 mL). After 20 minutes, the volatiles were removed under reduced pressure and the residue (1.8 g) was used in the next step.
Part G The residue from Part F was dissolved in chloroform (36 mL). mCPBA (a total of
9.6 g, 28.0 mmol) was added in portions to the stined solution over the next two hours. Concentrated ammonium hydroxide (18 mL) was added, followed by chloroform (30 mL), />-toluenesulfonyl chloride (1.94 g, 10.2 mmol), and chloroform (100 mL). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir overnight, then was filtered. To the stined filtrate was added chloroform (400 mL), concentrated ammonium hydroxide (10 mL), and^»-toluenesulfonyl chloride (1.94 g). After 1 hour, the reaction mixture was transfened to a separatory funnel and the aqueous phase was removed. Anhydrous ammonia was bubbled through the organic phase for 30 minutes. Additional /?-toluenesulfonyl chloride (1.94 g) were added. Anhydrous ammonia was bubbled through the organic phase for an additional 2 hours. More j>-toluenesulfonyl chloride (1.94 g) and concentrated ammonium hydroxide (40 mL) were added, and the mixture was allowed to stir over the weekend. The mixture was transfened to a separatory funnel. The organic phase was isolated and concenfrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, elution with 2.5% methanol in chloroform) followed by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, 0-20%ι CMA in chloform). The product was triturated with diethyl ether, isolated by filtration, and dried in a vacuum oven to yield 10 mg of cyclopentanone O- { [4-amino- 1 -(2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo [4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-2-yl]methyl} oxime as a white solid, mp 195-197 °C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.48 (d, J= 4.4 Hz, IH), 7.91 (d, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 7.44 (dd, J = 8.7 Hz, IH), 6.90 (s, 2H), 5.46 (br s, 2H), 5.01 (s, IH), 3.31 (s, 2H), 2.32 (t, J = 6.2 Hz, 2H), 2.23 (t, J= 6.2 Hz, 2H), 1.64 (m, 4H), 1.11 (br s, 6H); MS (APCT) m/z 369 (M + H)+;
Anal, calcd for Cι9H24N6O2: C, 61.94; H, 6.57; N, 22.81. Found: C, 61.65; H, 6.40; N,
22.75.
Example 99
Acetone O-{[4-amino-l-(2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-
2-yl]methyl} oxime
Figure imgf000195_0001
Part A mCPBA (23.7 g, 68.8 mmol) was added to a suspension of the crude material from
Part D of Example 98 (14.36 g, approximately 34.4 mmol) in chloroform (360 mL). The solution was stined for 1 hour, then was transfened to a separatory funnel and washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (150 mL). The organic phase was isolated and concenfrated ammonium hydroxide (80 mL) followed by »-toluenesulfonyl chloride (6.88 g, 1.05 equivalents) was added. After 30 minutes, additional »-toluenesulfonyl chloride
(13.8 g) was added and the mixture was allowed to stir overnight. The reaction mixture was diluted with chloroform (125 mL) and transfened to a separatory funnel. The organic layer was washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (250 mL), dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concenfrated under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, eluted with 4.25% methanol in chloroform) to afford 1.31 g of 1 - {4-amino-2-[(aminooxy)methyl]- lH-imidazo [4,5-c] [ 1 ,5]naphthyridin- 1 -yl} -2- methylpropan-2-ol as a yellow solid.
Part B Methanol (21 mL) and acetone (2.6 mL) were added to l-{4-amino-2-
[(aminooxy)methyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5-c][l,5]naphthyridin-l-yl}-2-methylpropan-2-ol (1.31 g, 4.3 mmol). The reaction was stined for 15 minutes then concenfrated under reduced pressure. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, eluted with 0.7% methanol in chloroform) followed by recrystallization from acetonitrile/water to yield 0.56 g of acetone O-{[4-amino-l-(2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]- l,5-naphthyridin-2-yl]methyl} oxime as a white solid, mp 198-200 °C.
1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.49 (d, J= 4.4 Hz, IH), 7.91 (d, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 7.44
(dd, J= 8.7 Hz, IH), 6.91 (s, 2H), 5.46 (br s, 2H), 5.02 (s, IH), 3.32 (s, 2H), 1.78 (d, J-
8.7 Hz, 6H), 1.12 (br s, 6H);
MS (APCI) m/z 343 (M + H)+;
Anal, calcd for Cι7H22N6O2: C, 59.63; H, 6.48; N, 24.54. Found: C, 59.42; H, 6.69; N,
24.62.
Example 100 Acetone O-{[4-amino-7-bromo-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2- yljmethyl} oxime
Figure imgf000196_0001
Part A
A mixture of triethyl orthoformate (154 g, 1.04 mol) and Meldrum's acid (142 g,
0.983 mol) was heated to 55°C for 4 hours. After cooling to 50 °C, a solution of 3- bromoaniline (162.6 g, 0.945 mol) in ethanol (300 mL) was added such that the temperature of the reaction was maintained between 50-55 °C. After half of the 3- bromoaniline had been added, stirring became difficult due to the formation of solids, so more ethanol (1 L) was added to facilitate stirring. Upon complete addition, the reaction was cooled to room temperature, and the solids were collected by filtration. The filter cake was washed with ice cold ethanol until the washings were nearly colorless, and the product was dried at 65 °C under vacuum to afford 287 g of 5-[(3-bromophenylimino)methyl]-2,2- dimethyl-l,3-dioxane-4,6-dione as an off-white solid.
1H NMR (300 MHz, CDC13) δ 11.19 (brd, J= 12.8 Hz, IH), 8.60 (d, J= 14.0 Hz, IH), 7.44-7.38 (m, 2H), 7.30 (t, J= 8.0 Hz, IH), 7.18 (ddd, J= 8.0, 2.2, 0.9 Hz, IH), 1.75 (s, 6H). Part B
7-Bromoquinolin-4-ol was prepared in accordance with the literature procedure (D.
Dibyendu et al., J. Med. Chem., 41, 4918-4926 (1998)) or by thermolysis of 5-[(3- bromophenylimino)methyl]-2,2-dimethyl-l,3-dioxane-4,6-dione in DOWTHERM A heat transfer fluid and had the following spectral properties:
1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 11.70 (brs, IH), 8.00 (d, J= 8.7 Hz, IH), 7.92 (d, J=
7.5 Hz, IH), 7.74 (d, J= 1.9 Hz, IH), 7.44 (dd, J= 8.7, 1.9 Hz, IH), 6.05 (d, J= 7.5 Hz,
IH).
Part C
A stined suspension of 7-bromoquinolin-4-ol (162 g, 0.723 mol) in propionic acid
(1500 mL) was brought to 110 °C. Nitric acid (85 g of 70%) was added dropwise over 1 hour such that the temperature was maintained between 110-115 °C. After half of the nitric acid had been added, stirring became difficult due to the formation of solids and an additional 200 mL of propionic acid was added. Upon complete addition, the reaction was stined for 1 hour at 110°C, cooled to room temperature, and the solid was collected by filfration. The filter cake was washed with ice cold ethanol until the washings were nearly colorless (800 mL), and the product was dried at 60 °C under vacuum to afford 152 g of 7- bromo-3-mtro-quinolin-4-ol as a pale yellow solid.
1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 13.0 (brs, IH), 9.22 (s, IH), 8.15 (d, J= 8.4 Hz, IH), 7.90 (d, J= 1.6 Hz, IH), 7.66 (dd, J= 8.7, 1.9 Hz, IH).
Part D 7-Bromo-3-nifroquinolin-4-ol (42 g, 156 mmol) was suspended in POCl3 (130 mL) and brought to 102 °C under an atmosphere of N2. After 45 min, all of the solids had dissolved, so the reaction was cooled to room temperature. The resulting solids were collected by filtration, washed with H2O, and then partitioned with CH2C12 (3 L) and 2M
Na2CO3 (500 mL). The organic layer was separated, washed with H2O (lx), dried over Na2SO4, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford 33.7 g of 7-bromo-4- chloro-3-nitroquinoline as a beige solid.
1H NMR (300 MHz, CDC13) δ 9.26 (s, IH), 8.41 (d, J= 1.8 Hz, IH), 8.30 (d, J= 9.0 Hz,
IH), 7.90 (dd, J= 8.9, 2.1 Hz, IH). Part E
To a suspension of 7-bromo-4-chloro-3-nitroquinoline (25.0 g, 87.0 mmol) in DMF (70 mL) was added triethylamine (18.2 mL, 130 mmol). A solution of iso- butylamine (9.50 mL, 95.7 mmol) in DMF (20 mL) was added dropwise. The viscous reaction mixture was stined overnight at ambient temperature. Water (200 mL) was added and the mixture was stined for 1 hour. A solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water, and dried in a vacuum oven overnight to yield 26.1 g of 7-bromo-N-(2- methylpropyl)-3-nitroquinolin-4-amine as a yellow powder.
Part F
A mixture of 7-bromo-N-(2-methylpropyl)-3-nitroquinolin-4-amine (25.1 g, 77.4 mmol) and 5% platinum on carbon (2.5 g), dichloroethane (160 mL), and ethanol (80 mL) was hydrogenated on a Pan apparatus at 30 psi (2.1 x 105 Pa) for 2 hours. The mixture was filtered through CELITE filter agent and the filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield 23.1 g of a brown oil.
Part G
To a stined solution of the material from Part F (23.1 g) and triethylamine (16.4 mL, 118 mmol) in dichloromethane (300 mL) was added dropwise chloroacetyl chloride (6.9 mL, 86.3 mmol). The reaction mixture was allowed to stir at room temperature for 7 days, then was concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting brown foam was partitioned between ethyl acetate (400 mL) and 1 : 1 saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate/water (400 mL). The water layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 200 mL). The organic layers were combined and concentrated under reduced pressure.
The crude product was divided into three portions, which were purified by chromatography on a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with ethyl acetate in hexanes). The purified material was combined to yield 18.32 g of 7-bromo-2- (chloromethyl)-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline as a yellow solid. Part H
To a solution of 7-bromo-2-(chloromethyl)-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- cjquinoline (13.9 g, 39.4 mmol) in chloroform (300 mL) at room temperature was added mCPBA (11% pure, 17.7 g, 78.8 mmol) over ten minutes. The reaction mixture was stined at room temperature for 3 hours, then concentrated ammonium hydroxide (150 mL) was added, followed by /?-toluenesulfonyl chloride (9.00 g, 47.3 mmol, added in portions over 10 minutes). The mixture was stined at room temperature for 1 hour, then was transfened to a separatory funnel. The layers were separated and the aqueous layer was exfracted with dichloromethane (2 x 100 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered through CELITE filter agent, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude product was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with ethyl acetate in hexanes) to yield 7.69 g of 7-bromo-2-(chloromethyl)-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as a yellow foam.
Part i
A solution of 7-bromo-2-(chloromethyl)-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-4-amine (7.65 g, 20.8 mmol) in DMF (20 mL) was added dropwise via addition funnel to a solution of N-hydroxyphthalimide (4.07 g, 25.0 mmol) and triethylamine (4.3 mL, 31.2 mmol) in DMF (20 mL). The addition funnel was rinsed with DMF (20 mL) and the rinse was added to the reaction solution, which was stined at room temperature. After 30 minutes, a precipitate formed. The viscous mixture was stined at room temperature overnight, then diethyl ether (150 mL) was added. The solid was isolated by filtration, washed with diethyl ether, and dried under vacuum to provide 7.44 g of 2-{[4-amino-7- bromo-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methoxy}-lH-isoindole- l,3(2H)-dione, which contained some triethylamine hydrochloride. The filtrate was concentrated to yield 8.5 g of a brown oil, which was found to contain product and was combined with the material from above and used in the next step. Part J
Anhydrous hydrazine (20 mL) was added to a stined suspension of the material from Part I (approximately 20.8 mmol) in ethanol (150 mL) at room temperature. The mixture became homogeneous after 2 minutes. After 30 minutes, a precipitate had formed. The mixture was stined for another 1.5 hours, then was filtered through CELITE filter agent. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to afford crude 2- [(aminooxy)methyl]-7-bromo- 1 -(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as a brown solid, which was used in the next step without purification.
Part K
The material from Part J was dissolved in methanol (150 mL) and acetone (50 mL). The solution was stined at room temperature for 3 hours, then was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield a brown solid. Dichloromethane (100 mL) was added and the mixture was stined for 30 minutes, then filtered. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure and purified by chromatography three times on a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel) to yield 4.11 g of acetone O-{[4-amino-7-bromo-l-(2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}oxime as a pale orange solid.
Example 101 Acetone O-{[4-amino-l-(2-methylpropyl)-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-
2-yl]methyl} oxime
Figure imgf000200_0001
Part A
A mixture of [4-amino-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2- yljmethanol (15.2 g, 56.2 mmol, U.S. Pat. No. 5,389,640 Example 9), platinum(LV) oxide
(7.6 g), and trifluoroacetic acid (75 mL) was hydrogenated at 50 psi (3.5 x 105 Pa) of hydrogen on a Pan apparatus for 2 days. The mixture was diluted with dichloromethane and filtered through CELITE filter agent, which was rinsed afterwards with dichloromethane and methanol. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure and the residue was partitioned between dichloromethane (250 mL) and 1:1 saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate/water (250 mL). Some solid formed that was isolated by filtration. The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 200 mL). The solid was dissolved in methanol and the resulting solution was combined with the organic layers, concentrated under reduced pressure, and purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, elution with 10% 1 M NH3 in methanol/dichloromethane) to afford 4.98 g of [4-amino-l-(2-methylpropyl)-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl]methanol as a grey solid.
Part B
Thionyl chloride (2.65 mL, 36.2 mmol) was added dropwise to a stined suspension of [4-amino-l-(2-methylpropyl)-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2- yljmethanol (4.97 g, 18.1 mmol) in 1,2-dichloroethane (200 mL). The suspension dissolved, then a precipitate formed after 5 minutes. The reaction mixture was stined at room temperature for 6 hours, then was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield crude 2-(chloromethyl)-l-(2-methylpropyl)-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4- amine hydrochloride, all of which was used in the next step.
Part C
A solution of N-hydroxyphthalimide (3.54 g, 21.7 mmol) and triethylamine (7.6 mL, 54.3 mmol) in DMF (25 mL) was added to a suspension of the material from Part B in DMF (25 mL) at room temperature. The reaction mixture was stined at room temperature overnight, then was concentrated under reduced pressure and used without purification in the next step.
Part D
Hydrazine hydrate (8.8 mL, 181 mmol) was added to a solution of the material from Part C in ethanol (180 mL). The reaction mixture was stined overnight and a solid formed that was removed by filfration. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure, then was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 5-10% 1 M NH in methanol/dichloromethane) to afford 4.52 g of2-[(aminooxy)methyl]-l-(2-methylpropyl)-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-4-amine as a pale yellow foam.
Part E
A solution of 2-[(aminooxy)methyl]-l-(2-methylpropyl)-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (700 mg, 2.42 mmol) in methanol (12 mL) and acetone
(12 mL) was stined at room temperature for 1 day, then was concenfrated under reduced pressure to yield an oil. The oil was diluted with acetonitrile and concentrated under reduced pressure to yield a solid that was recrystallized from acetonitrile. The crystals were isolated by filtration, washed with acetonitrile, and dried in a vacuum oven to yield
379 mg of acetone 0-{ [4-amino- l-(2-methylpropyl)-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-lH-imidazo [4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl} oxime as white crystals, mp 176-177 °C.
1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 5.87 (br s, 2H), 5.17 (s, 2H), 4.15 (d, J= 7.7 Hz, 2H), 2.91 (m, 2H), 2.67 (m, 2H), 2.03 (m, IH), 1.80 (s, 3H), 1.79 (s, 3H), 1.76 (m, 4H), 0.84 (d,
J= 6.6 Hz, 6H); MS (APCI) m/z 330.2 (M + H)+;
Anal, calcd for Cι8H27N5O: C, 65.62; H, 8.26; N, 21.26. Found: C, 65.53; H, 8.43; N,
21.45.
Examples 102-115
An aldehyde or ketone from the table below (1.1 equivalents) was added to a test tube containing a solution of 2-[(aminooxy)methyl]-l-(2-methylpropyl)-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (prepared as described in Parts A-D of Example 101, 29 mg, 0.1 mmol) in methanol (1 mL). The test tube was capped and placed on a shaker at ambient temperature overnight (approximately 18 hours). The solvent was removed by vacuum centrifugation. The compounds were purified by preparative high performance liquid chromatography (prep ΗPLC) using a Waters FractionLynx automated purification system. The prep ΗPLC fractions were analyzed using a Waters LC/TOF-MS, and the appropriate fractions were centrifuge evaporated to provide the trifluoroacetate salt of the desired compound. Reversed phase preparative liquid chromatography was performed with non-linear gradient elution from 5-95% B where A is 0.05% trifluoroacetic acid/water and B is 0.05 % trifluoroacetic acid/acetonitrile. Fractions were collected by mass- selective triggering. The table below shows the ketone or aldehyde used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
Examples 102-115
Figure imgf000203_0001
Figure imgf000204_0001
Examples 116-164 An aldehyde or ketone from the table below (1.2 equivalents) was added to a test tube containing a solution of l-{4-amino-2-[(aminooxy)methylj-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-l-yl}-2-methylpropan-2-ol (prepared as described in Parts A-F of Example 84, 30 mg, 0.1 mmol) in methanol (1 mL). The test tube was capped and placed on a shaker at ambient temperature overnight (approximately 18 hours). The solvent was removed by vacuum centrifugation. The compounds were purified using the method described in Examples 102-115. The table below shows the ketone or aldehyde used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt. Preparation of l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline-2-carbaldehyde for Example 116:
A solution of n-butyllithium in hexanes (2.5 M, 45.5 mL, 1.15 equivalents) was added dropwise to a stined, -78 °C solution of l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- cjquinoline (prepared as described in Example 32 of U.S. Patent 4,689,338, 25.64 g) in tefrahydrofuran (450 mL). The solution was stined for 10 minutes, then DMF (20.1 mL, 2.3 equivalents) was added. The reaction mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature over 1 hour. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure and the residue was portioned between ethyl acetate (400 mL) and brine (400 mL). The organic layer was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to yield a brown solid that was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, gradient elution with 0.5-1% methanol in dichloromethane) to provide 10.5 g of l-(2- methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c] quinoline-2-carbaldehyde.
Preparation of 4- [4-amino- 1 -(2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo [4, 5 -c] quinolin-2- yl]butan-2-one for Example 117:
Part A To a cooled solution of N4-(2-methylpropyl)quinoline-3,4-diamine (2.15 g, 10 mmol) in DMF (40 mL) was added 3-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)propanoic acid (2.40 g, 15 mmol), followed by 4-methylmorpholine (1.6 mL, 15 mmol) and l-(3- dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (EDCI) (2.9 g, 15 mmol). The resulting suspension was stined at room temperature and 4-dimethylaminopyridine (0.12 g, 1 mmol) was added. The dark yellow solution was stined at room temperature for 16 hours, then saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (100 mL) was added. The mixture was transfened to a separatory funnel and was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 100 mL). The organic layers were combined, washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (100 mL) and brine (100 mL), dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford an oil that was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, elution with 5% methanol in dichloromethane) to provide 2.55 g of N-{4-[(2- methylpropyl)amino]quinolin-3-yl}-3-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)propanamide.
Part B Water (3 mL) followed by solid sodium hydroxide (0.4 g, 10.7 mmol) were added to a stined solution of N-{4-[(2-methylpropyl)amino]quinolin-3-yl}-3-(2-methyl-l,3- dioxolan-2-yl)propanamide (2.55 g, 7.13 mmol) in ethanol (10 mL). The reaction mixture was heated at reflux for 30 minutes, then was allowed to cool to room temperature and was concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting aqueous slurry was diluted with water (50 mL) and was extracted with dichloromethane (2 x 50 mL). The organic layers were combined, washed with brine (50 mL), dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to yield 2.3 g of crude l-(2-methylpropyl)-2-[2-(2- methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)ethylj-lH-imidazo[4,5-cjquinoline as a clear oil.
Part C mCPBA (60% purity, 2.3 g, 7.95 mmol) was added in portions to a stined solution of l-(2-methylpropyl)-2-[2-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)ethylj-lH-imidazo[4,5- cjquinoline (2.7 g, 7.95 mmol) in chloroform (40 mL) at room temperature. The reaction mixture was stined for 20 minutes, then was partitioned between dichloromethane (100 mL) and saturated aqueous sodium carbonate (50 mL). The organic layer was washed with saturated aqueous sodium carbonate (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated without purification, concentrated under reduced pressure to yield an orange foam that was used in the next step without purification.
Part D
Concentrated ammonium hydroxide (13 mL) followed by ?-toluenesulfonyl chloride (1.50 g, 7.95 mmol) were added to a rapidly stined solution of the material from
Part C in dichloromethane (40 mL). The ?-toluenesulfonyl chloride was added in portions.
After the mixture was stined at room temperature for 10 minutes, the mixture was partitioned between chloroform (100 mL) and saturated aqueous sodium carbonate (50 mL). The organic layer was washed with brine (50 mL), dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude solid was crystallized from ethyl acetate. A tan solid was isolated by filtration, washed with acetonitrile, and dried at 65 °C under vacuum to provide 1.8 g of l-(2-methylpropyl)-2-[2-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan- 2-yl)ethyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine.
Part E
Concentrated hydrochloric acid (0.80 mL, 9.3 mmol) was added to a stined suspension of l-(2-methylpropyl)-2-[2-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)ethyl]-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (1.10 g, 3.10 mmol) in water (24 mL). A solution resulted and was stined at room temperature for 30 minutes. The solution was adjusted to pH 12 with 20% aqueous sodium hydroxide. A white solid precipitated and was isolated by filfration, washed with water, and recrystallized from ethyl acetate to yield 0.6 g of 4- [4-amino-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yljbutan-2-one as a monohydrate as a white powder, mp 172-174 °C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, ΩMSO-d6) δ 7.98 (d, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 7.61 (d, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 7.41 (t, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 7.26 (t, J= 8.1 Hz,
IH), 6.41 (bs, 2H), 4.34 (d, J= 7.5 Hz, 2H), 3.08 (bs, 4H), 2.23 (s, 3H), 2.23-2.15 (m, IH), 0.95 (d, J= 6.9 Hz, 6H); MS (APCL) m/z 311 (M + H)+;
Anal. Cacld for C18H22N4O«H2Oι : C, 65.83; H, 7.37: N, 17.06. Found: C, 66.03; H, 7.34; N, 17.10.
Preparation of 4-{4-amino-l-[5-(methylsulfonyl)pentylj-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl}butan-2-one for Example 118:
Part A N4-[5-(methylthio)pentyl]quinoline-3,4-diamine (prepared as described in U.S.
Patent 2003/0100764 Al Example 11 Parts A-D, 4.20 g, 15.3 mmol) was converted into 1.7 g of 2-[2-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)ethyl]-l-[5-(methylthio)pentyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5- cjquinoline using the method described in Part B of the preparation of 4-[4-amino-l-(2- hydroxy-2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yljbutan-2-one (for Example 119) below. Part B mCPBA (75%ι purity, 3.23 g, 14.0 mmol) was added in portions to a stined solution of 2-[2-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)ethylj-l-[5-(methylthio)pentyl]-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinoline (1.70 g, 4.25 mmol) in chloroform (21 mL) at room temperature. The reaction mixture was stined for 30 minutes, then concentrated ammonium hydroxide
(21 mL) was added followed by portionwise addition ofp-toluenesulfonyl chloride (0.97 g, 5.1 mmol). After the mixture was stined at room temperature for 10 minutes, the mixture was partitioned between chloroform (100 mL) and 1% aqueous sodium carbonate (50 mL). The organic layer was washed with 1%> aqueous sodium carbonate (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting crude solid was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, 5% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield 1.1 g of 2-[2-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)ethylj-l-[5- (methylthio)pentyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine.
Part C
The general procedure used in Part E of the preparation of 4-(4-amino-l-(2- methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl)butan-2-one (for Example 117) above was used to convert 2-[2-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)ethyl]-l-[5-(methylthio)pentyl]-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine into 4-{4-amino-l-[5-(methylthio)pentyl]-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl}butan-2-one. The crude solid isolated by filtration was stined in refluxing ethanol for 1 hour, then the suspension was allowed to cool to room temperature and was stined for 1 hour. The solid was isolated by filfration, washed with ehanol and dried to afford 4-{4-amino-l-[5-(mefhylthio)pentyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl}butan-2-one in 70% yield as a white powder, mp 179-181 °C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-rfβ) δ 8.02 (d, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 7.61 (d, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 7.42 (t, J= 8.1
Hz, IH), 7.26 (t, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 6.40 (bs, 2H), 4.52 (t, J= 7.5 Hz, 2H), 3.13-3.09 (m, 6H), 2.92 (s, 3H), 2.23 (s, 3H), 1.89-1.81 (m, 2H), 1.79-1.67 (m, 2H), 1.60-1.53 (m, 2H); MS (APCL) m/z 403 (M + H)+; Anal. Cacld for C20H26N4O3S: C, 59.68; H, 6.51: N, 13.92. Found: C, 59.59; H, 6.54; N, 13.82. Preparation of 4-[4-amino-l-(2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl]butan-2-one for Example 119:
Part A N-Hydroxysuccinamide (0.80 g, 6.9 mmol) followed by 4-methylmorpholine (0.70 g, 6.9 mmol) and l-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride (EDCI) (1.32 g, 6.9 mmol) were added to a 0 °C solution of 3 -(2-methyl-l, 3 -dioxolan-2- yl)propanoic acid (1.00 g, 6.24 mmol) in dichloromethane (12 mL). The solution was allowed to warm to room temperature and was stined overnight. The reaction mixture was diluted with dichloromethane (10 mL), transfened to a separatory fumiel, and washed with water (2 x 10 mL), saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (2 x 10 mL), and brine (10 mL). The organic layer was dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concenfrated under reduced pressure to provide 1.1 g of l-{[3-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)propanoyl]oxy}pynolidine- 2,5-dione as a white solid.
Part B
A suspension of l-[(3-aminoquinolin-4-yl)amino]-2-methylpropan-2-ol (1.00 g, 4.33 mmol), l-{[3-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)propanoyljoxy}pynolidine-2,5-dione (1.3 g, 5.2 mmol), and pyridine hydrochloride (0.1 g) in toluene (50 mL) was heated at reflux with a Dean Stark trap for 6 hours, then was cooled to room temperature and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford an oil. The oil was dissolved in dichloromethane (100 mL), washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (2 x 50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concenfrated under reduced pressure. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography (silica gel, 5% methanol in dichloromethane) to afford 0.6 g of 2-methyl-l-{2-[2-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)ethylj- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl}propan-2-ol.
Part C mCPBA (75%) purity, 0.62 g, 2.7 mmol) was added in portions to a stined solution of2-methyl-l-{2-[2-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)ethyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l- yl}propan-2-ol (0.80 g, 2.25 mmol) in chloroform (12 mL) at room temperature. The reaction mixture was stined for 20 minutes, then was partitioned between chloroform- (100 mL) and 1% aqueous sodium carbonate (50 mL). The organic layer was washed with 1% aqueous sodium carbonate (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated without purification, concenfrated under reduced pressure to yield an orange solid that was used in the next step without purification.
Part D
Concentrated ammonium hydroxide (4 mL) followed by -toluenesulfonyl chloride (0.47 g, 2.48 mmol) were added to a rapidly stined solution of the material from Part C in dichloromethane (12 mL). The ^-toluenesulfonyl chloride was added in portions. After the mixture was stined at room temperature for 10 minutes, the mixture was partitioned between chloroform (100 mL) and 1% aqueous sodium carbonate (50 mL). A white solid formed in the aqueous layer that was isolated by filtration, washed with water, and dried to yield 0.2 g of l-{4-amino-2-[2-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)ethyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-l-yl}-2-methylpropan-2-ol. The organic layer was washed with 1% aqueous sodium carbonate (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting crude solid was stined in water and sodium carbonate was added to adjust the pH to 10. The mixture was stined overnight and a solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water, and dried to provide 0.1 g of l-{4- amino-2-[2-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)ethyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl}-2- methylpropan-2-ol.
Part E
Concentrated hydrochloric acid (0.20 mL, 2.4 mmol) was added to a stined suspension of l-{4-amino-2-[2-(2-methyl-l,3-dioxolan-2-yl)ethyl]-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-l-yl}-2-methylpropan-2-ol (0.30 g, 0.81 mmol) in water (5 mL). A solution resulted and was stined at room temperature for 3 hours. The solution was adjusted to pH 13 with 20% aqueous sodium hydroxide. A gummy solid formed. Dichloromethane was added, but the solid did not dissolved. The mixture was poured into a separatory funnel, then the contents of the funnel were filtered. The white solid isolated by filtration was washed with water and dried to yield 0.17 g of 4-[4-amino-l-(2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl)- lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]butan-2-one as a white powder, mp 181-184 °C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, OMSO-d6) δ 8.26 (d, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 7.58 (d, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 7.37 (t, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 7.19 (t, J= 8.1 Hz, IH), 6.35 (bs, 2H), 4.79 (s, IH), 4.57 (bs, 2H), 3.21 (t, J= 6.9 Hz, 2H), 3.05 (t, J= 6.9 Hz, 2H), 2.20 (s, 3H), 1.18 (bs, 6H); MS (APCI) m/z 327 (M + H)+; Anal. Cacld for Ci8H22N4O2: C, 66.24; H, 6.79: N, 17.17. Found: C, 65.85; H, 6.71; N, 17.16.
Examples 116-164
Figure imgf000211_0001
Figure imgf000212_0001
Figure imgf000213_0001
Figure imgf000214_0001
Figure imgf000215_0001
Figure imgf000216_0001
Examples 165-172 An aldehyde or ketone from the table below (1.1 equivalents) was added to a test tube containing a solution of 2-[(aminooxy)methyl]-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c][l,5]naphthyridin-4-amine (prepared as described in Parts A-H of Example 95, 29 mg, 0.1 mmol) in methanol (1 mL). The test tube was capped and placed on a shaker at ambient temperature for 3 hours. The solvent was removed by vacuum centrifugation. The compounds were purified using the method described in Examples 102-115. The table below shows the ketone or aldehyde used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
Examples 165-172
Figure imgf000216_0002
Figure imgf000217_0001
Examples 173-192 3-Bromo-5-(tert-butyldimethylsilanyloxymethyl)pyridine was prepared according to the published procedure (Zhang, N. et al, J Med. Chem., 45, 2832-2840 (2002)). Under a nitrogen atmosphere, a solution of 3-bromo-5-(tert- butyldimethylsilanyloxymethyl)pyridine (28.70 g, 94.94 mmol) and triisopropyl borate (26.3 mL, 114 mmol) in dry THF was cooled to -70 °C. n-Butyllithium (45.6 mL, 114 mmol) was added dropwise over a period of 1.5 hours. The reaction was stined for an additional 30 minutes and then allowed to warm to -20 °C. Dilute aqueous ammonium chloride was added, and the mixture was allowed to warm to ambient temperature. The aqueous layer was separated and exfracted with diethyl ether. The combined organic fractions were concenfrated under reduced pressure, and methanol was added to the resulting oil. A solid formed, which was stined with water for two days, isolated by filfration, and dried under reduced pressure to provide 18.19 g of 5-(tert- butyldimethylsilanyloxymethyl)pyridine-3-boronic acid as a white solid.
The compounds in the table below were prepared according to the following method. A solution of 2-[(aminooxy)methyl]-7-bromo-l-(2-methylpropyl)-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (prepared as described in Parts A-J of Example 100, 80 mg, 0.20 mmol) in 7:3 volume:volume (v:v) chloroform:methanol (2 mL) was added to a test tube, and the solvent was removed by vacuum cenfrifugation. The boronic acid (0.22 mmol) indicated in the table below and ra-propanol (3.2 mL) were sequentially added, and the test tube was purged with nitrogen. The reaction mixture was sonicated until a solution formed. Palladium (H) acetate (0.292 mL of a 0.018 M solution in toluene, 0.0053 mmol), 2M aqueous sodium carbonate solution (1.2 mL), deionized water (225 μL), and a solution of 0.15 M triphenylphosphine in 72-propanol (106 μL, 0.0159 mmol) were sequentially added. The test tube was purged with nifrogen, capped, and then heated to 80 °C overnight in a sand bath. For Example 183, the solvent was removed by vacuum centrifiigation, and glacial acetic acid (1 mL), tetrahydrofuran (1 mL), and deionized water (1 mL) were added to the test tube. The reaction was heated overnight at 60 °C. The solvent was removed from the test tubes by vacuum centrifiigation.
The contents of each test tube were passed through a Waters Oasis Sample Extractions Cartridge MCX (6 cc) according to the following procedure. Hydrochloric acid (3 mL of 1 N) was added to adjust each example to pH 5-7, and the resulting solution was passed through the cartridge optionally using light nifrogen pressure. The cartridge was washed with methanol (5 mL) optionally using light nifrogen pressure and transfened to a clean test tube. A solution of 1% ammonia in methanol (2 x 5 mL) was then passed , through the cartridge optionally using light nitrogen pressure, and the basic solution was collected and concentrated.
The compounds were purified as described in Examples 102-115. The table below shows the boronic acid used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt. Examples 173-192
Figure imgf000219_0001
Figure imgf000220_0001
Example 193 tert-Butyl 2-[4-amino-7-(benzyloxy)-2-( {[(1 -methylethylidene)amino] oxy} methyl)- 1H- imidazo [4, 5 -c] quinolin- 1 -yl] ethylcarbamate
Figure imgf000221_0001
Part A
A mixture of triethyl orthoformate (92 mL, 0.55 mol) and 2,2-dimethyl-[l,3j- dioxane-4,6-dione (75.3 g, 0.522 mol) (Meldrum's acid) was heated at 55 °C for 90 minutes and then cooled to 45 °C. A solution of 3-benzyloxyaniline (100.2 g, 0.5029 mol) in methanol (200 mL) was slowly added to the reaction over a period 45 minutes while maintaining the reaction temperature below 50 °C. The reaction was then heated at 45 °C for one hour, allowed to cool to room temperature, and stined overnight. The reaction mixture was cooled to 1 °C, and the product was isolated by filtration and washed with cold ethanol (-400 mL) until the filtrate was colorless. 5-{[(3- Benzyloxy)phenylimino]methyl}-2,2-dimethyl-[l,3]-dioxane-4,6-dione (170.65 g) was isolated as a tan, powdery solid.
1H NMR (300MHz, OMSO-d6) : δ 11.21 (d, J= 14.2 Hz, IH), 8.61 (d, J= 14.2 Hz, IH), 7.49-7.30 (m, 7H), 7.12 (dd, J= 8.1, 1.96 Hz, IH), 6.91 (dd, J= 8.4, 2.1 Hz, IH), 5.16 (s, 2H), 1.68 (s, 6H).
Part B
A mixture of 5-{[(3-benzyloxy)phenylimino]methyl}-2,2-dimethyl-[l,3]-dioxane- 4,6-dione (170.65 g, 0.483 mol) and DOWTHERM A heat transfer fluid (800 mL) was heated to 100 °C and then slowly added to a flask containing DOWTHERM A heat transfer fluid (1.3 L, heated at 210 °C) over a period of 40 minutes. During the addition, the reaction temperature was not allowed to fall below 207 °C. Following the addition, the reaction was stined at 210 °C for one hour, and then allowed to cool to ambient temperature. A precipitate formed, which was isolated by filtration, washed with diethyl ether (1.7 L) and acetone (0.5 L), and dried in an oven to provide 76.5 g of 7- benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol as a tan powder.
1H NMR (300MHz, OMSO-d6) : δ 11.53 (s, IH), 7.99 (dd, J= 2.4, 7.4Hz, IH), 7.79 (d, J = 7.4Hz, IH), 7.50-7.32 (m, 5H), 7.00 (s, IH), 6.98 (dd, J= 2.5, 7.4Hz, IH), 5.93 (d, J=
7.5Hz, IH), 5.20 (s, 2H).
Part C
A mixture of 7-benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol (71.47 g, 0.2844 mol) and propionic acid (700 mL) was heated to 125 °C with vigorous stirring. Nitric acid (23.11 mL of 16 M) was slowly added over a period of 30 minutes while maintaining the reaction temperature between 121 °C and 125 °C. After the addition, the reaction was stined at 125 °C for 1 hour then allowed to cool to ambient temperature. The resulting solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water, and dried in an oven for 1.5 days to provide 69.13 g of 7- benzyloxy-3-nitroquinolin-4-ol as a grayish powder.
1H NMR (300MHz, DMSO- ) : δ 12.77 (s, IH), 9.12 (s, IH), 8.17 (dd, J= 3.3, 6.3Hz,
IH), 7.51-7.33 (m, 5H), 7.21-7.17 (m, 2H), 5.25 (s, 2H).
\
Part D DMF (100 mL) was cooled to 0 °C, and phosphorous oxychloride (27.5 mL, 0.295 mol) was added dropwise. The resulting solution was stined for 25 minutes and then added dropwise to a mixture of 7-benzyloxy-3-nifroquinolin-4-ol (72.87 g, 0.2459 mol) in DMF (400 mL). Following the addition, the reaction was heated at 100 °C for 5 minutes, cooled to ambient temperature, and poured into ice water with stirring. A tan precipitate formed, which was isolated by filtration and dissolved in dichloromethane. The resulting solution was dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to yield 72.9 g of 7-benzyloxy-4-chloro-3-nitroquinoline as a light brown solid. 1H NMR (300MHz, DMSO-rftf) : δ 9.34 (s, IH), 8.36 (d, J= 8.7Hz, IH), 7.71 (d, J= 2.4Hz, IH), 7.66 (dd, J= 2.4, 9.3Hz, IH), 7.56-7.51 (m, 2H), 7.46-7.34 (m, 3H), 5.40 (s, 2H). Part E tert-Butyl 2-aminoethylcarbamate (54.1 g, 338 mmol) was added to a stined solution of 7-benzyloxy-4-chloro-3-nitroquinoline (88.6 g, 282 mmol) and triethylamine (58.9 mL, 422 mmol) in DMF (800 mL) at room temperature. The reaction mixture was stined for 4 hours, then was poured onto stined hot water in a beaker to precipitate a yellow solid that was isolated by filtration and dried under vacuum at 65 °C to yield 123.7 g of tert-butyl 2- {[7-(benzyloxy)-3-nitroquinolin-4-yl]amino} ethylcarbamate.
Part F A mixture of tert-butyl 2-{[7-(benzyloxy)-3-nifroquinolin-4- yl]amino}ethylcarbamate (10.0 g, 22.8 mmol), 5%> platinum on carbon (1 g), and ethyl acetate (100 mL) was hydrogenated on a Pan apparatus at 30 psi (2.1 x 105 Pa) of hydrogen overnight. The reaction mixture was filtered through CELITE filter agent, which was rinsed afterwards with methanol. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure and used directly in the next step.
Part G
Chloroacetyl chloride (2.00 mL, 25.1 mmol) was added to a solution of the material from Part F and triethylamine (6.40 mL, 45.6 mmol) in dichloromethane (200 mL) at room temperature. The reaction mixture was stined at room temperature for 30 minutes, then was concenfrated under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in ethanol (200 mL) and the solution was stined at room temperature for 4 days. The solution was concentrated to yield a brown foam that was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, elution with 5% methanol/dichloromethane) to provide 4.87 g of tert-butyl 2-[7-(benzyloxy)-2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-l-yljethylcarbamate as a yellow foam.
Part H mCPBA (11% purity, 5.84 g, 26.1 mmol) was added to a stined solution oϊtert- butyl 2-[7-(benzyloxy)-2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-cjquinolin-l-yl]ethylcarbamate (4.87 g, 10.4 mmol) in chloroform (100 mL) at room temperature. After 30 minutes, the reaction mixture was transfened to a separatory funnel and washed with 1% aqueous sodium carbonate (100 mL). The organic layer was dried over magnesium sulfate and filtered. The filtrate was used in the next step.
Part i
Concentrated ammonium hydroxide (50 mL) was added to the solution from Part H at room temperature. The mixture was stined for 2 minutes, and then j9-toluenesulfonyl chloride (2.39 g, 12.5 mmol) was added. The reaction mixture was stined for 30 minutes then transfened to a separatory funnel. The layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (3 x 50 mL). The organic layers were combined, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated to yield a brown foam. The foam was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, gradient elution with 5-10% methanol dichloromethane) to yield 2.71 g of tert-butyl 2-[4-amino-7- (benzyloxy)-2-(chloromethyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-cjquinolin-l-yl]ethylcarbamate as a yellow foam.
Part J
A solution of tert-butyl 2-[4-amino-7-(benzyloxy)-2-(chloromethyl)-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl]ethylcarbamate (2.70 g, 5.60 mmol) in DMF (10 mL) was added to a stined solution of N-hydroxyphthalimide (1.10 g, 6.72 mmol) and triethylamine
(1.56 mL, 11.2 mmol) in DMF (10 mL) at room temperature. A solid formed after 10 minutes. After 1.5 hours, dichloromethane (50 mL) was added and the solid was isolated by filtration, washed with dichloromethane followed by diethyl ether, and dried under vacuum to yield 3.15 g of tert-butyl 2-(4-amino-7-(benzyloxy)-2-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro- 2H-isoindol-2-yl)oxy]methyl}-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)ethylcarbamate as an off- white solid.
Part K
Hydrazine hydrate (0.753 mL, 15.5 mmol) was added to a stined suspension of tert-butyl 2-(4-amino-7-(benzyloxy)-2-{[(l,3-dioxo-l,3-dihydro-2H-isoindol-2- yl)oxy]methyl}-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl)ethylcarbamate (3.15 g, 5.18 mmol) in ethanol (50 mL). The suspension was stined at room temperature for 3 hours, then was filtered. The filtrate was concenfrated under reduced pressure to yield 2.43 g of crude tert- butyl 2-[4-amino-2-[(aminooxy)methyl]-7-(benzyloxy)-lH-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l- yljethylcarbamate that was used without purification in the next step.
Part L
A solution of the material from Part K in acetone (25 mL) and methanol (25 mL) was stined at room temperature overnight, then was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield a yellow solid that was purified by chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica gel, elution with 10% methanol/dichloromethane) to afford 2.27 g of tert- butyl 2-[4-amino-7-(benzyloxy)-2-({[(l-methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-l-yl]ethylcarbamate as a foam.
1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.09 (d, J= 9.2 Hz, IH), 7.29-7.52 (m, 5H), 7.16 (m, IH), 7.14 (d, J= 2.6 Hz, IH), 6.94 (dd, J= 8.9, 2.6 Hz, IH), 6.58 (br s, 2H), 5.24 (s, 2H), 5.22 (s, 2H), 4.63 (m, 2H), 3.39 (m, 2H), 1.82 (s, 3H), 1.79 (s, 3H), 1.36 (s, 9H); MS
(APCT) m/z 519.2 (M + R)+.
Examples 194-217 To a stined solution of tert-butyl 2-[4-amino-7-(benzyloxy)-2-({[(l- methylethylidene)amino]oxy}methyl)-lH-imidazo[4,5-cjquinolin-l-yljethylcarbamate
(prepared as described in Example 193, 2.26 g, 4.36 mmol) in dichloromethane (40 mL) was added 4 M HCl in dioxane (10 mL), causing a precipitate to form immediately. Over several hours, methanol (80 mL) and additional 4 M HCl in dioxane (10 mL) were added. The mixture was concenfrated under reduced pressure, then was diluted with dichloromethane (50 mL) and trifluoroacetic acid (10 mL). The cloudy suspension was stined at room temperature for 3.5 hours, then was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield a paste. The paste was concenfrated from dichloromethane and diethyl ether to yield 3.02 g of acetone O-{[4-amino-l-(2-aminoethyl)-7-(benzyloxy)-lH-imidazo[4,5- c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}oxime tris(trifluoroacetate) as a yellow solid. A reagent from the table below (1.1 equivalents, 0.11 mmol) can be added to a test tube containing a solution of acetone 0-{ [4-amino- l-(2-aminoethyl)-7-(benzyloxy)-lH- imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-2-yl]methyl}oxime tris(trifluoroacetate) (76 mg, 0.10 mmol) and triethylamine (73 μL, 0.50 mmol) in chloroform (1 mL), and the reaction and purification can be carried out according to the procedure described in Examples 60-83. The table below shows a reagent that can be used for each example and the structure of the resulting compound.
Examples 194-217
Figure imgf000226_0001
Figure imgf000227_0001
Figure imgf000228_0002
Exemplary Compounds
Certain exemplary compounds, including some of those described above in the Examples, have the following Formulas (Hie, LVc, Va, and Via) and the following R", R2, and Ri substituents, wherein each line of the table is matched with Formula e, LVc, Va, or Via to represent a specific embodiment of the invention.
Figure imgf000228_0001
Va Via
Figure imgf000229_0001
Figure imgf000230_0001
CYTOKINE INDUCTION LN HUMAN CELLS Compounds of the invention have been found to induce cytokine biosynthesis when tested using the method described below.
An in vitro human blood cell system is used to assess cytokine induction. Activity is based on the measurement of interferon (α) and tumor necrosis factor (α) (IFN-α and TNF-α, respectively) secreted into culture media as described by Testerman et. al. in "Cytokine Induction by the Immunomodulators Imiquimod and S-27609", Journal of Leukocyte Biology, 58, 365-372 (September, 1995).
Blood Cell Preparation for Culture
Whole blood from healthy human donors is collected by venipuncture into EDTA vacutainer tubes. Peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMC) are separated from whole blood by density gradient centrifugation using HISTOP AQUE- 1077. Blood is diluted 1 : 1 with Dulbecco's Phosphate Buffered Saline (DPBS) or Hank's Balanced Salts Solution (HBSS). The PBMC layer is collected and washed twice with DPBS or HBSS and resuspended at 4 x 106 cells/mL in RPMI complete. The PBMC suspension is added to 48 well flat bottom sterile tissue culture plates (Costar, Cambridge, MA or Becton Dickinson Labware, Lincoln Park, NJ) containing an equal volume of RPMI complete media containing test compound.
Compound Preparation
The compounds are solubilized in dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO). The DMSO concentration should not exceed a final concentration of 1% for addition to the culture wells. The compounds are generally tested at concentrations ranging from 30-0.014 μM.
Incubation The solution of test compound is added at 60 μM to the first well containing RPMI complete and serial 3 fold dilutions are made in the wells. The PBMC suspension is then added to the wells in an equal volume, bringing the test compound concentrations to the desired range (30-0.014 μM). The final concentration of PBMC suspension is 2 x 106 cells/mL. The plates are covered with sterile plastic lids, mixed gently and then incubated for 18 to 24 hours at 37°C in a 5% carbon dioxide atmosphere.
Separation
Following incubation the plates are centrifuged for 10 minutes at 1000 rpm (approximately 200 x g) at 4°C. The cell-free culture supernatant is removed with a sterile polypropylene pipet and transfened to sterile polypropylene tubes. Samples are maintained at -30 to -70°C until analysis. The samples are analyzed for interferon (α) by ELISA and for tumor necrosis factor (α) by ELISA or IGEN Assay.
Interferon (α) and Tumor Necrosis Factor (α) Analysis by ELISA
Interferon (α) concentration is determined by ELISA using a Human Multi-Species kit from PBL Biomedical Laboratories, New Brunswick, NJ. Results are expressed in pg/mL.
Tumor necrosis factor (α) (TNF) concentration is determined using ELISA kits available from Biosource International, Camarillo, CA. Alternately, the TNF concentration can be determined by ORIGEN M-Series Immunoassay and read on an IGEN M-8 analyzer from IGEN International, Gaithersburg, MD. The immunoassay uses a human TNF capture and detection antibody pair from Biosource International, Camarillo, CA. Results are expressed in pg/mL.
Certain compounds of the invention may modulate cytokine biosynthesis by inhibiting production of tumor necrosis factor α (TNF-α) when tested using the method described below. TNF-α INHIBITION IN MOUSE CELLS The mouse macrophage cell line Raw 264.7 is used to assess the ability of compounds to inhibit tumor necrosis factor-α (TNF-α) production upon stimulation by lipopolysaccharide (LPS).
Single Concenfration Assay: Blood Cell Preparation for Culture
Raw cells (ATCC) are harvested by gentle scraping and then counted. The cell suspension is brought to 3 x 105 cells/mL in RPMI with 10 % fetal bovine serum (FBS). Cell suspension (100 μL) is added to 96-well flat bottom sterile tissues culture plates
(Becton Dickinson Labware, Lincoln Park, NJ). The final concentration of cells is 3 x 104 cells/well. The plates are incubated for 3 hours. Prior to the addition of test compound the medium is replaced with colorless RPMI medium with 3 % FBS.
Compound Preparation
The compounds are solubilized in dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO). The DMSO concentration should not exceed a final concenfration of 1% for addition to the culture wells. Compounds are tested at 5μM. LPS (Lipopolysaccaride from Salmonella typhimurium, Sigma-Aldrich) is diluted with colorless RPMI to the EC70 concentration as measured by a dose response assay.
Incubation
A solution of test compound (lμl) is added to each well. The plates are mixed on a microtiter plate shaker for 1 minute and then placed in an incubator. Twenty minutes later the solution of LPS (1 μL, EC70 concentration ~ 10 ng/ml) is added and the plates are mixed for 1 minute on a shaker. The plates are incubated for 18 to 24 hours at 37 °C in a 5 % carbon dioxide atmosphere.
TNF-α Analysis Following the incubation the supernatant is removed with a pipet. TNF-α concentration is determined by ELISA using a mouse TNF- α kit (from Biosource International, Camarillo, CA). Results are expressed in pg/mL. TNF-α expression upon LPS stimulation alone is considered a 100%) response.
Dose Response Assay: Blood Cell Preparation for Culture
Raw cells (ATCC) are harvested by gentle scraping and then counted. The cell suspension is brought to 4 x 105 cells/mL in RPMI with 10 % FBS. Cell suspension (250 μL) is added to 48-well flat bottom sterile tissues culture plates (Costar, Cambridge, MA). The final concentration of cells is 1 x 105 cells/well. The plates are incubated for 3 hours. Prior to the addition of test compound the medium is replaced with colorless RPMI medium with 3 % FBS.
Compound Preparation
The compounds are solubilized in dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO). The DMSO concentration should not exceed a final concenfration of 1% for addition to the culture wells. Compounds are tested at 0.03, 0.1, 0.3, 1, 3, 5 and 10 μM. LPS (Lipopolysaccaride from Salmonella typhimurium, Sigma-Aldrich) is diluted with colorless RPMI to the EC70 concentration as measured by dose response assay.
Incubation
A solution of test compound (200 μl) is added to each well. The plates are mixed on a microtiter plate shaker for 1 minute and then placed in an incubator. Twenty minutes later the solution of LPS (200 μL, EC70 concentration - 10 ng/ml) is added and the plates are mixed for 1 minute on a shaker. The plates are incubated for 18 to 24 hours at 37 °C in a 5 % carbon dioxide atmosphere.
TNF-α Analysis
Following the incubation the supernatant is removed with a pipet. TNF-α concentration is determined by ELISA using a mouse TNF- α kit (from Biosource
International, Camarillo, CA). Results are expressed in pg/mL. TNF-α expression upon LPS stimulation alone is considered a 100% response.
The complete disclosures of the patents, patent documents, and publications cited herein are incoφorated by reference in their entirety as if each were individually incorporated. Various modifications and alterations to this invention will become apparent to those skilled in the art without departing from the scope and spirit of this invention. It should be understood that this invention is not intended to be unduly limited by the illustrative embodiments and examples set forth herein and that such examples and embodiments are presented byway of example only with the scope of the invention intended to be limited only by the claims set forth herein as follows.

Claims

WHAT IS CLAIMED IS:
A compound of the Formula I:
Figure imgf000235_0001
I wherein:
X is Ci-io alkylene or C2-ι0 alkenylene;
RA and RB are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or when taken together, RA and RB form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R'" groups; or when taken together, R and RB form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups;
R2 and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino,
-S(O)0-2-alkyl, -S(O)0-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: ^~ Rι
1 η wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000237_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0- -, -N(-Q-R4)-, and -CH2-; Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O) -,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2;
R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent; R'" is a non-interfering substituent; ^ is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, aUcylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, CMO alkyl, C2-ιo alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Cι-10 alkylenyl; R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
Ru is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, Cι-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; and
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
2. A compound of the Formula H:
Figure imgf000238_0001
π wherein:
X is C1-10 alkylene or C2_io alkenylene; RAI and
Figure imgf000238_0002
are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or when taken together, RAI and RB1 form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups, or substituted by one R3 group, or substituted by one R3 group and one R group; or when taken together, RAI and RBI form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2;
Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
-R4,
-X'-Ri,
-X'-Y-R4,
Figure imgf000239_0001
-X'-R5,
-X"-O-NRia-Y'-Rib, and
Figure imgf000239_0002
R2, R", Rla, Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O)0-2-alkyl, -S(O)o-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(0)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or R and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
X~ RM
1 wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000241_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Ria and Rib together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of: -N- C(R6) -N- S(0)2 and ;
R3 is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-R4, -Z-X-R4,
-Z-X'-Y-R., -Z-X'-Y-X'-YTU, and -Z-X*-R5; X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R13)-alkylene- and -CH(R13)-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o-2-,
-S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-,
-C(R6)-O-,
-O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-O-,
-N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000242_0001
ected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O , -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000242_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
- C(0) _ N ) R10
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-;
Z is a bond or -O-;
Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9) ; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
-N- C(R6)
Figure imgf000243_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R7 is C2- alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Cι_10 alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl, CMO alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl; R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
Rio is C3-8 alkylene;
Ru is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of -CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0- -,
Figure imgf000244_0001
and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(Re)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
3. A compound of the Formula HI:
Figure imgf000244_0002
wherein: X is CMO alkylene or C2-ι0 alkenylene;
R2 and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino,
-S(O)0-2-alkyl, -S(O)0-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000246_0001
R1 19Z d wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9;
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-, -N^Q-R)-, and -CH2-; Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-;
Rc and Rj are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9) ; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R6 is selected from the group consisting of -O and =S; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-10 alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl,
Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
R is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
Ru is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1.5 alkylene, and
C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; n is an integer from 0 to 4;
R'" is a non-interfering substituent; and R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
4. A compound of the Formula ma:
Figure imgf000247_0001
wherein:
X is Ci-io alkylene or C2-10 alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; Ri is selected from the group consisting of: -R ,
Figure imgf000248_0001
-X'-Y-FU, -X'-Y-X'-Y-R^
Figure imgf000248_0002
-X"-O-NRia-Y'-Rib, and
-X"-O-N=C(Rι')(Rι"); R2, R", Ria, Rib, Ri1, and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino,
-S(O)0-2-alkyl,
-S(O)0-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or R and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000249_0001
1 π wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9,
Figure imgf000249_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Rla and Rib together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of: -N- C(R6) -N— S(O)2 R3 is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-R4, -Z-X -R , -Z-X*-Y-R4,
Figure imgf000250_0001
-Z-X'-R5; n is an integer from 0 to 4; m is 0 or 1 ; with the proviso that when m is 1 , then n is 0 or 1 ; X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is selected from the group consisting of -CH(Rι3)-alkylene- and -CH(Rι3)-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)0-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-,
-O-C(R,)-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-, -O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000250_0002
Figure imgf000251_0001
Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000251_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000251_0003
Ηo
-C(O)-C(O)-,
-C(O)-C(O)-O-, and
-C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Z is a bond or -O-;
Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
Rt is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be imsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nifro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000252_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-io alkyl, C2-1o alkenyl, CMO alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl; R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
Rio is C3-8 alkylene;
Rπ is C1-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and -N(R4)S
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-, -N^Q-Ri)-, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
5. A compound of the Formula ma:
Figure imgf000253_0001
wherein: X is Ci-io alkylene or C2-ιo alkenylene;
R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
-N(R9)2; Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000253_0002
-X-R4,
-X'-Y-R}, -X'-Y-X'-Y-IU,
-X'-Rs, -X"-O-NH-Y'-Rι', and
Figure imgf000254_0001
R2, R", Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, i alkoxy, dialkylamino, -S(O)o-2-alkyl, -S(O)o-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and , -C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" and/or Ri1 and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000255_0001
where n t e tota num er of atoms n the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000255_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; R3 is selected from the group consisting of:
-Z-R4, -Z-X-R4,
Figure imgf000255_0003
'-Z-X'-Y-X'-Y-EU, and -Z-X*-R5; n is an integer from 0 to 4; m is 0 or 1; with the proviso that when m is 1, then n is 0 or 1; X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; X" is -CH(Rι3)-alkylene- or-CH(R13)-alkenylene-; Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-,
-O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-, -O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000256_0001
Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-,
-S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000257_0001
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000257_0002
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and
-C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Z is a bond or -O-;
Rc and R are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, aikynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino,
(dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000258_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, Ci-io alkyl, C -ιo alkenyl, Ci-io alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C3-8 alkylene;
Ru is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; Ri2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, Cι-5 alkylene, and
C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o-2-, and
-NCEU)-;
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N(-Q-R4)-, and -CH2-; Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-; V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(Re)-, and
-S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
6. A compound of the Formula LV:
Figure imgf000259_0001
LV
wherein:
X is CMO alkylene or C2-ιo alkenylene;
R2 and R" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino,
-S(O)o-2-alkyl, -S(O)o-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nifro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy;
-C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000260_0001
1 π wherein the total number of atoms m the ring is 4 to 9,
Figure imgf000260_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-, -N(-Q-Rt)-, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R )-, -S(O)2-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-;
Rc and Rj are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and
Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be imsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nifro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, CMO alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl, CMO alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl; R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
Rπ is d-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; n is an integer from 0 to 4; and
R' is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
7. A compound of the Formula LVa:
Figure imgf000262_0001
LVa wnerem. X is C O alkylene or C2-ιo alkenylene;
R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
-N(R9)2; n is an integer from 0 to 4;
Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
-R4,
-X-R4,
-X'-Y-Rt,
-X-Y-X-Y-R4,
-X'-R5,
-X"-O-NRia-Y'-Rib, and
-X"-O-N=C(Rι')(Rι");
R2 , R", Rla, Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, ' heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O)0-2-alkyl, -S(O)o-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nifro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, ■ aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or R and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000264_0001
^R π η wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000264_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Rla and R^ together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000264_0003
X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R1 )-alkylene- and -CH(R13)-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; Y is selected from the group consisting of:
-S(O)o-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-, -O-C(R6)-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000265_0001
ected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000265_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-5
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000266_0001
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; * is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo; R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000266_0002
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R7 is C -7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C O alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl, C O alkoxy-d-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C3-8 alkylene; Ru is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
Rι is selected from the group consisting of a bond, Cι-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o-2-, and
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N(-Q-R4)-, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(Rό)-, -O- Rβ)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
A compound of the Formula LVa:
Figure imgf000267_0001
LVa wherein:
X is C O alkylene or C2-1o alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; n is an integer from 0 to 4;
Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
-R4,
Figure imgf000268_0001
-X'-Y-R ,
-X'-Y-X'-Y-R^ -X'-R5,
Figure imgf000268_0002
R2, R", Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino,
-S(O)o.2~alkyl,
-S(O)0-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nifro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" and/or R and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: ^ Rι
11 wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000269_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is -CH(R13)-alkylene- or-CH(R13)-alkenylene-;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o-2-,
-S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-,
-N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-, -O-C(R6)-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000270_0001
Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000271_0001
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000271_0002
-C(O)-C(O)-,
-C(O)-C(O)-O-, and
Figure imgf000271_0003
Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R ) ; or Rc and R can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino,
(dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000272_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C O alkyl, C2-ιo alkenyl, CMO alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C3-8 alkylene;
Ru is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; Rι2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1.5 alkylene, and
C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o-2-, and
-N(R4)-;
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N^Q-R -, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-; V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)~, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and
-S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
9. A compound of the Formula V:
Figure imgf000273_0001
V wherein: X is CMO alkylene or C2-ι0 alkenylene;
R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
-Rt,
-X'-R4,
-X-Y-R4,
-X'-Y-X'-Y-Ri, -X*-R5,
-X'-O-NRia-Y'-Rib, and
-X"-O-N=C(R1')(R1"); R2, R", Rla, Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, , amino, dialkylamino,
-S(O)o-2-alkyl, -S(O)o-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, -C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000275_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000275_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Ria and Rib together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
-N- C(R6) -N- S(O)2
Figure imgf000275_0003
R3 i vs selected from the group co ;nsisting of:
-Z-R4, -Z-X'-FU, -Z-X-Y-R4, -Z-X-Y-X'-Y-F , and -Z-X'-R5; p is an integer from 0 to 3; m is 0 or 1, with the proviso that when m is 1, p is 0 or 1; X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is selected from the group consisting of -CH(Rι3)-alkylene- and -CH(Rι3)-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; Y is selected from the group consisting of:
-S(O)0-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-,
-C(R6)-O-,
-O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-O-,
-N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000276_0001
ected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000276_0002
-C(O)-O-, -C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000277_0001
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Z is a bond or -O-;
Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R )2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000277_0002
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R7 is C2- alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 0 alkyl, C2-ιo alkenyl, CMO alkoxy-d-io alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C3-8 alkylene;
Ru is d-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, d.5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of -CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o-2-, and
-N(R4>; A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-, -N(-Q-R- -, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(Rό)-, -C(Rδ)-C(R6)-, -S(O) -, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
10. A compound of the Formula VI:
Figure imgf000278_0001
VI wherein: X is C O alkylene or C2-ιo alkenylene;
RA2 and RB2 are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
-N(R9)2; Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
-R4,
-X'-R,,
-X'-Y-RA,
-X'-Y-X'-Y-R4, -X*-R5,
-X"-O-NRia-Y'-Rib, and
Figure imgf000279_0001
R2, R", Rla, Ri , Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino,
-S(O)0-2-alkyl,
-S(O)0-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or R and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000281_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000281_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Rla and Rib together with the nifrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of: -N- C(R6) -N- S(O)2
Figure imgf000281_0003
X' i vs selected from the group co :nsisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R13)-alkylene- and
-CH(R13)-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6 , -C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-, -O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000281_0004
Figure imgf000282_0001
Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000282_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-:
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000282_0003
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nifro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000283_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R is C2- alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, CMO alkyl, C2-1o alkenyl,
C O alkoxy-CMo alkylenyl, and aryl-d-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
Rπ is C1-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, d-5 alkylene, and C -5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and -N(R4)-; A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-, -N -Q-R -, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R<5)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
11. A compound of the Formula VH:
Figure imgf000284_0001
VH wherein:
X is d-io alkylene or C2-10 alkenylene; RA3 and Rβ , when taken together, form a fused aryl ring or heteroaryl ring containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, wherein the aryl or heteroaryl ring is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups, or substituted by one R3 group, or substituted by one R3 group and one R group; or when taken together, RA3 and RB3 form a fused 5 to 7 membered saturated ring, optionally containing one heteroatom selected from the group consisting of N and S, and unsubstituted or substituted by one or more R groups; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; Ri is selected from the group consisting of: -R4, -X--R4,
-X -Y-R4, -X'-Y-X'-Y-E ,
-X'-R5,
-X"-O-NRla-Y'-Rib, and -X"-O-N=C(Rι')(Rι");
Ria, Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino, -S(O)0- -alkyl,
-S(O)0-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nifro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2, -N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000286_0001
1 q wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000286_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Ria and Rib together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000287_0001
R3 is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-R4,
-Z-X'-R4, -Z-X'-Y-Ri, -Z-X'-Y-X'-Y-R4, and -Z-X'-R5; X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is selected from the group consisting of -CH(Rι3)-alkylene- and -CH(Rι )-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of:
-S(O)0-2-,
-S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-,
-C(Re)-O-,
-O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-O-,
-N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R,s)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000287_0002
Figure imgf000288_0001
Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000288_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000288_0003
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Z is a bond or -O-; Rc and Rj are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and-N(R9)2; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; i is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be misubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000289_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R is C2- alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C O alkyl, C2-ιo alkenyl,
CMO alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-d-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C3-8 alkylene;
Ru is Cι-6 alkylene or C2.6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, Cι-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; Rι3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-, -N^Q-Ri)-, and -CH -;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R )-, -S(O) -, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
12. A compound of the Formula VHa:
Figure imgf000290_0001
VHa wherein:
X is CMO alkylene or C2_ιo alkenylene; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; Ri is selected from the group consisting of: -R4,
-X'-R4, -X'-Y-R4, -X'-Y-X'-Y-R4, -X'-R5,
-X"-O-NH-Y'-Rι', and
Figure imgf000291_0001
Ri' and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino, -S(O)o-2-alkyl, -S(O)o-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl, -NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nifro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl, -C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000292_0001
1 π wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000292_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; n is an integer from 0 to 4;
X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is -CH(Rι3)-alkylene- or -CH(Rι3)-alkenylene-;
Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)o-2-,
-S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-,
-O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-O-,
-N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000293_0001
ected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000293_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-, -C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-; -C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-, -C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000294_0001
-C(O)-C(O)-,
-C(O)-C(O)-O-, and
-C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Rc and Rj are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or j and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms;
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino,
(dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000294_0002
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C O alkyl, C2-1o alkenyl, CMO alkoxy-CMo alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl; R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
Rio is C3-8 alkylene;
Ru is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and
C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o- -, and
-NCEU)-;
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-,
Figure imgf000295_0001
and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-; V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and
-S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
13. A compound of the Formula VHb
VHb wherein: X is C O alkylene or C -10 alkenylene;
R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
-N(R9)2; n is an integer from 0 to 4; Ri is selected from the group consisting of: -R4, -XVf ,
-X-Y-RA, -X'-Y-X'-Y-RA, -X'-Rs,
Figure imgf000296_0001
-X"-O-N=C(Rι')(Rι");
Ri' and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, dialkylamino,
-S(O)0-2-alkyl, -S(O)0-2-aryl,
-NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyL
-C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl, -O-(CO)-alkyl, and
-C(O)-alkyl; or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000297_0001
1 η wherein the total number of atoms m the nng is 4 to 9,
Figure imgf000297_0002
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9;
X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can-be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; X" is -CH(Rι3)-alkylene- or -CH(Rι3)-alkenylene-; Y is selected from the group consisting of: -S(O)0-2-,
-S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R,)-, -O-C(O)-O-,
-N(R8)-Q-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-, -O-C(R6)-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000298_0001
Y' is selected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000299_0001
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000299_0002
-C(O)-C(O)-,
-C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9) ; or Rc and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; * is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino,
(dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of: — - NIN
Figure imgf000300_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =0 and =S;
R7 is C2- alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, CMO alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl, CMO alkoxy-d-10 alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
Rio is C3-8 alkylene;
Rπ is C1-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; R12 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and
C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which may be optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o-2-, and
-N(R4)S
A is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)o-2-,
Figure imgf000300_0002
and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R<5)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-; V is selected from the group consisting of -C(Pv6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and
-S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a phannaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
14. The compound or salt of claim 9 wherein p is 0.
15. The compound or salt of any one of claims 4, 5, 9, or 14 wherein m is 0.
16. The compound or salt of any one of claims 3 through 8, or claim 15 as dependent on claim 4 or claim 5, wherein n is 0.
17. The compound or salt of any one of claims 4 or 5, or claim 16 as dependent on any of claims 4, 5, or 15 wherein n and m are 0.
18. The compound or salt of any one of claims 7 or 8, or claim 16 as dependent on claim 7 or claim 8 wherein n is 0.
19. The compound or salt of claim 9 or claim 15 as dependent on claim 9 or claim 14 wherein m and p are 0.
20. The compound or salt of claim 10 wherein A2 and Rβ2 are each methyl.
21. The compound or salt of any one of claims 1 , 3 , or 6, or claim 16 as dependent on claim 3 or claim 6, wherein R' is selected from the group consisting of:
-R4, -X-R4, -X-Y-R4, -X'-Y-X'-Y-R4,
-X'-R5,
-X"-O-NH-Y'-Rι*, and -X"-O-N=C(Rι')(Rι"); wherein: X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
X" is -CH(R13)-alkylene- or -CH(R13)-alkenylene-; Y is selected from the group consisting of:
-S(O)o-2-,
-S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-,
-C(R6)-O-,
-O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-O-,
-N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000302_0001
lected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000302_0002
-C(O)-O-, -C(O)-N(R8)-, -C(S)-N(R8)-, -C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-, -C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-, -C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000303_0001
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Ri' and Ri" are the same as R2 and R"; R\ is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
— ■N N
Figure imgf000303_0002
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R7 is C - alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C O alkyl, C2-ιo alkenyl,
CMO alkoxy-Ci-io alkylenyl, and aryl-CMo alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C -8 alkylene; Rι3 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of-CH -, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)o-2-, and -N(R0-; Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O) -,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7.
22. The compound or salt of any one of claims 1 or 3, or claim 21 as dependent on any of claims 1 or 3, wherein R'" is R or R3 when n is 1, R or one R and one R3 when n is 2, or R when n is 3 to 4; R is selected from the group consisting of: halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; R3 is selected from the group consisting of: -Z-R4,
-Z-X-R4, -Z-X'-Y-R^ -Z-X'-Y-X'-Y-R , and -Z-X'-R5; n is an integer from 0 to 4;
Z is a bond or -O-; X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; Y is selected from the group consisting of:
-S(O)o-2~,
-S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-,
-C(R6)-O-, -O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-O-,
-N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000305_0001
Rj is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino,
(dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000306_0001
R6 is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, CMO alkyl, C2-ι0 alkenyl,
CMO alkoxy-Cι-ιo alkylenyl, and aryl-Ci-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; Rio is C3-8 alkylene;
A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and
-NO )-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O) -,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-; V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R<5)-, -O-C(R<5)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and
-S(O)2-;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7.
23. The compound or salt of any one of claims 2, 4, 5, 7 through 15, claims 17 through
20, or claim 16 as dependent on any one of claims 4, 5, 7, 8, or 15, wherein Ri is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkylsulfonylalkylenyl, -X'-Y-R^ and -X'-R5; wherein X' is alkylene; Y is -N(R8)-C(O)-, -N(R8)-S(O)2-, -N(R8)-S(O)2-N(R8)-, -N(R8)-C(O)-N(R8)-, -N(R8)-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000307_0001
; R is hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, or heteroaryl, wherein alkyl and alkenyl are optionally substituted by aryl or aryloxy and wherein aryl is optionally substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, cyano, and halogen; and R5 is
-N- C(R6) -N— S(0)2
Figure imgf000307_0002
24. The compound or salt of claim 23 wherein Ri is 2-methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2- methylpropyl, or-X'-Y-R^ X' is ethylene, propylene, or butylene; Y is -NH-C(O)-, -NH-S(O)2-, -NH-S(O)2-N(R8)-, -NH-C(O)-N(R8)-, -NH-C(O)-NH-C(O)-, or
- NH- C(O)— N X
; and R8 is hydrogen or methyl.
25. The compound or salt of any one of claims 1 through 10, 14 through 22, or 24, or claim 23 as dependent on any one of claims 2, 4, 5, 7 through 10 or 14 through 20, wherein at least one of R" or R2 is hydrogen.
26. The compound or salt of any one of claims 1 through 10, 14 through 22, 24, or 25, or claim 23 as dependent on any one of claims 2, 4, 5, 7 through 10 or 14 through 20, wherein at least one of R" or R2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl, wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, and heterocyclylalkylenyl are optionally substituted.
27. " The compound or salt of claim 26 wherein at least one of R" or R2 is alkyl or substituted alkyl, and at least one of R" or R2 is hydrogen.
28. The compound or salt of claim 26 wherein at least one of R" or R2 is alkenyl or substituted alkenyl, and at least one of R" or R2 is hydrogen.
29. The compound or salt of claim 26 wherein at least one of R" or R2 is aryl, arylalkylenyl, substituted aryl, or substituted arylalkylenyl, and at least one of R" or R2 is hydrogen.
30. The compound or salt of claim 26 wherein at least one of R" or R is heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, substituted heteroaryl, or substituted heteroarylalkylenyl, and at least one of R" or R2 is hydrogen.
31. The compound or salt of claim 26 wherein at least one of R" or R is heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted heterocyclyl, or substituted heterocyclylalkylenyl, and at least one of R" or R2 is hydrogen.
32. The compound or salt of any one of claims 1 through 10, 14 through 22, or 24, or claim 23 as dependent on any one of claims 2, 4, 5, 7 through 10 or 14 through 20, wherein R and R" are independently C O alkyl.
33. The compound or salt of claim 32 wherein R2 and R" are each methyl.
34. The compound or salt of any one of claims 1 through 10, 14 through 22, or 24, or claim 23 as dependent on any one of claims 2, 4, 5, 7 through 10 or 14 through 20, wherein at least one of R" or R is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, cyclopropyl, 2-(ethoxycarbonyl)cyclopropyl, propyl, butyl, 2-methylpropyl, tert-butyl, cyclopentyl, 2-cyclopentylethyl, acetoxymethyl, (ethoxycarbonyl)methyl, furyl, furfuryl, cyclohexyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 2-(methylthio)ethyl, phenyl, 2-methylphenyl, 3- methylphenyl, 4-methylphenyl, 2-methoxyphenyl, 3-methoxyphenyl, 4-methoxyphenyl, 2,6-dimethoxyphenyl, 2-chlorophenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 4-chlorophenyl, 2-fluorophenyl, 3- fluorophenyl, 4-fluorophenyl, 2-cyanophenyl, 3 -cyanophenyl, 4-cyanophenyl, 4- (dimethylamino)phenyl, 3-hydroxy-4-methoxyphenyl, 4-acetamidophenyl, 4- (methoxycarbonyl)phenyl, 4-trifluoromethylphenyl, phenylmethyl, phenoxymethyl, 1- phenylethyl, 2-phenylethyl, 2-phenylethenyl, biphenyl, 2-pyridyl, 3-pyridyl, 4-pyridyl, 1- methylpynol-2-yl, l-methylimidazol-2-yl, l-methylimidazol-4-yl, 3-cyclohexen-l-yl, 3,4- dihydro-2H-pyran-2-yl, 2-thienyl, 3-thienyl, thien-2-ylmethyl, thiazol-2-yl, 5-isoxazolyl, quinolin-2-yl, quinolin-3-yl, quinolin-4-yl, l-methylindol-2-yl, l-methylindol-3-yl, hydroxymethyl, 3,4-difluorophenyl, 3-chloro-4-fluorophenyl, 3,4-dichlorophenyl, 4- hydroxyphenyl, 2-hydroxyethyl, 1-hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, heptyl, and pynol-3-yl.
35. The compound or salt of any one of claims 1 through 10, 14 through 22, or 24, or claim 23 as dependent on any one of claims 2, 4, 5, 7 through 10 or 14 through 20, wherein R2 and R" join together to form a ring system.
36. The compound or salt of claim 35 wherein the ring system is
Figure imgf000309_0001
, wherein Ru is C1-2 alkylene; A is -CH2-, -O-, or -NX-Q-Rj)-; Q is a bond or -C(O)-; and Rj is alkyl or arylalkylenyl.
37. The compound or salt of any one of claims 1 through 36 wherein X is C1- alkylene.
38. The compound or salt of claim 37 wherein X is methylene.
39. The compound or salt of any one of claims 2, 4, 5, 7 through 10, 14, 15, or 17 through 20, or claim 16 as dependent on any one of claims 4, 5, 7, 8, or 15, wherein X is C1-4 alkylene; R2 is C1- alkyl; R" is hydrogen or Cι-4 alkyl; and Ri is Cι-6 alkyl or hydroxy-Cι-6 alkyl.
40. The compound or salt of any one of claims 2, 4, 5, 7 through 10, 14, 15, or 17 through 20, or claim 16 as dependent on any one of claims 4, 5, 7, 8, or 15, wherein X is Cι-4 alkylene; R" is C1-4 alkyl; R2 is hydrogen or C1-4 alkyl; and Ri is C1-6 alkyl or hydroxy-Ci-6 alkyl.
41. The compound or salt of any one of claims 39 or 40 wherein X is methylene; at least one of R" or R2 is methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, or 2-methylpropyl; and Rj is 2- methylpropyl, 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl, or butyl.
42. The compound or salt of any one of claims 39, 40, or 41 wherein X is methylene; R" and R are methyl; and Ri is 2-methylpropyl or 2-hydroxy-2-methylpropyl.
43. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of claims 1 through 42 in combination with a phannaceutically acceptable carrier.
44. A method of inducing cytokine biosynthesis in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of claims 1 through 42 to the animal.
45. A method of treating a viral disease in an animal in need thereof comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of claims 1 through 42 to the animal. (
46. A method of treating a neoplastic disease in an animal in need thereof comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of claims 1 through 42 to the animal.
47. A compound of the Formula VIH:
Figure imgf000310_0001
vm wherein: RA2 and RB are each independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, halogen, ' alkyl, alkenyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and
-N(R9)2; X is C1-10 alkylene or C2-1o alkenylene; Ri is selected from the group consisting of:
-Rt,
-X-R4,
Figure imgf000311_0001
-X'-R5,
-X"-O-NRia-Y'-Rib, and
Figure imgf000311_0002
R2, R", Rla, Rib, Ri', and Ri" are independently selected from the group consisting of: hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkylenyl, and alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heterocyclyl, or heterocyclylalkylenyl, substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of: hydroxy, alkyl, haloalkyl, hydroxyalkyl, alkoxy, amino, dialkylamino,
-S(O)o-2-alkyl,
-S(O)o-2-aryl, -NH-S(O)2-alkyl,
-NH-S(O)2-aryl, haloalkoxy, halogen, cyano, nitro, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy,
-C(O)-O-alkyl,
-C(O)-N(R8)2,
-N(R8)-C(O)-alkyl,
-O-(CO)-alkyl, and -C(O)-alkyl; or R2 and R" and/or Ri' and Ri" can join together to form a ring system selected from the group consisting of: R11 ^ A'
-R 1 wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9, and
Figure imgf000313_0001
wherein the total number of atoms in the ring is 4 to 9; or Ria and Rib together with the nitrogen atom and Y' to which they are bonded can join to form a ring selected from the group consisting of: -N- C(R6) -N- S(0)2 R7 and Rj ;
X' is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated by arylene, heteroarylene or heterocyclylene and optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups; X" is selected from the group consisting of-CH(R13)-alkylene- and
-CH(Rι3)-alkenylene-, wherein the alkylene and alkenylene are optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of:
-S(O)0-2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-,
-C(R6)-O-,
-O-C(R6)-,
-O-C(O)-O-, -N(R8)-Q-,
-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-O-C(R6)-N(R8)-,
-C(R6)-N(OR9)-,
Figure imgf000313_0002
Figure imgf000314_0001
lected from the group consisting of: a bond, -C(O)-, -C(S)-, -S(O)2-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-,
Figure imgf000314_0002
-C(O)-O-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-S(O)2-,
-C(O)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
-C(S)-N(R8)-C(O)-,
Figure imgf000314_0003
-C(O)-C(O)-, -C(O)-C(O)-O-, and -C(=NH)-N(R8)-; Rc and Rd are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxy, alkyl, alkenyl, aryl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, and -N(R9)2; or , and Rd can join to form a fused aryl ring or fused 5-10 membered heteroaryl ring containing one to four heteroatoms; Rj is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be imsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000315_0001
Rβ is selected from the group consisting of =O and =S; R is C2-7 alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C O alkyl, C2-10 alkenyl,
CMO alkoxy-d-io alkylenyl, and aryl-d-io alkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl; R10 is C -8 alkylene;
Ru is Cι-6 alkylene or C2-6 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom;
2 is selected from the group consisting of a bond, C1-5 alkylene, and C2-5 alkenylene, wherein the alkylene or alkenylene is optionally interrupted by one heteroatom; R13 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl which maybe optionally interrupted by one or more -O- groups;
A is selected from the group consisting of-CH2-, -O-, -C(O)-, -S(O)0-2-, and
A' is selected from the group consisting of -O-, -S(O)0-2-, -N(-Q-R4)-, and -CH2-;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(R6)-, -C(R6)-C(R6)-, -S(O)2-, -C(R6)-N(R8)-W-, -S(O)2-N(R8)-, -C(R6)-O-, and -C(R6)-N(OR9)-;
V is selected from the group consisting of -C(R6)-, -O-C(R6)-, -N(R8)-C(R6)-, and -S(O)2-; W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, -C(O)-, and -S(O)2-; and a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a + b is < 7; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
PCT/US2004/037854 2003-11-14 2004-11-12 Oxime substituted imidazo ring compounds WO2005048933A2 (en)

Priority Applications (5)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
CA002545774A CA2545774A1 (en) 2003-11-14 2004-11-12 Oxime substituted imidazo ring compounds
JP2006539911A JP2007511527A (en) 2003-11-14 2004-11-12 Oxime-substituted imidazo ring compounds
EP04810872A EP1685129A4 (en) 2003-11-14 2004-11-12 Oxime substituted imidazo ring compounds
US10/595,792 US7897767B2 (en) 2003-11-14 2004-11-12 Oxime substituted imidazoquinolines
AU2004291101A AU2004291101A1 (en) 2003-11-14 2004-11-12 Oxime substituted imidazo ring compounds

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US52041803P 2003-11-14 2003-11-14
US60/520,418 2003-11-14

Publications (2)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2005048933A2 true WO2005048933A2 (en) 2005-06-02
WO2005048933A3 WO2005048933A3 (en) 2005-12-01

Family

ID=34619463

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2004/037854 WO2005048933A2 (en) 2003-11-14 2004-11-12 Oxime substituted imidazo ring compounds

Country Status (7)

Country Link
US (1) US7897767B2 (en)
EP (1) EP1685129A4 (en)
JP (1) JP2007511527A (en)
CN (1) CN1906193A (en)
AU (1) AU2004291101A1 (en)
CA (1) CA2545774A1 (en)
WO (1) WO2005048933A2 (en)

Cited By (33)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2005048945A3 (en) * 2003-11-14 2006-03-23 3M Innovative Properties Co Hydroxylamine substituted imidazo ring compounds
WO2006080043A2 (en) * 2005-01-27 2006-08-03 Alma Mater Studiorum- Universita' Di Bologna Organic compounds useful for the treatment of alzheimer's disease, their use and method of preparation
EP1833827A2 (en) * 2004-12-30 2007-09-19 3M Innovative Properties Company Process for preparing 2-methyl-1-(2-methylpropyl)-1h-imidazoý4,5-c¨ý1,5¨naphthyridin-4-amine
JP2009507036A (en) * 2005-09-02 2009-02-19 ファイザー・インク Hydroxy-substituted 1H-imidazopyridine and method
JP2009509971A (en) * 2005-09-23 2009-03-12 コーリー ファーマシューティカル グループ,インコーポレイテッド Process for 1H-imidazo [4,5-c] pyridine and analogs thereof
WO2009118296A2 (en) * 2008-03-24 2009-10-01 4Sc Ag Novel substituted imidazoquinolines
JP2009544586A (en) * 2006-07-14 2009-12-17 塩野義製薬株式会社 Oxime compounds and uses thereof
US7879849B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2011-02-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridines and analogs thereof
US7897767B2 (en) * 2003-11-14 2011-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime substituted imidazoquinolines
US7906506B2 (en) 2006-07-12 2011-03-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted chiral fused [1,2] imidazo [4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US7915281B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2011-03-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Isoxazole, dihydroisoxazole, and oxadiazole substituted imidazo ring compounds and method
US7923429B2 (en) 2003-09-05 2011-04-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Treatment for CD5+ B cell lymphoma
US7943610B2 (en) 2005-04-01 2011-05-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridine-1,4-diamines and analogs thereof
US7943636B2 (en) 2005-04-01 2011-05-17 3M Innovative Properties Company 1-substituted pyrazolo (3,4-C) ring compounds as modulators of cytokine biosynthesis for the treatment of viral infections and neoplastic diseases
US7943609B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2011-05-17 3M Innovative Proprerties Company Chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-C] ring compounds
US7968563B2 (en) 2005-02-11 2011-06-28 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime and hydroxylamine substituted imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US8034938B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2011-10-11 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds
EP2394650A1 (en) 2004-12-30 2011-12-14 3M Innovative Properties Co. Use of resiquimod for the treatment of cutaneous metastases
US8518934B2 (en) 2008-06-11 2013-08-27 Shonogi & Co., Ltd. Oxycarbamoyl compounds and the use thereof
US8563732B2 (en) 2007-05-31 2013-10-22 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Oxyimino compounds and the use thereof
US8728486B2 (en) 2011-05-18 2014-05-20 University Of Kansas Toll-like receptor-7 and -8 modulatory 1H imidazoquinoline derived compounds
WO2014107663A2 (en) 2013-01-07 2014-07-10 The Trustees Of The University Of Pennsylvania Compositions and methods for treating cutaneous t cell lymphoma
US8871782B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2014-10-28 3M Innovative Properties Company Alkoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
US8951528B2 (en) 2006-02-22 2015-02-10 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier conjugates
US9248127B2 (en) 2005-02-04 2016-02-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Aqueous gel formulations containing immune response modifiers
EP3153180A1 (en) 2011-06-03 2017-04-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Heterobifunctional linkers with polyethylene glycol segments and immune response modifier conjugates made therefrom
US10005772B2 (en) 2006-12-22 2018-06-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier compositions and methods
WO2019166946A1 (en) 2018-02-28 2019-09-06 Pfizer Inc. Il-15 variants and uses thereof
WO2019224715A1 (en) 2018-05-23 2019-11-28 Pfizer Inc. Antibodies specific for cd3 and uses thereof
WO2019224716A2 (en) 2018-05-23 2019-11-28 Pfizer Inc. Antibodies specific for gucy2c and uses thereof
WO2020128893A1 (en) 2018-12-21 2020-06-25 Pfizer Inc. Combination treatments of cancer comprising a tlr agonist
WO2021124073A1 (en) 2019-12-17 2021-06-24 Pfizer Inc. Antibodies specific for cd47, pd-l1, and uses thereof
WO2022013775A1 (en) 2020-07-17 2022-01-20 Pfizer Inc. Therapeutic antibodies and their uses

Families Citing this family (37)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US6677347B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-01-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamido ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US20040265351A1 (en) 2003-04-10 2004-12-30 Miller Richard L. Methods and compositions for enhancing immune response
EP1617845A4 (en) * 2003-04-28 2006-09-20 3M Innovative Properties Co Compositions and methods for induction of opioid receptors
JP2007502288A (en) * 2003-08-12 2007-02-08 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Oxime-substituted imidazo-containing compounds
EP1658076B1 (en) * 2003-08-27 2013-03-06 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryloxy and arylalkyleneoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
AU2004315876B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2011-05-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridines and analogs thereof
US20090075980A1 (en) * 2003-10-03 2009-03-19 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Pyrazolopyridines and Analogs Thereof
US8691837B2 (en) 2003-11-25 2014-04-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazo ring systems and methods
WO2005066170A1 (en) * 2003-12-29 2005-07-21 3M Innovative Properties Company Arylalkenyl and arylalkynyl substituted imidazoquinolines
US8735421B2 (en) * 2003-12-30 2014-05-27 3M Innovative Properties Company Imidazoquinolinyl sulfonamides
WO2005094531A2 (en) * 2004-03-24 2005-10-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazopyridines, imidazoquinolines, and imidazonaphthyridines
WO2005123080A2 (en) * 2004-06-15 2005-12-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Nitrogen-containing heterocyclyl substituted imidazoquinolines and imidazonaphthyridines
US8541438B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2013-09-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazoquinolines, imidazopyridines, and imidazonaphthyridines
WO2006038923A2 (en) * 2004-06-18 2006-04-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryl substituted imidazonaphthyridines
WO2006009826A1 (en) * 2004-06-18 2006-01-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryloxy and arylalkyleneoxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US20090270443A1 (en) * 2004-09-02 2009-10-29 Doris Stoermer 1-amino imidazo-containing compounds and methods
WO2006063072A2 (en) * 2004-12-08 2006-06-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Immunomodulatory compositions, combinations and methods
AU2006212765B2 (en) 2005-02-09 2012-02-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
CA2602083A1 (en) 2005-02-09 2006-08-09 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Oxime and hydroxylamine substituted thiazolo(4,5-c) ring compounds and methods
US8658666B2 (en) * 2005-02-11 2014-02-25 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazoquinolines and imidazonaphthyridines
CA2598695A1 (en) * 2005-02-23 2006-09-21 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Hydroxyalkyl substituted imidazoquinolines
EP1850849A2 (en) * 2005-02-23 2007-11-07 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Method of preferentially inducing the biosynthesis of interferon
CA2598639A1 (en) 2005-02-23 2006-08-31 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Hydroxyalkyl substituted imidazonaphthyridines
US8158794B2 (en) * 2005-02-23 2012-04-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxyalkyl substituted imidazoquinoline compounds and methods
US8476292B2 (en) * 2005-09-09 2013-07-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide and carbamate derivatives of N-{2-[4-amino-2-(ethoxymethyl)-1H-imidazo[4,5-c] quinolin-1-Yl]-1,1-dimethylethyl}methanesulfonamide and methods
ZA200803029B (en) 2005-09-09 2009-02-25 Coley Pharm Group Inc Amide and carbamate derivatives of alkyl substituted /V-[4-(4-amino-1H-imidazo[4,5-c] quinolin-1-yl)butyl] methane-sulfonamides and methods
EP1948173B1 (en) 2005-11-04 2013-07-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1h-imidazoquinolines and methods
WO2007106854A2 (en) * 2006-03-15 2007-09-20 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1h-imidazonaphthyridines and methods
US8178539B2 (en) * 2006-09-06 2012-05-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted 3,4,6,7-tetrahydro-5H-1,2a,4a,8-tetraazacyclopenta[cd]phenalenes and methods
AU2010229835B2 (en) 2009-03-25 2015-01-15 The Board Of Regents Of The University Of Texas System Compositions for stimulation of mammalian innate immune resistance to pathogens
HUE033901T2 (en) 2010-08-17 2018-01-29 3M Innovative Properties Co Lipidated immune response modifier compound compositions, formulations, and methods
JP6460789B2 (en) 2011-06-03 2019-01-30 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Heterobifunctional linker having polyethylene glycol segment and immune response modulating complex prepared from the linker
US10286065B2 (en) 2014-09-19 2019-05-14 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Compositions and methods for treating viral infections through stimulated innate immunity in combination with antiviral compounds
WO2016057931A1 (en) 2014-10-10 2016-04-14 The Research Foundation For The State University Of New York Trifluoromethoxylation of arenes via intramolecular trifluoromethoxy group migration
JP6873980B2 (en) * 2015-09-14 2021-05-19 ファイザー・インク Novel imidazole [4,5-c] quinoline and imidazole [4,5-c] [1,5] naphthylidine derivatives as LRRK2 inhibitors
US11306083B2 (en) 2017-12-20 2022-04-19 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazo[4,5-C]quinoline compounds with a branched chain linking group for use as an immune response modifier
CN115403456B (en) * 2022-09-22 2023-11-17 成都大学 Method for synthesizing Edwan sweet intermediate 3-hydroxy-4-methoxy phenylpropionaldehyde

Family Cites Families (302)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US3314941A (en) * 1964-06-23 1967-04-18 American Cyanamid Co Novel substituted pyridodiazepins
DE1645976A1 (en) 1966-06-18 1971-01-21 Ajinomoto Kk Process for the preparation of adenosine and 2 ', 3'-O-isopropylidene adenosine
ZA704419B (en) 1969-07-21 1971-04-28 Ici Australia Ltd Injectable aqueous solutions of tetramisole
US3692907A (en) 1970-10-27 1972-09-19 Richardson Merrell Inc Treating viral infections with bis-basic ethers and thioethers of fluorenone and fluorene and pharmaceutical compositons of the same
US3917624A (en) 1972-09-27 1975-11-04 Pfizer Process for producing 2-amino-nicotinonitrile intermediates
US4006237A (en) 1973-10-11 1977-02-01 Beecham Group Limited Tetrahydrocarbostyril derivatives for the prophylaxis of asthma, hayfever and rhinitis
US3891660A (en) 1974-02-07 1975-06-24 Squibb & Sons Inc Derivatives of 1H-imidazo{8 4,5-c{9 pyridine-7-carboxylic acids and esters
US3899508A (en) 1974-04-12 1975-08-12 Lilly Co Eli 5-(2-Aminophenyl)pyrazole-3-carboxylic acids and esters thereof
DE2423389A1 (en) 1974-05-14 1975-12-04 Hoechst Ag PSYCHOTROPIC MEDICINAL PRODUCTS AND THE METHOD OF MANUFACTURING THEREOF
US4381344A (en) 1980-04-25 1983-04-26 Burroughs Wellcome Co. Process for producing deoxyribosides using bacterial phosphorylase
DE3204126A1 (en) 1982-02-06 1983-08-11 Bayer Ag, 5090 Leverkusen PYRAZOLOXAZINE, -THIAZINE, -CHINOLINE, METHOD FOR THE PRODUCTION THEREOF AND THEIR USE AS A MEDICINAL PRODUCT
US4758574A (en) 1982-05-03 1988-07-19 Eli Lilly And Company 2-phenylimidazio (4,5-c) pyridines
US4563525A (en) 1983-05-31 1986-01-07 Ici Americas Inc. Process for preparing pyrazolopyridine compounds
HU190109B (en) 1983-06-14 1986-08-28 Egyt Gyogyszervegyeszeti Gyar,Hu Process for preparing imidazo/4,5-c/quinolines
ZA848968B (en) * 1983-11-18 1986-06-25 Riker Laboratories Inc 1h-imidazo(4,5-c)quinolines and 1h-imidazo(4,5-c)quinolin-4-amines
CA1271477A (en) 1983-11-18 1990-07-10 John F. Gerster 1h-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amines
IL73534A (en) * 1983-11-18 1990-12-23 Riker Laboratories Inc 1h-imidazo(4,5-c)quinoline-4-amines,their preparation and pharmaceutical compositions containing certain such compounds
JPS61112075A (en) 1984-11-05 1986-05-30 Shionogi & Co Ltd Thienylpyrazoloquinoline derivative
US4593821A (en) 1985-04-25 1986-06-10 Laros Equipment Company, Inc. Belt separator for blow molding parts
US4668686A (en) 1985-04-25 1987-05-26 Bristol-Myers Company Imidazoquinoline antithrombrogenic cardiotonic agents
US4698346A (en) 1985-05-08 1987-10-06 Usv Pharmaceutical Corporation Thiazolo[5,4-h]quinoline compounds useful as anti-allergy agents
US4826830A (en) 1985-07-31 1989-05-02 Jui Han Topical application of glyciphosphoramide
CA1306260C (en) 1985-10-18 1992-08-11 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Condensed imidazopyridine derivatives
HU197019B (en) 1985-11-12 1989-02-28 Egyt Gyogyszervegyeszeti Gyar Process for producing thiqzolo (4,5-c) quinoline derivatives and pharmaceuticals comprising same
US4837378A (en) 1986-01-15 1989-06-06 Curatek Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Topical metronidazole formulations and therapeutic uses thereof
US4775674A (en) 1986-05-23 1988-10-04 Bristol-Myers Company Imidazoquinolinylether derivatives useful as phosphodiesterase and blood aggregation inhibitors
CA1287061C (en) 1986-06-27 1991-07-30 Roche Holding Ltd. Pyridine ethanolamine derivatives
US5500228A (en) 1987-05-26 1996-03-19 American Cyanamid Company Phase separation-microencapsulated pharmaceuticals compositions useful for alleviating dental disease
US4880779A (en) 1987-07-31 1989-11-14 Research Corporation Technologies, Inc. Method of prevention or treatment of AIDS by inhibition of human immunodeficiency virus
US4774339A (en) 1987-08-10 1988-09-27 Molecular Probes, Inc. Chemically reactive dipyrrometheneboron difluoride dyes
US5536743A (en) 1988-01-15 1996-07-16 Curatek Pharmaceuticals Limited Partnership Intravaginal treatment of vaginal infections with buffered metronidazole compositions
US5225183A (en) 1988-12-06 1993-07-06 Riker Laboratories, Inc. Medicinal aerosol formulations
US5238944A (en) * 1988-12-15 1993-08-24 Riker Laboratories, Inc. Topical formulations and transdermal delivery systems containing 1-isobutyl-1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine
US5736553A (en) 1988-12-15 1998-04-07 Riker Laboratories, Inc. Topical formulations and transdermal delivery systems containing 1-isobutyl-1H-imidazo 4,5-C!quinolin-4-amine
US5756747A (en) * 1989-02-27 1998-05-26 Riker Laboratories, Inc. 1H-imidazo 4,5-c!quinolin-4-amines
DE69029212T2 (en) 1989-02-27 1997-05-22 Riker Laboratories Inc 4-Amino-1H-imidazo (4,5-c) quinolines as antiviral agents
US5457183A (en) 1989-03-06 1995-10-10 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Hydroxylated texaphyrins
US5037986A (en) * 1989-03-23 1991-08-06 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Olefinic 1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amines
US4929624A (en) 1989-03-23 1990-05-29 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Olefinic 1H-imidazo(4,5-c)quinolin-4-amines
NZ232740A (en) 1989-04-20 1992-06-25 Riker Laboratories Inc Solution for parenteral administration comprising a 1h-imidazo(4,5-c) quinolin-4-amine derivative, an acid and a tonicity adjuster
US4988815A (en) 1989-10-26 1991-01-29 Riker Laboratories, Inc. 3-Amino or 3-nitro quinoline compounds which are intermediates in preparing 1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolines
US5750134A (en) 1989-11-03 1998-05-12 Riker Laboratories, Inc. Bioadhesive composition and patch
AU658134B2 (en) 1989-12-28 1995-04-06 Virginia Commonwealth University Sigma receptor ligands and the use thereof
US5274113A (en) 1991-11-01 1993-12-28 Molecular Probes, Inc. Long wavelength chemically reactive dipyrrometheneboron difluoride dyes and conjugates
EP0527818A4 (en) 1990-04-30 1993-09-15 Isis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Oligonucleotide modulation of arachidonic acid metabolism
JPH04235974A (en) 1990-06-08 1992-08-25 Roussel Uclaf New benzimidazole derivatives, process for producing same, obtained new intermediates, use thereof as medicines and pharmaceutical compositions containing same
DK0553202T3 (en) * 1990-10-05 1995-07-03 Minnesota Mining & Mfg Process for the preparation of imidazo (4,5-c) quinoline-4-amines
MX9203481A (en) 1990-10-18 1992-07-01 Minnesota Mining & Mfg FORMULATIONS.
US5248782A (en) 1990-12-18 1993-09-28 Molecular Probes, Inc. Long wavelength heteroaryl-substituted dipyrrometheneboron difluoride dyes
US5175296A (en) * 1991-03-01 1992-12-29 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amines and processes for their preparation
US5389640A (en) 1991-03-01 1995-02-14 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company 1-substituted, 2-substituted 1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amines
US5342784A (en) 1991-04-12 1994-08-30 Mitsubishi Paper Mills Limited Electrophotographic lithographic printing plate
JPH04327587A (en) 1991-04-26 1992-11-17 Asahi Chem Ind Co Ltd 6'-c-alkyl-3-deazaneplanocin a derivative, its production and use
US5187288A (en) 1991-05-22 1993-02-16 Molecular Probes, Inc. Ethenyl-substituted dipyrrometheneboron difluoride dyes and their synthesis
US5268376A (en) * 1991-09-04 1993-12-07 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company 1-substituted 1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amines
TW300219B (en) 1991-09-14 1997-03-11 Hoechst Ag
PH31245A (en) 1991-10-30 1998-06-18 Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv 1,3-Dihydro-2H-imidazoÄ4,5-BÜ-quinolin-2-one derivatives.
US5266575A (en) * 1991-11-06 1993-11-30 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company 2-ethyl 1H-imidazo[4,5-ciquinolin-4-amines
US5378848A (en) 1992-02-12 1995-01-03 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Condensed imidazopyridine derivatives
IL105325A (en) * 1992-04-16 1996-11-14 Minnesota Mining & Mfg Immunogen/vaccine adjuvant composition
DE69312487T2 (en) 1992-05-18 1997-11-27 Minnesota Mining & Mfg DEVICE FOR TRANSMUCOSAL DELIVERY OF ACTIVE SUBSTANCES
US5352680A (en) 1992-07-15 1994-10-04 Regents Of The University Of Minnesota Delta opioid receptor antagonists to block opioid agonist tolerance and dependence
US6608201B2 (en) 1992-08-28 2003-08-19 3M Innovative Properties Company Process for preparing 1-substituted, 2-substituted 1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amines
US5395937A (en) * 1993-01-29 1995-03-07 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Process for preparing quinoline amines
DE69413955T2 (en) 1993-03-17 1999-04-01 Minnesota Mining & Mfg AEROSOL COMPOSITION CONTAINING A DERIVATIVE DERIVATIVE FROM ESTER, AMID OR MERCAPTOESTER
DE4309969A1 (en) 1993-03-26 1994-09-29 Bayer Ag Substituted hetero-fused imidazoles
EP0622681B1 (en) 1993-04-27 1997-10-01 Agfa-Gevaert N.V. Process for incorporation of a water-insoluble substance into a hydrophilic layer
CZ288182B6 (en) 1993-07-15 2001-05-16 Minnesota Mining & Mfg Imidazo[4,5-c]pyridine-4-amines and pharmaceutical preparations based thereon
US5648516A (en) 1994-07-20 1997-07-15 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Fused cycloalkylimidazopyridines
US5352784A (en) 1993-07-15 1994-10-04 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Fused cycloalkylimidazopyridines
CA2131680C (en) 1993-09-17 2006-11-07 Gerhard Stucky Process for preparing imidazopyridine derivatives
US5837809A (en) 1995-08-11 1998-11-17 Oregon Health Sciences University Mammalian opioid receptor ligand and uses
JPH07163368A (en) 1993-12-15 1995-06-27 Hayashibara Biochem Lab Inc Recombinant dna and transformant containing the same recombinant dna
TW574214B (en) 1994-06-08 2004-02-01 Pfizer Corticotropin releasing factor antagonists
ES2267100T5 (en) 1994-07-15 2011-04-08 The University Of Iowa Research Foundation IMMUNOMODULATING OLIGONUCLEOTIDES.
US6207646B1 (en) 1994-07-15 2001-03-27 University Of Iowa Research Foundation Immunostimulatory nucleic acid molecules
US6239116B1 (en) 1994-07-15 2001-05-29 University Of Iowa Research Foundation Immunostimulatory nucleic acid molecules
US5612377A (en) 1994-08-04 1997-03-18 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Method of inhibiting leukotriene biosynthesis
US5644063A (en) 1994-09-08 1997-07-01 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-4-amine intermediates
GB9420168D0 (en) 1994-10-06 1994-11-23 Boots Co Plc Therapeutic agents
US5571819A (en) 1994-11-22 1996-11-05 Sabb; Annmarie L. Imidazopyridines as muscarinic agents
US5482936A (en) * 1995-01-12 1996-01-09 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Imidazo[4,5-C]quinoline amines
US6071949A (en) 1995-03-14 2000-06-06 The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services Use of lipoxygenase inhibitors as anti-cancer therapeutic and intervention agents
US5585612A (en) 1995-03-20 1996-12-17 Harp Enterprises, Inc. Method and apparatus for voting
FR2732605B1 (en) 1995-04-07 1997-05-16 Pasteur Merieux Serums Vacc COMPOSITION FOR INDUCING MUCOSAL IMMUNE RESPONSE
US5766789A (en) 1995-09-29 1998-06-16 Energetics Systems Corporation Electrical energy devices
EP0778277B1 (en) 1995-12-08 2003-06-25 Pfizer Inc. Substituted heterocyclic derivatives as CRF antagonists
US5939047A (en) 1996-04-16 1999-08-17 Jernberg; Gary R. Local delivery of chemotherapeutic agents for treatment of periodontal disease
US5861268A (en) 1996-05-23 1999-01-19 Biomide Investment Limited Partnership Method for induction of tumor cell apoptosis with chemical inhibitors targeted to 12-lipoxygenase
US5741908A (en) * 1996-06-21 1998-04-21 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Process for reparing imidazoquinolinamines
US5693811A (en) * 1996-06-21 1997-12-02 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Process for preparing tetrahdroimidazoquinolinamines
EP0882727B9 (en) 1996-07-03 2005-06-15 Sumitomo Pharmaceuticals Company, Limited Novel purine derivatives
US6387938B1 (en) 1996-07-05 2002-05-14 Mochida Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Benzimidazole derivatives
CA2268957C (en) 1996-10-25 2008-04-29 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Immune response modifier compounds for treatment of th2 mediated and related diseases
US5939090A (en) 1996-12-03 1999-08-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Gel formulations for topical drug delivery
EP0894797A4 (en) 1997-01-09 2001-08-16 Terumo Corp Novel amide derivatives and intermediates for the synthesis thereof
US6406705B1 (en) 1997-03-10 2002-06-18 University Of Iowa Research Foundation Use of nucleic acids containing unmethylated CpG dinucleotide as an adjuvant
US6426334B1 (en) 1997-04-30 2002-07-30 Hybridon, Inc. Oligonucleotide mediated specific cytokine induction and reduction of tumor growth in a mammal
US6113918A (en) 1997-05-08 2000-09-05 Ribi Immunochem Research, Inc. Aminoalkyl glucosamine phosphate compounds and their use as adjuvants and immunoeffectors
US6303347B1 (en) 1997-05-08 2001-10-16 Corixa Corporation Aminoalkyl glucosaminide phosphate compounds and their use as adjuvants and immunoeffectors
EP1003531B1 (en) 1997-05-20 2007-08-22 Ottawa Health Research Institute Processes for preparing nucleic acid constructs
US6123957A (en) 1997-07-16 2000-09-26 Jernberg; Gary R. Delivery of agents and method for regeneration of periodontal tissues
KR100528112B1 (en) 1997-08-20 2006-03-17 소니 가부시끼 가이샤 Apparatus and method for manufacturing disc-shaped recording medium
US6309623B1 (en) 1997-09-29 2001-10-30 Inhale Therapeutic Systems, Inc. Stabilized preparations for use in metered dose inhalers
ES2205573T3 (en) 1997-11-28 2004-05-01 Sumitomo Pharmaceuticals Company, Limited NEW HETEROCICLIC COMPOUNDS.
US6121323A (en) 1997-12-03 2000-09-19 3M Innovative Properties Company Bishydroxyureas
UA67760C2 (en) 1997-12-11 2004-07-15 Міннесота Майнінг Енд Мануфакчурінг Компані Imidazonaphthyridines and use thereof to induce the biosynthesis of cytokines
TW572758B (en) 1997-12-22 2004-01-21 Sumitomo Pharma Type 2 helper T cell-selective immune response inhibitors comprising purine derivatives
GB9804377D0 (en) 1998-03-03 1998-04-22 Speights Limited Lighting device
US6114058A (en) 1998-05-26 2000-09-05 Siemens Westinghouse Power Corporation Iron aluminide alloy container for solid oxide fuel cells
US6110929A (en) 1998-07-28 2000-08-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxazolo, thiazolo and selenazolo [4,5-c]-quinolin-4-amines and analogs thereof
JP2000119271A (en) 1998-08-12 2000-04-25 Hokuriku Seiyaku Co Ltd 1h-imidazopyridine derivative
US5962636A (en) 1998-08-12 1999-10-05 Amgen Canada Inc. Peptides capable of modulating inflammatory heart disease
US6518280B2 (en) 1998-12-11 2003-02-11 3M Innovative Properties Company Imidazonaphthyridines
US20020058674A1 (en) * 1999-01-08 2002-05-16 Hedenstrom John C. Systems and methods for treating a mucosal surface
EP1495758A3 (en) 1999-01-08 2005-04-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Formulations and methods for treatment of mucosal associated conditions with an immune response modifier
CN1555264A (en) * 1999-01-08 2004-12-15 3M Formulations for treatment of mucosal associated conditions with an immune response modifier
US6486168B1 (en) 1999-01-08 2002-11-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Formulations and methods for treatment of mucosal associated conditions with an immune response modifier
US6558951B1 (en) * 1999-02-11 2003-05-06 3M Innovative Properties Company Maturation of dendritic cells with immune response modifying compounds
US6294271B1 (en) 1999-02-12 2001-09-25 Shin-Etsu Chemical Co., Ltd. Flip-chip type semiconductor device sealing material and flip-chip type semiconductor device
JP2000247884A (en) 1999-03-01 2000-09-12 Sumitomo Pharmaceut Co Ltd Arachidonic acid-induced skin disease-treating agent
WO2000061765A2 (en) 1999-04-12 2000-10-19 Lexicon Genetics Incorporated Lipoxygenase proteins and polynucleotides encoding the same
US6756382B2 (en) * 1999-06-10 2004-06-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazoquinolines
US6541485B1 (en) * 1999-06-10 2003-04-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea substituted imidazoquinolines
US6331539B1 (en) 1999-06-10 2001-12-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamide and sulfamide substituted imidazoquinolines
US6451810B1 (en) * 1999-06-10 2002-09-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazoquinolines
US6573273B1 (en) 1999-06-10 2003-06-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea substituted imidazoquinolines
US6315985B1 (en) 1999-06-18 2001-11-13 3M Innovative Properties Company C-17/21 OH 20-ketosteroid solution aerosol products with enhanced chemical stability
WO2001012804A2 (en) 1999-08-13 2001-02-22 Hybridon, Inc. MODULATION OF OLIGONUCLEOTIDE CpG-MEDIATED IMMUNE STIMULATION BY POSITIONAL MODIFICATION OF NUCLEOSIDES
US6432989B1 (en) 1999-08-27 2002-08-13 Pfizer Inc Use of CRF antagonists to treat circadian rhythm disorders
IL139197A0 (en) 1999-10-29 2001-11-25 Pfizer Prod Inc Use of corticotropin releasing factor antagonists and related compositions
ES2254164T3 (en) 1999-10-29 2006-06-16 Nektar Therapeutics DRY POWDER COMPOSITIONS WITH IMPROVED DISPERSABILITY.
US6916925B1 (en) 1999-11-05 2005-07-12 3M Innovative Properties Co. Dye labeled imidazoquinoline compounds
US6376669B1 (en) * 1999-11-05 2002-04-23 3M Innovative Properties Company Dye labeled imidazoquinoline compounds
US6313156B1 (en) 1999-12-23 2001-11-06 Icos Corporation Thiazole compounds as cyclic-AMP-specific phosphodiesterase inhibitors
US20040023870A1 (en) 2000-01-21 2004-02-05 Douglas Dedera Methods of therapy and diagnosis using targeting of cells that express toll-like receptor proteins
GB0001704D0 (en) 2000-01-25 2000-03-15 Glaxo Group Ltd Protein
IL150841A0 (en) 2000-02-09 2003-02-12 Hokuriku Pharmaceutical 1h-imidazopyridine derivatives
CA2403553A1 (en) 2000-03-17 2001-09-27 David Johnson Novel amphipathic aldehydes and their use as adjuvants and immunoeffectors
US20010046968A1 (en) 2000-03-23 2001-11-29 Zagon Ian S. Opioid growth factor modulates angiogenesis
US6894060B2 (en) * 2000-03-30 2005-05-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Method for the treatment of dermal lesions caused by envenomation
PL357672A1 (en) 2000-03-30 2004-07-26 Shionogi & Co, Ltd. Novel process for producing fused imidazopyridine derivative and novel crystal form
DE10020465A1 (en) 2000-04-26 2001-11-08 Osram Opto Semiconductors Gmbh Radiation-emitting semiconductor component with luminescence conversion element
AU2001264753A1 (en) 2000-05-19 2001-12-03 Millennium Pharmaceuticals, Inc. 46638, a putative family member of human lipoxygenase
DE10029580C1 (en) 2000-06-15 2002-01-10 Ferton Holding Sa Device for removing body stones with an intracorporeal lithotripter
US6387383B1 (en) 2000-08-03 2002-05-14 Dow Pharmaceutical Sciences Topical low-viscosity gel composition
US6900016B1 (en) 2000-09-08 2005-05-31 Applera Corporation Polymorphisms in known genes associated with inflammatory autoimmune disease, methods of detection and uses thereof
US20020055517A1 (en) * 2000-09-15 2002-05-09 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods for delaying recurrence of herpes virus symptoms
WO2002022809A2 (en) 2000-09-15 2002-03-21 Coley Pharmaceutical Gmbh PROCESS FOR HIGH THROUGHPUT SCREENING OF CpG-BASED IMMUNO-AGONIST/ANTAGONIST
GB0023008D0 (en) 2000-09-20 2000-11-01 Glaxo Group Ltd Improvements in vaccination
CZ20031587A3 (en) 2000-12-07 2004-01-14 Aoyama Seisakusho Co., Ltd. Method for baking steel parts of a product
US20020107262A1 (en) * 2000-12-08 2002-08-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazopyridines
EP1360486A2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2003-11-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Screening method for identifying compounds that selectively induce interferon alpha
UA74593C2 (en) 2000-12-08 2006-01-16 3M Innovative Properties Co Substituted imidazopyridines
US6660747B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-12-09 3M Innovative Properties Company Amido ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6667312B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-12-23 3M Innovative Properties Company Thioether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6677348B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2004-01-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryl ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6664260B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2003-12-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Heterocyclic ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6525064B1 (en) * 2000-12-08 2003-02-25 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamido substituted imidazopyridines
US6664265B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-12-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Amido ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6664264B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-12-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Thioether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6660735B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-12-09 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea substituted imidazoquinoline ethers
US6545017B1 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-04-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea substituted imidazopyridines
US6545016B1 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-04-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazopyridines
US6677347B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2004-01-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamido ether substituted imidazoquinolines
UA75622C2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2006-05-15 3M Innovative Properties Co Aryl ether substituted imidazoquinolines, pharmaceutical composition based thereon
US20020182274A1 (en) 2001-03-21 2002-12-05 Kung-Ming Lu Methods for inhibiting cancer growth, reducing infection and promoting general health with a fermented soy extract
ES2314042T3 (en) 2001-04-17 2009-03-16 Dainippon Sumitomo Pharma Co., Ltd. NEW DERIVATIVES OF ADENINA.
ATE463505T1 (en) 2001-04-20 2010-04-15 Inst Systems Biology TOLL-LIKE RECEPTOR 5 LIGANDS AND METHODS OF USE
US20020193729A1 (en) 2001-04-20 2002-12-19 Cormier Michel J.N. Microprojection array immunization patch and method
US6627639B2 (en) 2001-04-26 2003-09-30 Wyeth Uses for indoletetrahydropyridine derivatives of 2,3-dihydro-7H-[1,4]dioxino-[2,3-e]indole
US7226928B2 (en) 2001-06-15 2007-06-05 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods for the treatment of periodontal disease
US6756399B2 (en) 2001-06-29 2004-06-29 The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services Use of lipoxygenase inhibitors and PPAR ligands as anti-cancer therapeutic and intervention agents
CA2453664A1 (en) 2001-07-16 2003-01-30 Takayuki Kasai Process for preparation of amidine derivatives
US6664280B2 (en) * 2001-07-25 2003-12-16 The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Army Antivesicant compounds and methods of making and using thereof
US20030133913A1 (en) * 2001-08-30 2003-07-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods of maturing plasmacytoid dendritic cells using immune response modifier molecules
US7132438B2 (en) * 2001-10-09 2006-11-07 Amgen Inc. Benzimidazole derivatives
AU2002360278A1 (en) * 2001-10-12 2003-11-11 Coley Pharmaceutical Gmbh Methods and products for enhancing immune responses using imidazoquinoline compounds
DK1719511T3 (en) * 2001-11-16 2009-04-14 Coley Pharm Group Inc N- [4- (4-amino-2-ethyl-1H-imidazo [4,5-c] quinolin-1-yl) butyl] methanesulfonamide, a pharmaceutical composition comprising the same, and use thereof
AU2002364897A1 (en) 2001-11-17 2003-06-10 Maria Martinez-Colon Imiquimod therapies
CN101033242A (en) 2001-11-27 2007-09-12 安那迪斯药品股份有限公司 Antenna system for a level measurement apparatus
ES2312659T3 (en) * 2001-11-29 2009-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company PHARMACEUTICAL FORMULATIONS THAT INCLUDE A MODIFIER OF THE IMMUNE RESPONSE.
US6677349B1 (en) * 2001-12-21 2004-01-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamide and sulfamide substituted imidazoquinolines
US6775514B2 (en) 2002-01-11 2004-08-10 Xerox Corporation Substrate size monitoring system for use in copier/printers
US6525028B1 (en) 2002-02-04 2003-02-25 Corixa Corporation Immunoeffector compounds
US20050281813A1 (en) 2002-02-14 2005-12-22 Nuvelo, Inc. Methods of therapy and diagnosis using targeting of cells that express toll-like receptor proteins
JP2005518433A (en) * 2002-02-22 2005-06-23 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Methods for reducing and treating UVB-induced immunosuppression
US20030185835A1 (en) 2002-03-19 2003-10-02 Braun Ralph P. Adjuvant for vaccines
US8153141B2 (en) 2002-04-04 2012-04-10 Coley Pharmaceutical Gmbh Immunostimulatory G, U-containing oligoribonucleotides
NZ535988A (en) 2002-04-30 2005-09-30 Unigen Pharmaceuticals Inc Formulation of a mixture of free-B-ring flavonoids and flavans as a therapeutic agent
GB0211649D0 (en) * 2002-05-21 2002-07-03 Novartis Ag Organic compounds
AU2003233519A1 (en) * 2002-05-29 2003-12-19 3M Innovative Properties Company Process for imidazo(4,5-c)pyridin-4-amines
JP2005538057A (en) * 2002-06-07 2005-12-15 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Ether-substituted imidazopyridine
EP1543002B1 (en) * 2002-07-23 2006-08-30 TEVA Gyógyszergyár Zártkörüen Müködö Részvénytársaság Preparation of 1h-imidazo 4,5-c|quinolin-4-amines via1h-imidazo 4,5-c|quinolin-4-phthalimide intermediates
ES2282691T3 (en) * 2002-07-26 2007-10-16 Teva Gyogyszergyar Zartkoruen Mukodo Reszvenytarsasag PREPARATION OF IH-IMIDAZO (4,5-C) QUINOLIN-4-AMINA THROUGH NEW INT ERMEDIOS 1H-IMIDAZO (4,5-C) QUINOLIN-4-CIANO AND 1H-IMIDAZO (4,5-C).
AU2003299863B2 (en) * 2002-08-15 2009-09-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Immunostimulatory compositions and methods of stimulating an immune response
AU2003299082A1 (en) * 2002-09-26 2004-04-19 3M Innovative Properties Company 1h-imidazo dimers
US7199119B2 (en) 2002-10-31 2007-04-03 Amgen Inc. Antiinflammation agents
WO2004043913A2 (en) 2002-11-08 2004-05-27 Trimeris, Inc. Hetero-substituted benzimidazole compounds and antiviral uses thereof
AU2003287324A1 (en) * 2002-12-11 2004-06-30 3M Innovative Properties Company Gene expression systems and recombinant cell lines
AU2003287316A1 (en) 2002-12-11 2004-06-30 3M Innovative Properties Company Assays relating to toll-like receptor activity
AU2003301052A1 (en) * 2002-12-20 2004-07-22 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryl / hetaryl substituted imidazoquinolines
US7387271B2 (en) * 2002-12-30 2008-06-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Immunostimulatory combinations
WO2004071459A2 (en) 2003-02-13 2004-08-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods and compositions related to irm compounds and toll-like receptor 8
US7485432B2 (en) * 2003-02-27 2009-02-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Selective modulation of TLR-mediated biological activity
AU2004218349A1 (en) * 2003-03-04 2004-09-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Prophylactic treatment of UV-induced epidermal neoplasia
CA2517655A1 (en) * 2003-03-07 2004-09-23 3M Innovative Properties Company 1-amino 1h-imidazoquinolines
US7163947B2 (en) 2003-03-07 2007-01-16 3M Innovative Properties Company 1-Amino 1H-imidazoquinolines
CA2518445A1 (en) * 2003-03-13 2004-09-23 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of tattoo removal
MXPA05009694A (en) * 2003-03-13 2005-10-20 3M Innovative Properties Co Methods of improving skin quality.
WO2004080293A2 (en) * 2003-03-13 2004-09-23 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods for diagnosing skin lesions
US20040192585A1 (en) * 2003-03-25 2004-09-30 3M Innovative Properties Company Treatment for basal cell carcinoma
WO2004087049A2 (en) * 2003-03-25 2004-10-14 3M Innovative Properties Company Selective activation of cellular activities mediated through a common toll-like receptor
ES2423800T3 (en) 2003-03-28 2013-09-24 Novartis Vaccines And Diagnostics, Inc. Use of organic compounds for immunopotentiation
AU2004244962A1 (en) 2003-04-10 2004-12-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Delivery of immune response modifier compounds using metal-containing particulate support materials
US20040265351A1 (en) 2003-04-10 2004-12-30 Miller Richard L. Methods and compositions for enhancing immune response
EP1617845A4 (en) * 2003-04-28 2006-09-20 3M Innovative Properties Co Compositions and methods for induction of opioid receptors
WO2004110992A2 (en) 2003-06-06 2004-12-23 3M Innovative Properties Company Process for imidazo[4,5-c] pyridin-4-amines
WO2004110991A2 (en) 2003-06-06 2004-12-23 3M Innovative Properties Company PROCESS FOR IMIDAZO[4,5-c]PYRIDIN-4-AMINES
JP2007524615A (en) 2003-06-20 2007-08-30 コーリー ファーマシューティカル ゲーエムベーハー Low molecular weight Toll-like receptor (TLR) antagonist
MY157827A (en) 2003-06-27 2016-07-29 3M Innovative Properties Co Sulfonamide substituted imidazoquinolines
US20050106300A1 (en) 2003-06-30 2005-05-19 Purdue Research Foundation Method for producing a material having an increased solubility in alcohol
WO2005016273A2 (en) 2003-08-05 2005-02-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Infection prophylaxis using immune response modifier compounds
JP2007502288A (en) * 2003-08-12 2007-02-08 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Oxime-substituted imidazo-containing compounds
EP1660122A4 (en) 2003-08-25 2007-10-24 3M Innovative Properties Co Immunostimulatory combinations and treatments
EP1658076B1 (en) 2003-08-27 2013-03-06 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryloxy and arylalkyleneoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
US7576068B2 (en) * 2003-09-05 2009-08-18 Anadys Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Administration of TLR7 ligands and prodrugs thereof for treatment of infection by hepatitis C virus
AU2004270201A1 (en) 2003-09-05 2005-03-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Treatment for CD5+ B cell lymphoma
GB0321615D0 (en) 2003-09-15 2003-10-15 Glaxo Group Ltd Improvements in vaccination
EP1664342A4 (en) 2003-09-17 2007-12-26 3M Innovative Properties Co Selective modulation of tlr gene expression
EP1668010A2 (en) * 2003-10-01 2006-06-14 Taro Pharmaceuticals U.S.A., Inc. Method of preparing 4-amino-1h -imidazo(4,5- c )quinolines and acid addition salts thereof
US20090075980A1 (en) 2003-10-03 2009-03-19 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Pyrazolopyridines and Analogs Thereof
US7544697B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2009-06-09 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Pyrazolopyridines and analogs thereof
BRPI0414856A (en) 2003-10-03 2006-11-21 3M Innovative Properties Co alkoxy-substituted imidazoquinolines
WO2005041891A2 (en) 2003-10-31 2005-05-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Neutrophil activation by immune response modifier compounds
US20050239733A1 (en) 2003-10-31 2005-10-27 Coley Pharmaceutical Gmbh Sequence requirements for inhibitory oligonucleotides
ITMI20032121A1 (en) * 2003-11-04 2005-05-05 Dinamite Dipharma Spa In Forma Abbr Eviata Dipharm PROCEDURE FOR THE PREPARATION OF IMIQUIMOD AND ITS INTERMEDIATES
CA2545774A1 (en) 2003-11-14 2005-06-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime substituted imidazo ring compounds
WO2005048945A2 (en) * 2003-11-14 2005-06-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxylamine substituted imidazo ring compounds
CU23404A1 (en) 2003-11-19 2009-08-04 Ct Ingenieria Genetica Biotech NEISSERIA MENINGITIDIS CAPSULAR POLYSACARIDS AS MUCOSOPT IMMUNOPOTENTIZERS AND RESULTING FORMULATIONS
US8778963B2 (en) 2003-11-25 2014-07-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxylamine and oxime substituted imidazoquinolines, imidazopyridines, and imidazonaphthyridines
US8691837B2 (en) 2003-11-25 2014-04-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazo ring systems and methods
US20050226878A1 (en) 2003-12-02 2005-10-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Therapeutic combinations and methods including IRM compounds
US8940755B2 (en) 2003-12-02 2015-01-27 3M Innovative Properties Company Therapeutic combinations and methods including IRM compounds
AU2004315771A1 (en) 2003-12-04 2005-08-25 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfone substituted imidazo ring ethers
WO2005066172A1 (en) 2003-12-29 2005-07-21 3M Innovative Properties Company Piperazine, [1,4]diazepane, [1,4]diazocane, and [1,5]diazocane fused imidazo ring compounds
WO2005066170A1 (en) 2003-12-29 2005-07-21 3M Innovative Properties Company Arylalkenyl and arylalkynyl substituted imidazoquinolines
US8735421B2 (en) 2003-12-30 2014-05-27 3M Innovative Properties Company Imidazoquinolinyl sulfonamides
WO2005065678A1 (en) 2003-12-30 2005-07-21 3M Innovative Properties Company Immunomodulatory combinations
EP1699398A4 (en) 2003-12-30 2007-10-17 3M Innovative Properties Co Enhancement of immune responses
WO2005094531A2 (en) 2004-03-24 2005-10-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazopyridines, imidazoquinolines, and imidazonaphthyridines
AU2005244260B2 (en) 2004-04-09 2010-08-05 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods, compositions, and preparations for delivery of immune response modifiers
US20050267145A1 (en) 2004-05-28 2005-12-01 Merrill Bryon A Treatment for lung cancer
US20080015184A1 (en) 2004-06-14 2008-01-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea Substituted Imidazopyridines, Imidazoquinolines, and Imidazonaphthyridines
WO2005123080A2 (en) 2004-06-15 2005-12-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Nitrogen-containing heterocyclyl substituted imidazoquinolines and imidazonaphthyridines
WO2006038923A2 (en) 2004-06-18 2006-04-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryl substituted imidazonaphthyridines
US20070259881A1 (en) 2004-06-18 2007-11-08 Dellaria Joseph F Jr Substituted Imidazo Ring Systems and Methods
WO2006009826A1 (en) 2004-06-18 2006-01-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryloxy and arylalkyleneoxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
WO2006065280A2 (en) 2004-06-18 2006-06-22 3M Innovative Properties Company Isoxazole, dihydroisoxazole, and oxadiazole substituted imidazo ring compounds and methods
US20070259907A1 (en) 2004-06-18 2007-11-08 Prince Ryan B Aryl and arylalkylenyl substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US20090270443A1 (en) 2004-09-02 2009-10-29 Doris Stoermer 1-amino imidazo-containing compounds and methods
JP2008523084A (en) 2004-12-08 2008-07-03 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Immunostimulating combination and method
WO2006063072A2 (en) 2004-12-08 2006-06-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Immunomodulatory compositions, combinations and methods
AU2005323024A1 (en) 2004-12-30 2006-07-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Multi-route administration of immune response modifier compounds
WO2006074003A2 (en) 2004-12-30 2006-07-13 3M Innovative Properties Company CHIRAL FUSED [1,2]IMIDAZO[4,5-c] RING COMPOUNDS
CA2594674C (en) 2004-12-30 2016-05-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds
US9248127B2 (en) 2005-02-04 2016-02-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Aqueous gel formulations containing immune response modifiers
CA2602083A1 (en) 2005-02-09 2006-08-09 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Oxime and hydroxylamine substituted thiazolo(4,5-c) ring compounds and methods
AU2006212765B2 (en) 2005-02-09 2012-02-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US7968563B2 (en) * 2005-02-11 2011-06-28 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime and hydroxylamine substituted imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
JP2008530112A (en) 2005-02-11 2008-08-07 コーリー ファーマシューティカル グループ,インコーポレイテッド Substituted condensed [1,2] imidazo “4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US8658666B2 (en) 2005-02-11 2014-02-25 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazoquinolines and imidazonaphthyridines
US8158794B2 (en) 2005-02-23 2012-04-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxyalkyl substituted imidazoquinoline compounds and methods
CA2598639A1 (en) 2005-02-23 2006-08-31 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Hydroxyalkyl substituted imidazonaphthyridines
EP1850849A2 (en) 2005-02-23 2007-11-07 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Method of preferentially inducing the biosynthesis of interferon
CA2598695A1 (en) 2005-02-23 2006-09-21 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Hydroxyalkyl substituted imidazoquinolines
CA2603063A1 (en) 2005-04-01 2006-10-12 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Pyrazolo[3,4-c]quinolines, pyrazolo[3,4-c]naphthyridines, analogs thereof, and methods
EP1863770A4 (en) 2005-04-01 2010-05-05 Coley Pharm Group Inc Ring closing and related methods and intermediates
AU2006232375A1 (en) 2005-04-01 2006-10-12 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. 1-substituted pyrazolo (3,4-c) ring compounds as modulators of cytokine biosynthesis for the treatment of viral infections and neoplastic diseases
EP1869043A2 (en) 2005-04-01 2007-12-26 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Pyrazolopyridine-1,4-diamines and analogs thereof
GB0510390D0 (en) 2005-05-20 2005-06-29 Novartis Ag Organic compounds
MX2008002414A (en) 2005-09-02 2008-03-27 Pfizer Hydroxy substituted 1h-imidazopyridines and methods.
ZA200803029B (en) 2005-09-09 2009-02-25 Coley Pharm Group Inc Amide and carbamate derivatives of alkyl substituted /V-[4-(4-amino-1H-imidazo[4,5-c] quinolin-1-yl)butyl] methane-sulfonamides and methods
US8476292B2 (en) 2005-09-09 2013-07-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide and carbamate derivatives of N-{2-[4-amino-2-(ethoxymethyl)-1H-imidazo[4,5-c] quinolin-1-Yl]-1,1-dimethylethyl}methanesulfonamide and methods
AU2006292119A1 (en) 2005-09-23 2007-03-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Method for 1H-imidazo[4,5-c]pyridines and analogs thereof
EP1948173B1 (en) 2005-11-04 2013-07-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1h-imidazoquinolines and methods
WO2007062043A1 (en) 2005-11-23 2007-05-31 Coley Pharmaceutical Group Inc. Method of activating murine toll-like receptor 8
KR20080077982A (en) 2005-12-16 2008-08-26 콜레이 파마시티컬 그룹, 인코포레이티드 Substituted imidazoquinolines, imidazonaphthyridines, and imidazopyridines, compositions, and methods
WO2007079169A2 (en) 2005-12-28 2007-07-12 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Treatment for acute myeloid leukemia
WO2007079171A2 (en) 2005-12-28 2007-07-12 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Treatment for hodgkin's lymphoma
EP1968582A4 (en) 2005-12-28 2011-02-16 3M Innovative Properties Co Treatment for cutaneous t cell lymphoma
WO2007079086A1 (en) 2005-12-28 2007-07-12 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Pyrazoloalkyl substituted imidazo ring compounds and methods
WO2007079146A1 (en) 2005-12-28 2007-07-12 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc Treatment for non-hodgkin's lymphoma
WO2007079202A2 (en) 2005-12-28 2007-07-12 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Treatment for acute lymhoblastic leukemia
US20090306388A1 (en) 2006-02-10 2009-12-10 Pfizer Inc. Method for substituted ih-imidazo[4,5-c] pyridines
WO2007106852A2 (en) 2006-03-15 2007-09-20 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Substituted fused[1,2]imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
WO2007106854A2 (en) 2006-03-15 2007-09-20 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1h-imidazonaphthyridines and methods
WO2007143526A2 (en) 2006-06-05 2007-12-13 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Substituted tetrahydroimidazonaphthyridines and methods
US7906506B2 (en) 2006-07-12 2011-03-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted chiral fused [1,2] imidazo [4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US8178539B2 (en) 2006-09-06 2012-05-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted 3,4,6,7-tetrahydro-5H-1,2a,4a,8-tetraazacyclopenta[cd]phenalenes and methods
WO2008036312A1 (en) 2006-09-19 2008-03-27 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Fungicidal methods using immune response modifier compounds
WO2008045543A1 (en) 2006-10-13 2008-04-17 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Substituted 4h-imidazo [4, 5, 1-ij] [1, 6] naphthyridine-9-amines and their pharmaceutical use

Non-Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
See references of EP1685129A4 *

Cited By (47)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7923429B2 (en) 2003-09-05 2011-04-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Treatment for CD5+ B cell lymphoma
US8871782B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2014-10-28 3M Innovative Properties Company Alkoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
US7879849B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2011-02-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridines and analogs thereof
US7897767B2 (en) * 2003-11-14 2011-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime substituted imidazoquinolines
WO2005048945A3 (en) * 2003-11-14 2006-03-23 3M Innovative Properties Co Hydroxylamine substituted imidazo ring compounds
US7915281B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2011-03-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Isoxazole, dihydroisoxazole, and oxadiazole substituted imidazo ring compounds and method
EP1833827A2 (en) * 2004-12-30 2007-09-19 3M Innovative Properties Company Process for preparing 2-methyl-1-(2-methylpropyl)-1h-imidazoý4,5-c¨ý1,5¨naphthyridin-4-amine
US7943609B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2011-05-17 3M Innovative Proprerties Company Chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-C] ring compounds
EP1833827A4 (en) * 2004-12-30 2009-11-11 Meda Ab Process for preparing 2-methyl-1-(2-methylpropyl)-1h-imidazoý4,5-c¨ý1,5¨naphthyridin-4-amine
US8034938B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2011-10-11 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds
EP2394650A1 (en) 2004-12-30 2011-12-14 3M Innovative Properties Co. Use of resiquimod for the treatment of cutaneous metastases
US7307083B2 (en) 2005-01-27 2007-12-11 Alma Mater Studiorum-Universita'di Bologna Tetrahydro-acridine and dithiolane derivatives
WO2006080043A3 (en) * 2005-01-27 2006-09-08 Univ Bologna Alma Mater Organic compounds useful for the treatment of alzheimer's disease, their use and method of preparation
WO2006080043A2 (en) * 2005-01-27 2006-08-03 Alma Mater Studiorum- Universita' Di Bologna Organic compounds useful for the treatment of alzheimer's disease, their use and method of preparation
US9248127B2 (en) 2005-02-04 2016-02-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Aqueous gel formulations containing immune response modifiers
US10071156B2 (en) 2005-02-04 2018-09-11 3M Innovative Properties Company Aqueous gel formulations containing immune response modifiers
US7968563B2 (en) 2005-02-11 2011-06-28 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime and hydroxylamine substituted imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US7943610B2 (en) 2005-04-01 2011-05-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridine-1,4-diamines and analogs thereof
US7943636B2 (en) 2005-04-01 2011-05-17 3M Innovative Properties Company 1-substituted pyrazolo (3,4-C) ring compounds as modulators of cytokine biosynthesis for the treatment of viral infections and neoplastic diseases
JP2009507036A (en) * 2005-09-02 2009-02-19 ファイザー・インク Hydroxy-substituted 1H-imidazopyridine and method
JP2009509971A (en) * 2005-09-23 2009-03-12 コーリー ファーマシューティカル グループ,インコーポレイテッド Process for 1H-imidazo [4,5-c] pyridine and analogs thereof
EP3085373A1 (en) 2006-02-22 2016-10-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier conjugates
US8951528B2 (en) 2006-02-22 2015-02-10 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier conjugates
US7906506B2 (en) 2006-07-12 2011-03-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted chiral fused [1,2] imidazo [4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
JP2009544586A (en) * 2006-07-14 2009-12-17 塩野義製薬株式会社 Oxime compounds and uses thereof
US10005772B2 (en) 2006-12-22 2018-06-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier compositions and methods
US10144735B2 (en) 2006-12-22 2018-12-04 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier compositions and methods
US8563732B2 (en) 2007-05-31 2013-10-22 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Oxyimino compounds and the use thereof
US9073913B2 (en) 2008-03-24 2015-07-07 4Sc Ag Substituted imidazoquinolines
WO2009118296A2 (en) * 2008-03-24 2009-10-01 4Sc Ag Novel substituted imidazoquinolines
EA023556B1 (en) * 2008-03-24 2016-06-30 4ЭсЦэ АГ 1,2-disubstituted-4-aminoimidazoquinolines
US9446040B2 (en) 2008-03-24 2016-09-20 4Sc Ag Substituted imidazoquinolines
WO2009118296A3 (en) * 2008-03-24 2009-12-03 4Sc Ag Novel substituted imidazoquinolines
US9908880B2 (en) 2008-03-24 2018-03-06 4Sc Ag Substituted imidazoquinolines
US8518934B2 (en) 2008-06-11 2013-08-27 Shonogi & Co., Ltd. Oxycarbamoyl compounds and the use thereof
US9441005B2 (en) 2011-05-18 2016-09-13 University Of Kansas Toll-like receptor-7 and -8 modulatory 1H imidazoquinoline derived compounds
US8728486B2 (en) 2011-05-18 2014-05-20 University Of Kansas Toll-like receptor-7 and -8 modulatory 1H imidazoquinoline derived compounds
EP3153180A1 (en) 2011-06-03 2017-04-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Heterobifunctional linkers with polyethylene glycol segments and immune response modifier conjugates made therefrom
WO2014107663A2 (en) 2013-01-07 2014-07-10 The Trustees Of The University Of Pennsylvania Compositions and methods for treating cutaneous t cell lymphoma
EP3756669A1 (en) 2013-01-07 2020-12-30 The Trustees of the University of Pennsylvania Compositions for use for treating cutaneous t cell lymphoma
WO2019166946A1 (en) 2018-02-28 2019-09-06 Pfizer Inc. Il-15 variants and uses thereof
WO2019224715A1 (en) 2018-05-23 2019-11-28 Pfizer Inc. Antibodies specific for cd3 and uses thereof
WO2019224716A2 (en) 2018-05-23 2019-11-28 Pfizer Inc. Antibodies specific for gucy2c and uses thereof
US11434292B2 (en) 2018-05-23 2022-09-06 Pfizer Inc. Antibodies specific for CD3 and uses thereof
WO2020128893A1 (en) 2018-12-21 2020-06-25 Pfizer Inc. Combination treatments of cancer comprising a tlr agonist
WO2021124073A1 (en) 2019-12-17 2021-06-24 Pfizer Inc. Antibodies specific for cd47, pd-l1, and uses thereof
WO2022013775A1 (en) 2020-07-17 2022-01-20 Pfizer Inc. Therapeutic antibodies and their uses

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US7897767B2 (en) 2011-03-01
CA2545774A1 (en) 2005-06-02
US20090042925A1 (en) 2009-02-12
EP1685129A2 (en) 2006-08-02
CN1906193A (en) 2007-01-31
JP2007511527A (en) 2007-05-10
WO2005048933A3 (en) 2005-12-01
AU2004291101A1 (en) 2005-06-02
EP1685129A4 (en) 2008-10-22

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
WO2005048933A2 (en) Oxime substituted imidazo ring compounds
US8598192B2 (en) Hydroxylamine substituted imidazoquinolines
US8735421B2 (en) Imidazoquinolinyl sulfonamides
US8802853B2 (en) Arylalkenyl and arylalkynyl substituted imidazoquinolines
EP1699792A1 (en) Piperazine, 1,4¨diazepane, 1,4¨diazocane, and 1,5¨diazocane fused imidazo ring compounds
MXPA06001669A (en) Oxime substituted imidazo-containing compounds.
EP1686992A2 (en) Hydroxylamine and oxime substituted imidazoquinolines, imidazopyridines, and imidazonaphthyridines
AU2006213746A1 (en) Oxime and hydroxylamine substituted imidazo(4,5-c) ring compounds and methods
WO2005051317A2 (en) Substituted imidazo ring systems and methods
WO2005076783A2 (en) Sulfone substituted imidazo ring ethers

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AK Designated states

Kind code of ref document: A2

Designated state(s): AE AG AL AM AT AU AZ BA BB BG BR BW BY BZ CA CH CN CO CR CU CZ DE DK DM DZ EC EE EG ES FI GB GD GE GH GM HR HU ID IL IN IS JP KE KG KP KR KZ LC LK LR LS LT LU LV MA MD MG MK MN MW MX MZ NA NI NO NZ OM PG PH PL PT RO RU SC SD SE SG SK SL SY TJ TM TN TR TT TZ UA UG US UZ VC VN YU ZA ZM ZW

AL Designated countries for regional patents

Kind code of ref document: A2

Designated state(s): BW GH GM KE LS MW MZ NA SD SL SZ TZ UG ZM ZW AM AZ BY KG KZ MD RU TJ TM AT BE BG CH CY CZ DE DK EE ES FI FR GB GR HU IE IS IT LU MC NL PL PT RO SE SI SK TR BF BJ CF CG CI CM GA GN GQ GW ML MR NE SN TD TG

121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application
WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2545774

Country of ref document: CA

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 10595792

Country of ref document: US

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2006539911

Country of ref document: JP

Ref document number: 1669/CHENP/2006

Country of ref document: IN

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2004291101

Country of ref document: AU

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2004810872

Country of ref document: EP

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2004291101

Country of ref document: AU

Date of ref document: 20041112

Kind code of ref document: A

WWP Wipo information: published in national office

Ref document number: 2004291101

Country of ref document: AU

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 200480040434.9

Country of ref document: CN

WWP Wipo information: published in national office

Ref document number: 2004810872

Country of ref document: EP